Strategic Marketing Planning: A Step-by-Step Approach [2 ed.] 1032463937, 9781032463933

This book provides a uniquely practical approach to strategic marketing planning. Combining a comprehensive overview of

126 81 16MB

English Pages 458 Year 2023

Report DMCA / Copyright

DOWNLOAD PDF FILE

Recommend Papers

Strategic Marketing Planning: A Step-by-Step Approach [2 ed.]
 1032463937, 9781032463933

  • 0 0 0
  • Like this paper and download? You can publish your own PDF file online for free in a few minutes! Sign Up
File loading please wait...
Citation preview

Strategic Marketing Planning

This book provides a uniquely practical approach to strategic marketing planning. Combining a comprehensive overview of theory with practice, each chapter takes the reader step by step through the strategic marketing process. Beginning with situation analysis, it moves on to marketing strategy (targeting and brand positioning) and finally details the overall implementation and creation of customer values. This second edition has been fully updated to integrate both sustainability and digitalization throughout the whole strategic planning process, covering analyzing consumer needs, setting goals, choosing a brand positioning, and marketing communication. Subjects such as big data, AI, online behavioral targeting, influencer marketing, and social media are explored, accompanied by plentiful examples. A unique feature is the full integration of sustainability within normal marketing, led by a new customer value model. Strategic Marketing Planning equips the reader with the necessary tools and techniques to develop and deliver a thorough and effective marketing strategy. With a broad range of international case studies that bring the theory to life, this renowned text is vital reading for undergraduate and postgraduate students of marketing management and strategic marketing. It should also be of interest to marketing practitioners who want a clear overview to aid them in the planning process. Support materials include PowerPoint slides. Karel Jan Alsem is Professor of Marketing at the Hanze University of Applied Sciences in Groningen, The Netherlands. In addition, he is Assistant Professor of Marketing at the Faculty of Economics and Business at the University of Groningen, The Netherlands. He is also a consultant in branding and health care marketing. His main research interests concern strategic brand management, marketing communications, and marketing planning. Alongside a number of books, he has published papers in journals such as the International Journal of Research in Marketing, Applied Economics, and the Journal of Market Focused Management.

Strategic Marketing Planning A Step-by-Step Approach Second Edition

Karel Jan Alsem

Designed cover image: Ryan McVay / Getty Images Second edition published 2024 by Routledge 4 Park Square, Milton Park, Abingdon, Oxon, OX14 4RN and by Routledge 605 Third Avenue, New York, NY 10158 Routledge is an imprint of the Taylor & Francis Group, an informa business © 2024 Karel Jan Alsem The right of Karel Jan Alsem to be identified as author of this work has been asserted in accordance with sections 77 and 78 of the Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988. All rights reserved. No part of this book may be reprinted or reproduced or utilised in any form or by any electronic, mechanical, or other means, now known or hereafter invented, including photocopying and recording, or in any information storage or retrieval system, without permission in writing from the publishers. Trademark notice: Product or corporate names may be trademarks or registered trademarks, and are used only for identification and explanation without intent to infringe. First edition published by Routledge 2019 British Library Cataloguing-in-Publication Data A catalogue record for this book is available from the British Library Library of Congress Cataloging-in-Publication Data Names: Alsem, K. J., author. Title: Strategic marketing planning : a step-by-step approach / Karel Jan Alsem. Description: Second edition. | Abingdon, Oxon ; New York, NY : Routledge, 2024. | First edition published by Routledge 2019. | Includes bibliographical references and index. Identifiers: LCCN 2023022150 (print) | LCCN 2023022151 (ebook) | ISBN 9781032463933 (hardback) | ISBN 9781032463834 (paperback) | ISBN 9781003381488 (ebook) Subjects: LCSH: Marketing—Management. Classification: LCC HF5415.13 .A435313 2024 (print) | LCC HF5415.13 (ebook) | DDC 658.8—dc23/eng/20230720 LC record available at https://lccn.loc.gov/2023022150 LC ebook record available at https://lccn.loc.gov/2023022151 ISBN: 978-1-032-46393-3 (hbk) ISBN: 978-1-032-46383-4 (pbk) ISBN: 978-1-003-38148-8 (ebk) DOI: 10.4324/9781003381488 Typeset in Times New Roman by Apex CoVantage, LLC Access the Support Material: www.routledge.com/9781032463834

Contents

Preface to the second edition

xv

Acknowledgmentsxix

Part 1: Introduction and marketing planning 1 The essence of marketing Introduction 1.1 The changing landscape of marketing 1.1.1 Types of trends 1.1.2 Online behavior and digital marketing 1.1.3 Marketing spiral 1.1.4 The unconscious consumer and the role of emotion 1.1.5 Sustainability 1.2 What is marketing? 1.2.1 The concept of marketing 1.2.2 Marketing 1.0: customer needs and competition 1.2.3 Marketing 2.0: emotions, relationships, experiences, and brands 1.2.4 Marketing 3.0: society and other interest groups 1.2.5 Conclusion and marketing as an activity 1.3 Marketing in organizations 1.3.1 Marketing and other functions in the organization 1.3.2 Forms of marketing Summary Will the engine of the rock continue to rock?

3 3 3 4 4 6 8 10 14 14 15 16 21 21 23 23 25 26 28

vi

COnTenTS

................................................................................................... 2

The strategic marketing planning process

31

Introduction 2.1 Levels and types of decisions in a company 2.1.1 The company level 2.1.2 The division and SBU level 2.1.3 The product level and marketing mix level 2.1.4 The position of the brand 2.1.5 Strategic, tactical, and operational decisions 2.2 Core of the marketing strategy 2.2.1 Corporate strategy: growth direction and value strategy 2.2.2 Marketing strategy: target group and positioning 2.3 Content of the strategic marketing planning process 2.3.1 Importance of an environmental analysis 2.3.2 Overview of the process 2.3.3 Description of the phases 2.3.4 Properties of the planning process 2.4 Structure of a marketing plan Summary experience Disneyland Paris

31 31 32 32 33 34 34 34 35 36 37 37 42 44 48 48 53 54

Part 2: Situation analysis 3

Mission, customer values, and market definition

61

Introduction 3.1 Developing a customer-oriented vision 3.1.1 Functions of a mission 3.1.2 Two types of missions and sustainability 3.1.3 Vision of a company 3.2 Customer values 3.2.1 What is customer value? 3.2.2 The Brand Benefitting Model 3.2.3 The value strategies of Treacy and Wiersema 3.2.4 Format of Porter 3.2.5 Conclusions about the classifications 3.3 Market definition 3.3.1 Market definition at the SBU level 3.3.2 Market definition at product-brand level 3.3.3 Market definition and new activities 3.3.4 Importance and danger of the market definition Summary Coffee is an experience

62 62 62 64 65 66 66 68 69 73 73 74 74 76 77 80 81 82

Contents vii

4 Internal analysis Introduction 4.1 Objectives and the PDCA cycle 4.1.1 Requirements for objectives 4.1.2 The PDCA cycle 4.2 Step 1: application of the balanced scorecard 4.2.1 Financial goals 4.2.2 Customer-oriented goals 4.2.3 Internal and social goals 4.2.4 Innovation goals 4.2.5 Sustainability goals 4.2.6 Economy versus sustainability 4.3 Step 2: evaluation of the results 4.4 Step 3: internal analysis at company level 4.4.1 Brand benefits as an analysis model 4.4.2 Management’s assessment of functional areas 4.4.3 Marketing audit 4.5 Step 4: internal analysis at brand level Summary How Wal-Mart found its footing in the Amazon era

89 90 90 91 92 93 94 94 95 97 97 97 98 101 102 102 105 106 107 108

5 Customer analysis Introduction 5.1 Goals of the customer analysis 5.2 Segmentation research 5.2.1 Requirements for segments 5.2.2 Steps and methods 5.2.3 Guidelines for segmentation 5.3 Models of consumer behavior 5.3.1 The standard consumer behavior model 5.3.2 The multi-attribute attitude model 5.3.3 Means-end chain 5.3.4 The SERVQUAL model 5.4 Measuring the importance of product properties 5.4.1 Direct method: Likert scale 5.4.2 Conjoint analysis 5.5 Measuring perceptions and associations 5.5.1 Qualitative methods 5.5.2 Likert scales and spider diagrams 5.5.3 Perceptual mapping 5.6 Measuring brand strength 5.6.1 Brand strength and brand value 5.6.2 Brand Equity Pyramid 5.6.3 Net Promoter Score

113 114 114 116 116 116 121 122 122 123 124 125 128 128 128 130 131 131 132 136 136 137 138

viii  Contents



Contents ix



x  Contents

9 SWOT analysis Introduction 9.1 Definitions and forecasting methods 9.1.1 Definitions 9.1.2 Forecasting methods 9.2 Step 1: summary of the situation analysis 9.3 Step 2: vision of the environment and core challenge 9.4 Step 3: marketing strategic options 9.4.1 Features of the SWOT approach in this book 9.4.2 SWOT matrix 9.5 Step 4: selection of a marketing strategy 9.5.1 Criteria when assessing options 9.5.2 Forecasts and considerations in the selection process 9.5.3 Estimating the net present value of a strategy Summary Pepsi Cola in the United States: strategic choices

232 233 233 233 234 235 235 239 239 245 245 246 248 249 250 252

Part 3: Corporate decisions and marketing decisions 10 Corporate objectives and strategies

261

Introduction 262 10.1 Company vision and objectives 262 10.1.1 Corporate vision 262 10.1.2 Corporate objectives 263 10.2 Portfolio analysis 264 10.2.1 Purpose and content of the portfolio analysis 264 10.2.2 BCG matrix 266 10.2.3 MABA analysis 268 10.2.4 Trajectory analysis 270 10.2.5 Brand variants of the portfolio analysis 271 10.2.6 Advantages and disadvantages of portfolio methods272 10.3 Corporate strategy: choice of markets 272 10.3.1 Components of the corporate strategy 272 10.3.2 Choice of markets 273 10.4 Corporate strategy: choice of partners 278 10.4.1 Internal or external growth 278 10.4.2 External development: competition-decreasing strategies279 10.4.3 The SWOT analysis and the competition-decreasing strategy 279 10.4.4 Competition-decreasing strategies in practice 280

Contents xi



Summary Chocolate of Barry Callebaut

11 Marketing objectives and marketing strategies Introduction 11.1 Marketing objectives 11.2 Target group selection 11.2.1 Evaluation of market segments 11.2.2 Selection of the target group 11.2.3 Inclusive marketing 11.2.4 Loyalty programs 11.2.5 Behavioral targeting 11.3 Brand positioning 11.3.1 Definition and goal of positioning 11.3.2 Needs and values 11.3.3 Tools to choose a positioning 11.3.4 Positioning and sustainability 11.3.5 Tools to formulate a positioning 11.3.6 Brand laws 11.4 Brand architecture 11.4.1 Brand levels 11.4.2 Choosing a brand structure 11.5 Brand names 11.5.1 Developing a brand name 11.5.2 Types of brand names 11.5.3 Criteria for choosing a name 11.5.4 Brand name process 11.6 Design and logo 11.7 Managing brands 11.7.1 Repositioning 11.7.2 Rebranding 11.7.3 Crisis management and communication 11.7.4 Managing brands across products and varieties (extensions) 11.7.5 Managing brands across countries Summary Vorsprung durch Technik

282 283 292 293 294 294 295 296 298 298 302 302 303 306 309 314 317 319 322 322 323 323 323 324 325 327 329 332 332 332 334 337 339 341 342

Part 4: Implementation 12 Choice of product/service, price, and channels

349

Introduction 12.1 Guidelines for the marketing mix 12.1.1 Strategic thinking

350 351 351

xii  Contents

12.1.2 Innovation 12.1.3 Positive approach 12.2 Products and services 12.2.1 Overview of product decisions 12.2.2 New product development 12.3 Pricing 12.3.1 Pricing decisions 12.3.2 Investigating price sensitivity 12.4 Distribution 12.4.1 Overview of decisions 12.4.2 Level of availability 12.4.3  Where do we want to be available? 12.4.4 Management of the distribution channels Summary Case Nespresso: exclusive coffee

351 352 354 354 356 358 358 360 361 361 361 362 364 365 367

13 Marketing communications

371

Introduction 13.1 Steps in communication planning 13.2 Determination of the target audience 13.3 Selecting a proposition 13.4 Communication objectives and communication budget 13.4.1 Measuring results and effects 13.4.2 Choice of communication objectives 13.4.3 Budget determination 13.5 Briefing and requirements for communication 13.6 Creation and execution 13.7 Pretesting 13.7.1 Concept test 13.7.2 Qualitative pretest 13.7.3 Quantitative pretest 13.7.4 Limitations and use of pretesting 13.8 Communication tools and media 13.9 Online communication 13.9.1 Forms of online communication 13.9.2 Summary of digital marketing 13.9.3 Communication for small businesses 13.10 Monitoring and effect research 13.10.1 Monitoring 13.10.2 Effect research 13.10.3 Measurement of results and effects of communication

372 372 373 375 376 376 377 381 381 383 385 385 387 387 387 389 395 395 401 402 403 403 403 404

Contents xiii

13.11 Customer experience management Summary Vans: genuine commitment with its fans

407 409 410

14 Organization and execution of marketing

415

Introduction 14.1 Marketing and personnel 14.1.1 Relation between marketing and personnel 14.1.2 Internal branding 14.1.3 Leadership 14.1.4 Labor market communication 14.2 Organization of marketing and communication 14.2.1 Part time marketer 14.2.2 Organization of marketing 14.2.3 Organization of communication 14.3 Performance projection and selling the plan 14.3.1 Performance projection 14.3.2 Selling the plan: internal marketing 14.3.3 Template for marketing plan summary 14.4 Implementation of the plans 14.4.1 Guidelines for implementation 14.4.2 Concluding tips for strategic marketing Summary Unilever: business with a purpose

416 416 416 417 418 420 421 421 422 424 427 427 428 431 432 432 434 434 435

Literature441 Index449

Preface to the second edition

This second edition appears five years after the first edition. This does not seem to be a long period; however, the world has dramatically changed since then. The coronavirus, wars, #meetoo, and especially sustainability are more important than ever. Although climate change has already been known about for decades, it looks like only recently have humans realized that the Earth is not infinite in room for all of us. In 2023 the IPCC published alarming conclusions about the slow disaster coming to all of us. What does this have to do with marketing? A lot. Marketing is the key discipline within organizations to influence consumer behavior, and this behavior should be more sustainable, just like the behavior of organizations themselves. So, I think brands should take the lead in this. Marketing can be helpful in this respect instead of having the image of stimulating too much unsustainable consumption. Both organizations who do regular business and now also have to be and act more sustainable as well as organizations who have stimulating sustainable consumer behavior as a main task (such as governmental organizations and NGOs) can and should use marketing to do this. This second edition of Strategic Marketing Planning can help with this. It still is about regular strategic marketing planning but now with explicit attention to sustainability in all stages of marketing: culture, research, strategy, and tactics. It is my wish that in the end, this will also improve the image of marketing itself. A number of adjustments have been made in this second edition without changing the structure. An overview of all adjustments can be found after the contents. As in the first edition, digital marketing is integrated in all phases. This also happens with sustainability in this edition. Chapter 1 discusses the specific characteristics and challenges of sustainable consumer behavior. Sustainability then recurs in many phases of this book, now including our Brand Benefitting Model, a model that plays an even more prominent role in this edition, based on an even clearer definition of customer value. Some specific new topics such as inclusive marketing and customer experience management are also covered. In the section on brand positioning, the models are arranged more logically. Simplifications have also been made, as with the internal analysis, which now consists of four steps. The topics of crisis communication and influencer marketing have been rewritten. In addition, the case material has been updated in this edition, and examples about corona have also been included.

xvi  Preface to the second edition

Preface for the first edition This book describes the current thinking on strategic marketing from a how-to perspective. The theory of strategic marketing is presented in steps. Those steps can be followed to arrive at a strategic marketing plan. This book has a combination of five attributes that make it different from other marketing strategy books. First, it deals only with strategic marketing. Therefore, there are no separate chapters devoted to consumer behavior, market research, or each of the marketing instruments (the 4 P’s are dealt with in two chapters). The second attribute is the process approach. The third attribute relates to what the author feels is important in marketing: customers and brands. A customer and brand orientation is followed throughout the book: in the analysis, in choosing options, in developing marketing strategy, and in implementation. The fourth attribute is that in many places in the book, strategic guidelines are given: what to do and what not to do in marketing practice. Finally, there is much attention to tools and techniques that can be helpful in the planning process. In summary, this book combines an academic and applied approach of strategic marketing planning. The book is primarily targeted at students with a basic knowledge of marketing. Thus, the relevant target groups are undergraduates in the third or fourth year and some MBAs. The book can be used in, for example, courses in marketing strategy or marketing management. The book can also be used in executive teaching and by marketing practitioners who are looking for academic support for their daily decision making. The book consists of four parts, including 14 chapters, with each chapter being a step in the strategic marketing planning process: Part 1  Introduction and marketing planning   1 The essence of marketing   2 The strategic marketing planning process Part 2  Situation analysis   3   4   5   6   7   8   9

Mission, customer values, and market definition Internal analysis Customer analysis Industry analysis Competitor analysis Distribution and supplier analysis SWOT analysis

Part 3  Corporate decisions and marketing decisions 10 Corporate objectives and strategies 11 Marketing objectives and marketing strategies Part 4  Implementation 12 Choice of product/service, price, and channels 13 Marketing communications 14 Organization and execution of marketing

Preface to the second edition xvii

Each chapter starts with key points and an illustrative case with questions. Throughout the text, many examples are included, most of them in separate boxes, enabling readers to concentrate on the theory, the examples, or both. Each chapter ends with a summary. This book tries to reduce the gap between strategic marketing theory and marketing practice. The main message is that you should ask yourself continuously what effect your company’s behavior has on potential customers. For example, you might ask: How does my amusing commercial score on brand recall? Or: Do more brand extensions reduce or increase customers’ confusion? Things like this have to do with the attitude of the manager and also with the way the planning process is done. Both aspects receive attention in this book. The content of the book is the result of continuously wondering whether strategic marketing issues are and should be applicable in marketing practice. However, there is no ‘truth’. Science by definition is a matter of asking questions, and a field as young as marketing science is only at the beginning of the process of finding the ‘truth’. It is my hope that the ideas in this book not only lead to better marketing decision making but also lead to the asking of better marketing questions. I would greatly appreciate it if you, as my customer, make me part of your ongoing needs and perceptions with regard to this book. Karel Jan Alsem Hanze University of Applied Sciences Groningen March 2023

Acknowledgments

The book is an updated and revised version of its Dutch counterpart, which is now in its ninth edition. First, I thank my Dutch publisher, Noordhoff, for permitting me to do this international version. Second, I owe many thanks to Erik Kostelijk for preparing the starting cases and questions. I thank my publisher, Routledge, for publishing the book. Finally, I would like to acknowledge the feedback I received from the following reviewers. Their thoughtful reviews are greatly appreciated: n n n n

Dr. Scott Dacko Dr. Erica Brady Dr. Robert Essig Dr. Kathy-Ann Fletcher

Finally, I would like to thank our quartet Tom, Sophie, Anne, and Floor (aged 31, 31, 29, and 27, respectively) for keeping their father sharp and young. And, of course, I am extremely grateful to my cobrand Cato for being an infinite source of positive support. Karel Jan Alsem Haren, March 2023

Part I

Introduction and marketing planning 1 2

The essence of marketing The strategic marketing planning process

Strategic marketing planning aims to bridge the gap between the theory and practice of strategic marketing. It describes how a company (or brand) can go through the strategic marketing planning process and how marketing decisions can be made from an analysis of the brand and the environment. We opt for a step-by-step approach description of the activities that a company must carry out in the context of strategic marketing. These activities can be divided into analysis, strategy, and tactics/implementation. The applications of the marketing principles described are not limited to (commercial) markets for food; durable goods, such as cars; and services, such as banks. Precisely because marketing in general aims to improve the relationships between a provider and target groups, the process also applies to healthcare, charities, regions, and other less profit-oriented markets, for example. This book consists of four parts and thus follows the central CAST model (marketing as Culture, Analysis, Strategy and Tactics). The introductory Part 1 describes the principles of marketing (‘marketing as culture’) and the marketing planning process. The marketing planning process is then discussed step by step: each step is a chapter: in 12 steps (Chapters 3 to 14), you develop a marketing plan. Part 2 is devoted to strategic analyses. Our starting point here is that without thorough, systematic situation analysis, finding a successful strategy is more luck than wisdom. Part 3 is devoted to strategy formation, with a strong focus on branding and positioning decisions. Part 4 contains the translation (including communication) and implementation

DOI: 10.4324/9781003381488-1

2  INTRODUCTION AND MARKETING PLANNING

of the strategic decisions in tactics. Parts 2, 3, and 4 correspond to the basic parts of a marketing plan: n a ‘marketing report’ (analysis results; Part 2) n a strategic marketing plan (long-term decisions; Part 3) n a tactical (and operational) marketing plan (elaboration of the market instruments

for one year; Part 4)

All marketing activities must be carried out with a purpose: to create (long-term) value for the customer and society with a recognizable brand image. Based on this goal (customer/ society and brand), not only are activities described, but practical advice is also given. The book can be used to develop a marketing plan but can also serve as a guide for taking a closer look at your own marketing policy. Part 1 of this book contains an introduction. In Chapter 1, we first discuss the importance of marketing and what marketing actually entails. Chapter 2 outlines the entire strategic marketing planning process that a company can follow to arrive at a marketing plan. The planning process is the common thread running through the book.

Chapter 1

The essence of marketing

Key points in this chapter n Outline what marketing is and describe how marketing developed, along with

new visions about consumer behavior.

n Introduce marketing (customer and brand) as the key to developing custom-

ers’ relationship with a brand.

n Describe aggregation levels in organizations. n Stress the importance of a sustainable competitive advantage.

Introduction This book covers the concept of strategic marketing from the customer and brand perspective. It is done step by step, leading to a marketing plan for a brand. Following the route, the reader will be confronted with different theories and models, each of them contributing to the marketing plan. There are no side paths, such as a separate chapter about consumer behavior. This introductory chapter is devoted to the importance and content of marketing. We start with an outline of the context in which marketing exists, why marketing is increasingly important, and which important developments must be taken into account. Subsequently, in Section 1.2, we indicate what we actually mean by marketing. We also see the hierarchy and developments in the marketing concept, including the relevance of sustainability. Finally, in Section 1.3, we discuss some forms of marketing and the relationship of marketing with other business functions.

1.1 The changing landscape of marketing In this section we describe types of trends in marketing, online behavior and digital marketing, and the marketing spiral. Then the unconscious consumer and the role of emotion are discussed, and we conclude with sustainability. DOI: 10.4324/9781003381488-2

4  INTRODUCTION AND MARKETING PLANNING

1.1.1  Types of trends In anticipation of the next section, we first note that marketing is mainly about customer-oriented action based on a clear brand identity. Marketing is one discipline or ‘function’, as are finance, human resources management, and information and communication technology (ICT). All these business functions have to do with a dynamic environment. This is often referred to by the acronym VUCA: an environment that is volatile, uncertain, complex, and ambiguous. In this section, we outline several developments (‘trends’) that have (or have had) an influence on marketing. We distinguish three types of trends: 1 2 3

Trends initiated by ‘providers’/organizations Trends in consumer behavior (demand side) Trends in research/knowledge

The first two types of trends strongly influence each other. As we’ll see later in this book, consumers often don’t know what they want and latent needs don’t surface until they’re ‘invented’ by a company. We now outline the following developments/trends: 1 Online and digital marketing 2 The marketing spiral 3 The unconscious consumer 4 Sustainability In addition to these trends, there have been all kinds of other developments, such as the coronavirus, international conflicts, more attention to diversity, more equal treatment of women (#metoo), and much more. These are part of the macro-environmental analysis and are not discussed here. We chose the previous because they are directly related to marketing.

1.1.2  Online behavior and digital marketing The arrival and development of the online world (from the early 1990s) has undoubtedly been the most important groundbreaking development for marketing in the past 40 years. Consumers’ search and choice behavior largely takes place online. But the internet has also produced many new products and services, such as new intermediaries between traditional providers and consumers, such as Booking.com, but also new services such as Uber (including taxi, delivery), Airbnb (accommodation), Takeaway (meal delivery), Picnic (online supermarket), Gorillas (speed delivery), and Check (sharing scooters). These intermediaries’ can be regarded as new ‘retailers’.

THE ESSENCE OF MARKETING 5

Case 1.1  New online retailers

Uber extended its portfolio Uber Eats is an online food ordering and delivery platform launched by Uber in 2014. Meals are delivered by couriers using cars, scooters, bikes, or on foot. It is operational in over 6,000 cities across 45 countries as of 2021.

With the advent of the internet, the availability of information has also increased enormously. More and more information about brands is becoming available to consumers. This mainly concerns experience data (i.e. reviews). Reviews often play an important role in purchasing decisions, and consumer reviews appear to be even more important than official reviews (Ghimire et al., 2022). Due to the arrival of social media, the distribution of information is also faster than ever: a (re)action by a consumer can be disseminated at lightning speed via, for example, Twitter. Much is written about social media. But what makes social media special? It ensures that people’s opinions can be spread rapidly among large groups of other people. So it is, as it were, an extreme form of what has been known for decades as ‘word of mouth’. If word of mouth in the past indeed had to go from mouth to mouth (singular), nowadays one interesting tweet from someone can quickly reach thousands of others. And if there are also journalists who find it interesting to report this in ‘classical’ media such as a newspaper, then it goes twice as fast. The consequence of this rapid form of word of mouth is that the power of consumers is increasing. Companies therefore have to watch out for reputation problems and will have to deal with customer wishes even more carefully than before. The online behavior of consumers means that the position of retailers (‘shops’) is under pressure. It is said that retailers must provide more ‘experience’. Because the internet is so important, marketing related to it is often referred to as ‘online marketing’ or ‘digital marketing’. We make three comments on this.

6  INTRODUCTION AND MARKETING PLANNING

The first comment we make on these designations is that we believe that the use of online channels is a normal part of marketing. Actually, (separate) online marketing does not exist. This already applies to young people: they have been brought up online and therefore do not know anything else. Nevertheless, we consider it important to define the concept of online marketing at this point, because a lot of attention is paid to it in theory and practice nowadays. We see online marketing by definition as part or subset of ‘ordinary’ marketing. So what is it exactly? We now consider both parts of this concept: first the designation ‘online’ and then the designation ‘marketing’. Online means that you are active on the internet. However, for some ‘online-like’ applications, you don’t always have to be online, for example, when using apps on your phone. In marketing, too, some activities, such as analyzing ‘big data’, are partly based on online behavior but not limited to that. Moreover, the analysis itself does not require the internet. That is why the term ‘digital marketing’ is often used, which is a slightly broader concept than online marketing and includes everything that has to do with online-related media and applications. Following the scientific literature, we also use the term ‘digital marketing’. Then the word ‘marketing’. A well-known part of digital marketing is ‘optimizing’ a website so that it is found quickly (search engine optimization [SEO]). The use of social media, such as a YouTube channel, is another example. What is striking about examples of online marketing is that they often concern online communication. But the internet is not only a communication channel; it is increasingly also a sales channel (‘e-commerce’). Products sold via the internet are both physical products (e.g. electronics) and services (e.g. holidays, hotel reservations). Which brings us to the definition of digital marketing. Digital marketing therefore encompasses much more than just online communication. In fact, all phases of marketing (research, marketing strategy, marketing tactics) have digital aspects and applications. Digital aspects therefore recur in many chapters in this book as part of (ordinary) marketing.

1.1.3  Marketing spiral Even before the arrival of the internet, and certainly afterwards, there has been increasing competition between brands. This is visible in all four marketing instruments (4 Ps: product, price, place, and promotion): more products and services, more communication, more price competition, and more frequent use of multiple channels. As we show in the next section, an important starting point in marketing is to differentiate yourself from competitors. That is getting more and more difficult, especially since everyone is trying to do this. As a result of this competition, consumers see less and less differences between brands, after which brands communicate even more or come up with price offers or introduce product innovations, and so on. So there is a spiral. Figure 1.1 shows the communication spiral. All spirals together are called the marketing spiral by Nederstigt and Poiesz (2022) (Figure 1.2).

THE ESSENCE OF MARKETING 7

Brands are increasing their communication

Brand images are relatively less visible Figure 1.1 The communication spiral

Figure 1.2 The marketing spiral Source: Nederstigt and Poiesz (2022)

Consumers are confronted with many commercial signals

8  INTRODUCTION AND MARKETING PLANNING

Case 1.2 The communication spiral

Advertising offline still important Although much attention in marketing is given to online channels, ‘classical’ offline communication such as outdoor or TV advertising is still important. All signals of brands unconsciously affect brand perception in consumers’ minds. With regard to the increasing range of products and services, you could say that this is good for consumers But how happy are you when you have to choose from 40 different detergents for a shelf in a store? Consumers do sometimes get tired of that, so much choice also creates uncertainty, and you have to make a lot of effort to find out everything. The phenomenon that ‘more choice’ leads to more doubt prompted Schwartz (2004) to write his book The Paradox of Choice: Whether we buy a pair of jeans or a cup of coffee, take out a telephone contract, or choose an education, everyday decisions are increasingly complex due to the overwhelming abundance of choices.

1.1.4  The unconscious consumer and the role of emotion For years, the central principle in economics was that people act rationally. For example, if a consumer needs new shoes, he or she will collect information about possible brands, compare, choose, and buy. A classic consumer behavior model depicts these phases (Figure 1.3). It has long been recognized in marketing theory that these phases are only completed when there is high involvement. Involvement in this context means how important a consumer finds it to make a good product choice. In practice, many marketers find their products very important and sometimes think that consumers do too. Unfortunately, for

THE ESSENCE OF MARKETING 9

Case 1.3  Paradox of choice

Too much choice makes uncertain Being able to choose from many brands may seem nice for a consumer, but this also makes him/her uncertain. Sometimes a consumer likes to have a more simple situation with fewer possibilities.

Need recognition

Information search

Evaluation of alternatives

Purchase decision

Postpurchase behavior

Figure 1.3  Classic consumer behavior model

ordinary people, products and brands are often not that important at all, so there is low involvement. People with low involvement make ‘unconscious’ decisions more often than with high involvement. Much psychological and economic research therefore shows that people are largely driven by emotional and often unconscious motives instead of rational considerations. This has everything to do with the idea that people have two systems for making choices. Kahneman (2011) talks about two ‘systems’; see Figure 1.4. System 2 is the conscious system in which decisions are made in a rational manner. But system 1 is more the autonomous, unconscious choice process. With the latter, think about hearing your name in company without paying attention or going home on autopilot by bike. System 1 therefore seems to be becoming increasingly important. System 2 is especially good for long-term decisions and to counter (sometimes) overly spontaneous reactions. In economics, this view is the core of behavioral economics, for which Richard Thaler was awarded a Nobel Prize some years ago. Psychology has always been important in marketing, and the role of emotion has always been recognized. However, coupled with

10  INTRODUCTION AND MARKETING PLANNING

SYSTEM 1

Intuition & instinct

Unconscious Fast Associative Automatic pilot

SYSTEM 2

Rational thinking

Takes effort Slow Logical Lazy Indecisive

Figure 1.4 Systems 1 and 2

the fact that consumer involvement in buying brands is often low and appears to be decreasing due to ever-increasing choice, the importance of emotion and subconscious behavior cannot be overemphasized. According to some authors, more than 95% of people’s decisions are made unconsciously (Dijksterhuis, 2007). For marketers, this means, among other things, that brands must present themselves to customers in a consistent manner across the board.

1.1.5 Sustainability Let’s start with a definition of this concept. This is necessary since this term is – somewhat confusingly – used both for environmental issues (‘planet’) and for matters concerning the sustainable employability of personnel (‘people’). In this book, we choose the designation ‘sustainability’ for matters relating to the environment. In Section 11.3.4, we relate this to the Sustainable Development Goals (SDGs). There is worldwide agreement that the earth is experiencing a climate change that is already having far-reaching consequences and will have many more consequences. Major consequences are predicted for weather conditions, the water level, and the food supply (‘shortages from 2050’) and thus also for migration and stability in countries. In fact, the current generation of people is finding out that the Earth is finite. The average temperature on Earth has also been rising for ‘only’ ten years. About 50 years ago, for example, the Club of Rome already warned about this, but now that people are starting to feel the consequences (heat, rain, forest fires, energy shortages, etc.), sustainability is really starting to come to life. The challenge of dealing with this has also increased due to international conflicts from 2022 onwards. Energy prices then rose sharply, and even the availability of energy came under pressure.

THE ESSENCE OF MARKETING 11

Case 1.4  The importance of sustainability

Patagonia changes into a sustainable company A half century after founding the outdoor apparel maker Patagonia, Yvon Chouinard, the eccentric rock climber who became a reluctant billionaire with his unconventional spin on capitalism, has given the company away. Rather than selling the company or taking it public, Mr. Chouinard, his wife, and two adult children have transferred their ownership of Patagonia, valued at about $3 billion, to a specially designed trust and a nonprofit organization. They were created to preserve the company’s independence and ensure that all of its profits – some $100 million a year – are used to combat climate change and protect undeveloped land around the globe. The unusual move comes at a moment of growing scrutiny for billionaires and corporations, whose rhetoric about making the world a better place is often overshadowed by their contributions to the very problems they claim to want to solve. At the same time, Mr. Chouinard’s relinquishment of the family fortune is in keeping with his longstanding disregard for business norms and his lifelong love for the environment. ‘Hopefully this will influence a new form of capitalism that doesn’t end up with a few rich people and a bunch of poor people’, Mr. Chouinard, 83, said in an exclusive interview. ‘We are going to give away the maximum amount of money to people who are actively working on saving this planet’. Source: www.nytimes.com/2022/09/14/climate/ patagonia-climate-philanthropy-chouinard.html

12  INTRODUCTION AND MARKETING PLANNING

Sustainability is a global social issue that affects everyone and involves many business functions. The role of marketing in this is difficult. It is sometimes argued that marketing is a co-cause of unsustainable behavior, due to the supposed emphasis on (more) consumption and putting the interests of the company, the shareholder, and the manager (profit) first. In our view, however, that is not the core of marketing. Marketing is about relationships between organizations and stakeholders. And it is also important for long-term consequences and various interest groups. Marketing can actually play a positive role in stimulating sustainable behavior. This is important for organizations such as governments and interest groups but also for companies that will increasingly be held accountable for their sustainable behavior. Sustainability has also long been the subject of scientific marketing research. For a long time, the approach was to identify ‘the green consumer’ with terms such as ‘green marketing’. But Kilbourne (1998) already indicated, some 25 years ago, partly on the basis of empirical research (including Kilbourne & Alsem, 1997), that a more macro perspective is needed to avert the ecological crisis. Kotler (2011) argued for ‘reinventing marketing with sustainability in mind’. Whether this has actually happened now, we leave in the air. Here we discuss some important aspects of sustainable consumer behavior: n What is sustainable consumer behavior? n What is the problem with consumer behavior? n Which factors play a role in sustainable consumer behavior?

We base this largely on the state-of-the-art paper by White et al. (2019) entitled ‘How to SHIFT Consumer Behaviors to Be More Sustainable: A Literature Review and Guiding Framework’.

Definition of sustainable consumer behavior Sustainable consumer behavior differs fundamentally from ‘ordinary’ consumer behavior in a number of respects. Two dimensions are often mentioned, along which major differences exist. The first is short versus long term. The second is the target group perspective: is it the consumer him- or herself or also other stakeholders? In short, the core of sustainable consumer behavior is that it concerns consumption behavior that has no adverse consequences for others in the long term. So you should not burden others with the negative effects of your consumption behavior.

Problem with sustainable consumer behavior Many studies show that people find sustainability very important. But, unfortunately, there is a big gap in the behavior of these same people. Finding sustainability important does not always lead to sustainable behavior. Nederstigt and Poiesz (2022) also show the well-known consumer behavior triangle with ‘motivation, capacity and opportunity’ at the corners (Figure 1.5). You could say that the motivation is there. Capacity has to do with one’s own possibilities and with the opportunity to actually do something. There are limitations in both areas. It is often the case that sustainable alternatives are even more expensive than

THE ESSENCE OF MARKETING 13

Motivation

Behavior

Opportunity

Capacity

Figure 1.5  The consumer behavior triangle

non-sustainable, for example, vegetarian food. And not everyone can afford to buy a heat pump or electric car. At the same time, everyone can take the bike more often for shorter distances instead of the car, take a shorter shower, or turn down the heating a bit. So there is more at play. We’ll get into that now.

Factors influencing sustainable consumption behavior In their study, White et al. (2019) developed the SHIFT model. According to this model, five categories of factors influence sustainable behavior: 1 2 3 4 5

Social influence: social norms, social identity, and social desirability. Habit formation. Individual self: ‘self-concept, self-consistency, self-interest, self-efficacy, and personal norms’. For example, people who are younger, more liberal, or better educated are more likely to engage in environmentally friendly behavior. Feelings and cognitions: two routes to action: more conscious or intuitive, cognitive or based on (negative and positive) emotions, learning and framing. Tangibility: the problem with sustainable consumption is that people first feel the burden (e.g. higher costs), while the benefits are only realized in the long term, in the future. It is important to make these future benefits tangible in today’s consumption.

According to the authors, the SHIFT model can be used to close the gap between attitude and behavior that often exists in sustainable contexts. If barriers lie mainly in the social factors, an opportunity is to communicate the behavior of others. Often there will be several obstacles, and combining ‘interventions’ will therefore be more effective. The extent to which an obstacle is important depends on the personal context of the citizen. Both personality aspects and social influences can play a role in this. Because marketing and sustainability are closely linked, this book will include sustainability in all phases of marketing (culture, analysis, strategy, tactics).

14  INTRODUCTION AND MARKETING PLANNING

1.2 What is marketing? Many people think of marketing as advertising and sales. But that is not the core of marketing as we envision it. In this section we first show that the concept of marketing can be interpreted in three (related) ways (Section 1.2.1). We then describe the development of the concept of marketing to the present day. We distinguish three development phases in marketing: up to the 1990s (Section 1.2.2), between 1990 and 2010 (Section 1.2.3), and from 2010 (Section 1.2.4). We end in Section 1.2.5 with some conclusions.

1.2.1  The concept of marketing The concept of marketing can be interpreted in different ways (Webster, 1992, 2005): 1

As a organizational culture (the marketing concept or vision): a set of beliefs that directs the organization in such a way that there is a commitment to meeting the needs of the customer in order to be profitable in the long term. In short: the customer comes first. Later in this chapter we argue that the brand identity should also be at the core of the marketing concept. 2 As a strategy: choosing target groups and positioning the products and services (STP: segmenting, targeting, and positioning). As input for strategy development, a Strengths, Weaknesses, Opportunities, Threats (SWOT) analysis is required: linking internal strengths and weaknesses to external opportunities and threats. 3 As tactics and activities: the daily activities around the four market instruments product development, pricing, distribution, and channel choice and around communication. In this classification we therefore state that the handling of the four market instruments (the 4 Ps) is a tactical matter: short-term decisions for, say, a year. This is a simplification of reality, because we agree with Varadarajan (2010) that many 4P decisions can also be strategic and thus have consequences for several years. Despite the fact that Figure 1.6 does not accurately represent reality, the figure is very clear for educational purposes. Figure 1.6 is called the CAST model (culture, analytics, strategy, tactics) and basically represents a hierarchy in marketing theory. The highest level (culture) describes the core of what marketing is concerned with: customers and brands. The three stages below are the three concrete steps that are taken in marketing. That’s first: analytics and research. Next is a thorough choice of the (marketing) strategy: target group and positioning. The choice of marketing strategy determines the direction for step 3: the development of marketing as a tactic. The three meanings of marketing are therefore logically in line with each other. The highest level of this, the marketing concept, has traditionally had the customer at its core. Now that marketing concept itself has undergone several developments over the years, partly prompted by increasing knowledge about consumer behavior. We distinguish the following phases (Kotler, 2011): n Marketing 1.0: customer wishes and competitive advantages n Marketing 2.0: relationships and emotions n Marketing 3.0: social and societal interests

For each of these forms of marketing, the new needs come in addition to the previous ones.

THE ESSENCE OF MARKETING 15

Marketing as a culture Customer orientation and brand orientation

Analyses Internal and external

Marketing as a strategy Targeting and positioning

Marketing as tactics 4 Ps: Product, price, place, promotion (+personnel) Figure 1.6  Marketing hierarchy (CAST model)

1.2.2  Marketing 1.0: customer needs and competition It is not entirely clear when marketing was ‘invented’. The top journal Journal of Marketing was founded in 1936. In any case, marketing seems to have become more and more well known since the 1960s. One of the international founders of marketing science is Philip Kotler, who published the first edition of the standard work Marketing Management in 1967. As stated in Section 1.2.1, according to the ‘classic’ marketing concept, the customer is central. This external orientation is an important difference with many other business economic disciplines, such as finance, organizational science, human resources management, and business development. An important starting point of marketing is the needs of customers.

Strategic marketing concept In the 1980s, the realization arose that customer orientation alone is not enough to be successful. It is also necessary to be better than the competition: only by achieving a sustainable competitive advantage can a company continue to operate profitably in the longer term. Competition was already increasing sharply at that time, partly due to less favorable economic developments in that period. A well-known author who propagated the competitive idea was Porter (1980). All in all, a marketing concept emerged that can be referred to as the strategic marketing concept (Day & Wensley, 1983). The strategic marketing concept actually forms an extension of the classic marketing concept and states that a company must meet the following conditions: n The company must be customer oriented. n The company must focus on realizing sustainable competitive advantages of prod-

ucts in markets (for example: lower price, better service, better design).

16  INTRODUCTION AND MARKETING PLANNING

n The organization must also have an eye for other target groups, especially retailers. n In addition, it is important that the company make a profit in order to survive in the

long term.

Market orientation The aforementioned points of attention largely correspond to what is referred to in the marketing literature as market orientation. Market orientation consists of the following components (Narver & Slater, 1990; Kohli & Jaworski, 1990): n Customer-oriented thinking (customer orientation). Does the company make rea-

sonable promises and keep them? Are customers treated as individuals? Are the wishes and opinions of the target group specifically explored by means of market research? And if so, does that have consequences for trading in the company? n Competitive thinking (competitor orientation). Does the company have a lot of information about individual competitors? Is that information systematically analyzed and distributed throughout the organization? Does the company know when to respond to competitor actions and how to differentiate itself from competitors? n Interfunctional coordination (interfunctional orientation) or integrated decisionmaking: Does the organization share information internally? Are the strategies for the various functional areas integrated? Are joint decisions made? Is the entire organization genuinely interested in customers? Putting customer wishes first still applies and can still be improved in many organizations, say Verhoef and Lemon (2013), who introduce the concept of customer value management and introduce various ways, including the smart use of data, to make customer value really play a role.

1.2.3  Marketing 2.0: emotions, relationships, experiences, and brands In the 1990s, two expansions of the marketing concept were introduced, mainly prompted by the realization that consumers do not only make decisions ‘cognitively’ but that emotions and subconscious decisions play a major role in them (see Section 1.1). This led to attention to ‘experiences’, relationships, customer loyalty, and the brand. The logical connection between experiences (in a broad sense) and brand thinking is that a clear brand identity is necessary (but not sufficient) to build relationships with customers.

Relationships In this context it has been stated that it is no longer about (one-off) transaction-oriented marketing but about relationship marketing (Gummesson, 1987, 1999; Webster, 1992) or direct marketing (DM): obtaining and maintaining a structural, direct relationship between a supplier and the customer (Hoekstra, 2003). This also includes thinking in terms of customer satisfaction and customer loyalty. A frequently mentioned thought

THE ESSENCE OF MARKETING 17

is that it is cheaper to focus on existing customers than on new customers (Reichheld, 1993, 1996). They differ in cost by a factor of five. Whether this factor is correct, we leave unexplored. However, it is logical to assume that someone who is already a customer, by definition, thinks more positively about the company than someone who is not a customer. Indeed, that makes it likely that customer retention is more efficient than new customer retention. A focus on customer retention can therefore be defended and is also in line with the marketing idea of customer focus. Of course, a company cannot do without attracting new customers, simply because customers are always disappearing. Incidentally, there is a danger in relationship marketing, namely doing your best too intensively and therefore too intrusively trying to make a customer your ‘friend’. Then it becomes ‘sales’ again. Later, Vargo and Lusch (2004) came to an appropriate interpretation of the marketing concept by emphasizing the service aspect of marketing: every marketer should see him- or herself as a service provider and should therefore also be prepared to provide an appropriate service to customers instead of focusing too much on the product. In fact, this is about realizing a customer-oriented attitude. This can only be achieved by the people in the organization itself. Everyone in the organization must therefore be interested in the customer (Gummesson, 1991, 1998). The idea of service is thus very close to the idea of relationship marketing (Ravald & Grönroos, 1996).

Experiences Experiences are the experiences people have with brands. Brakus et al. (2009) define ‘brand experience’ as ‘subjective, internal consumer reactions and behavioral reactions, elicited by brand-related stimuli such as packaging, communication, environments and personal contacts’. The authors show that brand experience consists of four dimensions: sensory, affective, intellectual, and behavioral. Experience is therefore not necessarily about ‘spectacular’ experiences but simply about the total of impressions that a consumer experiences with a brand through all senses. Most clearly, ‘experiences’ play a role in stores, for example. When you walk through an Apple store, you ‘experience’ the brand in every way. But you also experience a brand through other channels, such as a video on YouTube. Verhoef et al. (2019) show in a review article that the sum total of all cognitive, affective, social, and physical experiences is important. And that brings us naturally to the brand and its positioning because they form the starting point of all those experiences. Figure 1.7 shows the relationships between the topics of this section.

Brand thinking Also in the 1990s, we saw the emergence of brand thinking in marketing. This has to do with three aspects: 1

Emotions. We already mentioned it: in humans, ‘system 1’ is often decisive. Brands will have to respond to this. In communication, for example, not only do physical product properties have to be emphasized, but emotional associations also have to be linked to the brand.

18  INTRODUCTION AND MARKETING PLANNING

Experiences with the brand

Emotions and unconscious behavior (‘system 1’)

Brand thinking: positioning and taking initiatives Relations with the brand

Figure 1.7  Emotions and the brand

2

3

Customers often don’t know what new things they want. In a video clip made at the end of the 1990s, people clearly state that they have no need for a mobile phone (‘Then I’ll write a letter’; ‘Imagine being called on my bicycle, terrible’.) Ideas for innovations will therefore often have to come from a company itself. You could also say: companies must respond to the latent needs of consumers and therefore have a long-term vision. Customers may have wishes that do not fit the brand. If there is a need for insurance from Unilever, should Unilever provide it? No, because that doesn’t suit Unilever. This point has to do with the brand identity of a company. Day (1999) rightly warns that a company can be too customer oriented. This in turn has to do with the so-called resource-based view (Wernerfelt, 1984). Also according to this view, a strategy should mainly be based on what a company is good at, the core competences (Prahalad & Hamel, 1990; Srivastava et al., 1998). Hooley et al. (1998, 2004) are among the few authors who suggest combining the resource-based view with marketing. They call this resource-based marketing.

From the theory of the marketing hierarchy as described here, there is also an objection to a complete focus on the customer. Indeed, it would be inconsistent if the hierarchical model focused exclusively on the demand side at the highest level and the supply side was added at lower levels. So, also for logical reasons, marketing as a culture must also explicitly name the supply side. This is best done by including the brand identity in the core concept of marketing. Attention to ‘the brand’ and ‘branding’ has been widely available in marketing literature, especially since the 1990s (Aaker, 1991, 1995; Keller, 1993; Keller & Swaminathan, 2019). But including the supply side through the brand in the core concept of marketing is unusual. In our opinion, organizations that subscribe to a marketing orientation (‘culture’) should focus on two things: customer needs and brand identity. An organization strives to deliver customer value and to build a strong brand. Alsem and Kostelijk (2008) introduced this and referred to it as identity marketing, but it is in fact ‘ordinary’ marketing (see Figure 1.8). In practice, things often go wrong on two sides of Figure 1.8: n There is too little attention for the customer: does it really make him or her happy?

Fournier et al. (1998) refer in this context to the ‘end of relationship marketing’.

n Too little attention is paid to brand identity: do we make choices that fit well with

our identity, and are we consistent?

THE ESSENCE OF MARKETING 19

Resource-based view Competitive advantage flows from superior skills and competences

Essence of marketing Supply Brand identity

Demand Customer needs

New marketing concept Culture of the company is aimed at balancing customer needs and brand identity Figure 1.8  New marketing paradigm according to Alsem, Kostelijk (2008)

Figure 1.9  Identity and needs

The identity of a brand versus the wishes of customers The identity of a brand and the wishes of customers have been described as separate constructs, but it is important to note that they can reinforce and influence each other. The mutual reinforcement lies in the fact that if a brand is recognizable to customers, a form of trust can more easily arise. Also, according to Morgan and Hunt (1994), trust is an essential factor in relationship marketing. Relationships and brand identity therefore belong together. There is also a dynamic relationship between customer wishes and brand identity (see Figure 1.9). This dynamic goes both ways. First, consumers learn from new products from companies. Apparently consumers sometimes don’t even need certain products at all, but as soon as they are there, everyone wants them anyway! Earlier we mentioned the example of the mobile phone. It may have been Steve Jobs’s strength that he ‘sensed’ what potential needs people had without them being aware of it. In short: there is an influence of a ‘brand identity’ (translated as products) on the wishes of consumers. At the same time, there is an influence that runs in the opposite direction. New needs may arise that companies can respond to. It is said that people are increasingly in need of convenience. So organizations can try to make people’s lives easier. A company like Kodak was too slow to respond to the growing need for digital photography (invented by them, after all). Philips, on the other hand, has regularly adapted and has even divested the activity with which this company once started (lightning).

20  INTRODUCTION AND MARKETING PLANNING

Studies: Sharp and the importance of brand awareness The importance of the brand is also empirically supported. In some publications worth reading, Byron Sharp of the London Business School summarizes various studies he has done on brand choices based on many databases with actual purchase data (Sharp, 2010; Romaniuk & Sharp, 2015). The most important conclusion from all these studies is the great importance of brand awareness. Sharp shows that consumers have a strong preference for well-known brands. Moreover, it appears that information about, for example, quality plays much less of a role. For example, Sharp shows that brands that are similar in the perception of consumers compete with each other much less directly than you would expect on the basis of those perceptions. The size of a brand plays a dominant role in the preferred position a brand has in the minds of consumers. Not only is the mental availability of a brand (communication) important, so is its physical availability (distribution). One explanation for the findings of Sharp et al. lies in the low level of involvement that consumers generally have when purchasing products. We already mentioned this in Section 1.1: people usually do not get very involved in brands. Seen in this way, it is logical that consumers are mainly guided in their choice of a brand by the simple fact that they know a brand: in other words, brand awareness, probably with the thought: I know that brand, in any case, and if it is so well known, it is probably good. A good example of such a brand is Heineken. As a beer brand, Heineken will probably have a high brand awareness worldwide, almost 100% in many countries. However, the question is how this brand is doing with ‘unique associations’. The point is that Heineken has had quite a variety of advertising campaigns in recent decades. Some campaigns were also quite generic, with slogans such as ‘Biertje? Heineken!’ So the question is how consistent and unique Heineken is in its brand communication. Nevertheless, Heineken is the global market leader in beer. One reason for this may be that it is ‘simply the tastiest beer’. Certainly for the beer category, however, it has been shown that emotion is much more decisive for brand choices than the actual product characteristics. A simple blind test (‘do this at home!’) will be able to demonstrate this: with a brand name, completely different preferences emerge than without a brand name. The explanation is probably that Heineken has both a high recognition and yet also evokes a ‘good feeling’, which is the result of all visible behavior of the brand. That good feeling apparently ties in with the subconscious choices consumers make when choosing brands. While the findings of Sharp et al. seem logical, there is an academic debate about the importance of brand image at this point. In an award-winning paper, Pauwels and Ewijk (2013) show that both ‘soft’ metrics that measure attitude (i.e. the strength of associations) and ‘hard’ data about consumer online behavior are good predictors of final sales. So brand image, which goes beyond brand awareness, does matter. Hanssens (2015) shows that the average advertising elasticity is only about 0.1, which does not indicate that strong media pressure has a major influence on sales. Our conclusion from this dispute about the relevance of image is that both brand awareness and brand image are important.

THE ESSENCE OF MARKETING 21

1.2.4  Marketing 3.0: society and other interest groups We have already considered the challenges of sustainability. Since roughly 2010, increasing attention has been paid to this problem in marketing. Kotler (2011) wrote an intro about this in a special issue of the Journal of Marketing. Interestingly enough, it is precisely this famous Kotler who much earlier (around 1971) introduced so-called ‘social marketing’ (‘the societal marketing concept’) and ‘demarketing’. Social marketing involves the marketing of an idea (e.g. anti-smoking campaigns) or charity (e.g. nature conservation) or other socially relevant ‘products’. In the context of sustainability, it is of course about the environment but also about personnel policy, although in this book, as mentioned earlier, we focus on sustainability with regard to the environment. Demarketing is understood to mean encouraging a reduction in the question of what is or can be applied (flying?) in the context of, for example, energy consumption and other environmentally harmful behavior. Social marketing therefore automatically involves many more target groups than just consumers. Hillebrand et al. (2015) speak of stakeholder marketing in this context. Porter and Kramer (2011) introduced the concept of shareholder value: companies should expand their business model by providing value to society. So you could say that the foundations for ‘marketing 3.0’ were laid a long time ago but have only emerged strongly since 2010 and more recently since 2022. In a special issue of the Journal of Marketing, Kumar (2018) and other authors rightly state that the implementation of marketing will have to change significantly. Kumar uses the term ‘transformative marketing’ for this. Another term is ‘purpose marketing’. But just as with ‘digital marketing’, sustainability must also be part of ‘ordinary marketing’. We will therefore not use a new term for this ourselves. Digitization and sustainability are simply part of marketing.

1.2.5  Conclusion and marketing as an activity Figure 1.10 summarizes the developments in the marketing concept. For the aforementioned developments in marketing, matters do not replace the foregoing but are added. In concrete terms, this means that in 2023 the core of the marketing concept can be defined as follows: Organizations that follow marketing as a culture in the organization are concerned with meeting (latent) functional, emotional and social needs of target groups, better than competitors, based on a strong brand identity. True customer focus and brand thinking are leading. Value must be delivered for the company, the customer, and society (Figure 1.11). We have presented marketing as culture (umbrella concept), strategy, and tactics. We also indicated that analyses and research form the basis for strategic decisions (CAST model). To be as concrete as possible about what marketing practically entails, it is good to indicate which activities fall under marketing. These are three steps (the ‘AST’ from the CAST model): 1 2 3

Perform analyses/research Marketing strategic choices Marketing tactics

22  INTRODUCTION AND MARKETING PLANNING

Period

Assumption about

Marketing concept

Emphasis on:

Marketing 1.0:

Customer needs

Classic and strategic

Competitive

marketing

advantages

Marketing 2.0:

Relationships

Relationship marketing

Experiences

and identity marketing

Brands

Marketing 3.0:

Social and societal

Social or

challenges

transformative

Other interest groups

consumer behavior Until about

Functional needs

1990 1990-2010

2010-present

Emotional consumer

Sustainable consumer

marketing

Figure 1.10 Developments in the marketing concept

Society (welfare of humans)

Marketing 3.0

Customer (fulfill needs) Figure 1.11 Values according to marketing

Company (profit/viability)

THE ESSENCE OF MARKETING 23

We then define marketing as an activity as follows: Marketing is, based on careful analyses of the market and one’s own organization, choosing a distinctive range of products/services that meet the needs of customers, partners, and society and marketing those products/services through brand-oriented choices of prices, communication, and channels and through brand-oriented management of the personnel. Figure 1.12 summarizes the core of marketing. The interests of society are now subsumed under those of customers, in accordance with the Brand Benefitting Model to be discussed later in this book. The American Marketing Association (AMA), a very reputable marketing institute, defines marketing as: Marketing is the activity, set of institutions, and processes for creating, communicating, delivering, and exchanging offerings that have value for customers, clients, partners, and society at large. All in all, four ‘stakeholders’ are important in marketing: 1 2 3 4

the organization itself: a suitable identity customer groups: delivering customer values society: no burden for future generations personnel: social policy

For these target groups, the first two form the core of marketing, but the third always plays a role. With regard to personnel, the human resources management business function is primarily responsible for this.

1.3 Marketing in organizations Given the content of marketing outlined previously, several conclusions can be drawn about the relationships with other parts of the organization and also about the application of marketing in markets.

1.3.1  Marketing and other functions in the organization The decisions made show that strategic marketing planning is a very important part of strategic management. In particular, the choice of the markets in which it wishes to be active is a very important decision for a company, which therefore forms the core of the company’s strategy. The proposals for and information about these decisions are provided by the marketing functional area. It also appears that the aforementioned components of strategic marketing have implications for other functional areas. The field of strategic marketing is therefore not separate from other functional areas. In fact, due to the aforementioned environmental developments, not only marketing itself but also the internal coordination of marketing with other functions within the company is becoming increasingly important. Figure 1.13 shows which relationships between marketing and other parts of the company have become more important in recent years.

24  INTRODUCTION AND MARKETING PLANNING

Marketing as culture Needs customer and society

Identity brand

Essence of marketing Balancing customer needs and brand identity

Marketing as strategy

Targeting

Brand positioning

Marketing as tactics • • • • •

Product Price Place Promotion Personnel

Figure 1.12  The essence of marketing (3.0)

THE ESSENCE OF MARKETING 25

Innovation

Marketing

Internal branding

Research & Development

Part time marketeers

Human resource management

Accountability

Finance & accounting

Figure 1.13  Marketing and other functions

First of all, there is the relationship between marketing and research and development (R&D). This concerns the importance of innovation. Due to increasing customer demands and competition, creating, and maintaining a competitive advantage is becoming increasingly important, so innovation is important. Companies must constantly consider whether the product and service offering cannot be improved and renewed. Much research also shows a positive relationship between innovation and performance (see, for example: Damanpour et al., 1989; Zahra et al., 1988; Han et al., 1998). A second important relationship between marketing and another functional area is that with human resources management (HRM, the human resources department). The point here is that the people in the organization ultimately determine the external image of the organization and that without well-motivated staff, the implementation of chosen strategies is at risk (Foster et al., 2010). This is the principle of internal branding, which means that companies must ensure that all employees are sufficiently aware of the company positioning and also behave as such. Gummesson (1991) introduced the term ‘part-time marketers’ in this context to indicate that all employees should be customer oriented. A third marketing relationship that we would like to highlight is that of the Finance Department. In marketing practice and science, there is a noticeable trend of growing interest in the financial aspects of marketing: does marketing really pay for itself? This logical question is referred to as the question of the accountability of marketing (Verhoef & Leeflang, 2009). There are also journals that focus on this issue, such as the Journal of Accounting and Marketing. Van Helden and Alsem (2016) state in this journal that marketing performance should be measured with much more than financial metrics.

1.3.2  Forms of marketing The increasing importance of marketing is also reflected in the fact that marketing is being applied in more and more industries where it was not used before (see also Kotler, 2004). Examples: n Business marketing. Business marketing is defined as marketing from organization

to organization, so not directly to the final consumer, but to another company. This form of marketing is not new at all, but it receives less attention in books than

26  INTRODUCTION AND MARKETING PLANNING

n

n

n

n

consumer marketing. It can also be noted that in practice, business marketing pays a lot of attention to sales (personal sales) because establishing relationships (customer relation management [CRM]) and bringing in customers through personal contacts is in practice an important part of business marketing. However, it is important to realize that business marketing also consists of building strong brands, because ultimately buyers (‘customers’) are also people who are sensitive to branding activities. Health care marketing. The government’s policy is to achieve an increase in quality and cost reduction in healthcare by introducing (regulated) competition. Due to this increasing competition in healthcare markets, the importance of customer relationships and brand positioning is becoming increasingly important (Alsem & Klein Koerkamp, 2016). Energy branding. The use and above all the responsible use of energy increasingly require marketing and therefore also the ‘branding’ (positioning) of energy brands. A difficult but necessary challenge. Place marketing. Regions (cities, municipalities, [parts of] provinces, countries) are increasingly competing for the favors of three target groups: visitors (tourists), residents, and businesses. A clear positioning then becomes increasingly important and therefore also regional marketing (also known as city marketing or destination branding) (Anholt, 2010). Cultural marketing. This concerns a variety of services, such as museums (Tobelem, 1997), visual arts, performing arts, music, and film. Not all of these services were originally set up to be financed from the market; in fact, even with a large influx of visitors to a museum attraction (a so-called blockbuster), the income usually still does not cover the expenditure. But despite that, interest in culture is increasingly viewed critically. The aim of cultural marketing is, then, to draw more attention to the different forms of culture.

Summary Due to various environmental trends, thinking from target groups (customer focus) is becoming important for more and more organizations. The core of marketing theory (the marketing concept) has evolved along the notions of what customers’ needs actually are: primarily functional needs (marketing 1.0) but also good experiences and relationships with brands (emotional needs, marketing 2.0) and in the last few years also an interest in sustainability (marketing 3.0). Marketing as a culture nowadays also means that companies must deliver value to customers and the society that fits their own brand identity: ‘What can I do for you?’, taking into account the long-term interests of customers and society. Marketing itself is carried out in three steps. The first step consists of an analysis of the internal and external environment, in which research among customers forms the core. The second step is to determine the marketing strategy: choosing target groups and your own (brand) positioning. The third step is that form and content are given to the four market instruments (product, price, place, and communication) plus personnel from the marketing strategy. So the difference between marketing and communication is that communication is one of the market instruments, next to product, price, and place (and personnel). Marketing also includes doing research and determining a strategy. In our view, marketing is actually ‘market-oriented business’.

THE ESSENCE OF MARKETING 27

Recent developments, such as opportunities for digital marketing and an increasing importance of sustainability, have a major influence on an organization’s marketing decisions. Partly for this reason, marketing should not be isolated: cooperation with other functional areas is of great importance. Examples are: strong alignment with strategic management, pricing and accountability with finance, internal branding with HRM, and innovation with R&D.

28  INTRODUCTION AND MARKETING PLANNING

Will the engine of the rock continue to rock?

For decades, the style and the sound of the Fender Stratocaster had a strong influence on rock ‘n’ roll. But the American guitar company is facing an uncertain future. Because of the developments in music, electronics are increasingly replacing the guitar. In 1948, radio repair man Leo Fender took a piece of wood, screwed another piece of wood to it, and added an electric system. You have heard the rest of the story, even if you do not know it. You’ve heard it in the guitar riffs of Buddy Holly, Jimi Hendrix, George Harrison, Keith Richards, Eric Clapton, Pete Townsend, Bruce Springsteen, Mark Knopfler, Kurt Cobain, and so on. It is the sound of the electric Fender guitar. The Fender company, in full Fender Musical Instruments, is the world’s largest manufacturer of guitars. The Stratocaster, which came on the market in 1954, is still one of the most sold guitars. The cutting sound of the Strat stands for everything that is rock and roll. But in 2022 the heart of rock is no longer beating as it once did. A Stratocaster is expensive; it is just not one of the first necessities in life for most people. But Fender suffers from more than its price alone. The company is also plagued by the powerful guys that make the money move on Wall Street. In 2012, almost half of Fender was in the hands of the venture capitalist Weston Presidio, who wanted to sell his share for a nice price. The economy was in bad shape, and he hoped to get some of his investment back. However, the IPO went no further: investors were not convinced by the possibilities that the Fender brand could offer. After the withdrawal of the public offering, Weston Presidio sold its stock to the private equity arm of Hawaiian automotive retailer Servco Pacific, which in turn sold a portion of its stake to San Francisco’s TPG Growth. With all

THE ESSENCE OF MARKETING 29

these changes in ownership, the company experienced a rough ride and tries to look for some stability now. In the past years, Fender has made some ballsy moves. First, Fender made the move to let customers order direct from their website. In 2015, Fender launched a division called Fender Digital to focus on apps, websites, platforms, and tools. The company debuted Mod Shop, an online customization site where customers can design their own colorful guitar or bass. While the digital move is currently only limited to ‘custom-configurable’ guitars, it probably still left a bad taste in the mouths of many of the company’s dealers. Then in 2016, the company released Fender Tune, a free app that helps players tune their guitars. It is the first in what is to be a line of teaching devices the company plans to launch over the next years, according to CEO Andy Mooney. But even now, with the currently booming economy, uncertainty about the future is what makes life hard for Fender. Times have changed. In the fifties, sixties, and seventies, guitars were the engine behind all developments in pop and rock music. And the real rock ‘n’ roll enthusiast still wants this. Take Rick Barrio Dill. He is bassist of the soul and rock band Vintage Trouble and went crazy when his specially made Fender Reissue Precision bass guitar was stolen when he was on tour with the Cranberries. ‘I felt like someone had just died; I was a complete wreck’, says Dill. He reported the theft via Twitter. Before he knew it he got a message from Gibson Guitars, the big rival of Fender. The company offered him a new guitar. Dill rejected the offer. But a similar bid that Fender made him shortly after, he grabbed it with both hands. ‘Fender is flowing through my veins’, says Dill. The guitarist also collects vintage Fenders. In 1999 he bought a Tobacco sunburst Fender Jazz Bass from 1969 for 900 euros. Four years later he sold the instrument for 2,000 euros. ‘Now I try to find one again and I have to pay at least 5,000 euros for it’. However, these enthusiasts are fewer and fewer. For most musicians, even the average enthusiast, the guitars of that time have been replaced by electric turntables, drum computers, and synthesizers. Hip hoppers and rappers do not need a guitar to hit the charts. The guitars that are still sold are the lower-priced ones. The instruments are made in China and cost a fraction of the more than €1,200 that you quickly spend on a Fender ‘Eric Clapton’ Stratocaster. But with such a cheaper guitar, you can also ‘make a nice piece of music’. Fender has already outsourced part of its production to low-wage countries and, like many other guitar builders, is building simple guitars. But the profit margins on those instruments are much lower than on the showpieces of the past. The American Guitar Center, the largest musical instrument store in the world, is also experiencing difficult times, with the market turning more and more towards online shops. According to analysts, Guitar Center is crucial for Fender. No less than a sixth of the guitars that Fender sells are purchased at that instrument store. One of the big problems that Fender has to deal with, ironically enough, is Fender itself. When Fender first released its classic Stratocaster and Telecaster

30  INTRODUCTION AND MARKETING PLANNING

guitars in the 1950s, it became one of the first electric guitar manufacturers in the United States. Since then, the company has developed a reputation for high quality among professional musicians. The guitars that were produced in the sixties and seventies are much more beloved than the instruments that the company produces nowadays. Whether it is true or not, musicians have the idea that the classic Fenders have a different, more beautiful sound and are qualitatively better than the guitars that are produced nowadays. Modern techniques might make the sound of new instruments more perfect than ever, but it is the imperfections that create the classic sounds so much loved by real musicians. How to proceed with Fender is the big question. According to one of the shareholders of the company: ‘I love Fender. It is the most beautiful company in the world. We are in it for the long term and we will do what is right for Fender’. But whether the right thing is the old-fashioned guitar, the internet, or even guitar education is a question that remains unanswered.

Questions 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

Which trends affect the Fender brand? The book discusses a hierarchy in marketing: the CAST model. Illustrate this marketing hierarchy for Fender. Discuss whether the strategic marketing concept can be used by Fender. Illustrate the resource-based view by using the information about Fender in this case. Identity marketing tries to find a balance between customer needs on the one hand and brand identity on the other. Show how this ‘tension’ between supply and demand is relevant for Fender. Digital marketing is becoming increasingly relevant for any kind of business. Illustrate this for Fender. At first sight, corporate social responsibility may not seem to be of immediate concern to a brand like Fender. How could Fender profile itself with marketing 3.0 and thus appeal to the responsible consumer? Give strategic marketing advice for Fender based on the information in this case.

Chapter 2

The strategic marketing planning process Key points in this chapter n To know different levels in a company and the content of strategy at these

levels

n To know the essence of marketing strategy n To know the different steps in the marketing planning process

Introduction The previous chapter explained what marketing entails. It starts with the realization that a company must act in a customer- and brand-oriented way (culture). This requires a clear choice in target group and positioning (strategy). The strategy is then translated into an application of the four Ps (tactics). Crucial in this process is a sound choice of marketing strategy. The basis for this is laid in the internal and external analysis. In this chapter we show how to go through the entire strategic marketing planning process. But first we will discuss the different levels that exist in (large) companies (Section 2.1). We then focus on the concept of sustainable competitive advantage as part of the marketing strategy (Section 2.2). Then the phases of the planning process are discussed (Section 2.3). We conclude the chapter in Section 2.4 with a description of the various components of the marketing plan.

2.1 Levels and types of decisions in a company Several ‘levels’ can be distinguished within a (large) company, and different types of decisions are taken at each level. There are companies that limit their activities to one

DOI: 10.4324/9781003381488-3

32  INTRODUCTION AND MARKETING PLANNING

market, for example, a car manufacturer that only makes small cars for a target group. Many smaller and/or start-up companies also focus on one market. However, many companies are active in more than one market. For example, Procter & Gamble is active in baby care (e.g. Pampers), fabric care (e.g. Ariel, Dreft), grooming (e.g. Braun, Gillette), hair care (e.g. Pantene, Head & Shoulders), oral care (e.g. Oral-B), and skin care (e.g. Olay, Old Spice). But even a small business like a local restaurant can distinguish different markets, such as room rental, catering, and dinners on site. To achieve clarity in the marketing planning process about what should be analyzed and what should be decided upon, it is important to understand the levels within a company. Three levels may be distinguished (see Figure 2.1): 1 2 3

the corporate level (Section 2.1.1) the division and Strategic Business Unit (SBU) level (Section 2.1.2) the product and market instrument level (Section 2.1.3)

2.1.1  The company level The company level is the top level, also known as the ‘corporate level’. This concerns the company as a whole. All the different products that a company releases on the different markets are collectively referred to as the product mix or the range.

2.1.2  The division and SBU level A division is a more or less autonomously operating unit within a company. A division can contain different product groups. A product group (also called product line, product category, or simply category) comprises a group of related products. Examples of product groups are: snacks, internal transport, consultancy, foot care products, and men’s clothing. In practice, a product group is often used as a market definition, for example, the health insurance market. Although the product group is only one of the three dimensions of a market definition (the other two are customer groups and customer functions; see Section 3.1.2), this means that product groups often correspond to markets. We will therefore regularly make this connection in this book. A strategic business unit (also known as strategic product group) is concentrated around a product group (and therefore usually also a market). Many companies operate with SBUs, which in turn are sometimes grouped into divisions (see Case 2.1). Top management (corporate level)

Company

SBU1

Strategic Business Unit

Product/brand

Marketing instruments

P1.1

P1.2

Prod1.1 Price1.1 Place1.1 Prom1.1

Figure 2.1  Levels in a company

SBU...

SBU2

P1.3

P1….

P2.1

P2.2 P2….

P….

Prod... Price…

Place…

Prom…

THE STRATEGIC MARKETING PLANNING PROCESS 33

Case 2.1  Many companies have several brands in different SBUs

L’Oréal has four groups of brands The L’Oréal product mix includes consumer products (including through the L’Oréal Paris and Garnier brands), professional products (for example, for hairdressers), luxury products (including Lancôme and Cacharel), ‘active cosmetics’, and finally the Body Shop brand. Although there is often a difference between the division and the SBU level, we will not make a distinction between the two levels in the rest of this book. The reason for this is that a division level can be considered a corporate level, but one step lower. In practice, divisions are often also smaller companies within a large company. Therefore, what is said about corporate objectives and strategies can also apply to divisional objectives and strategies. For example, the corporate strategy determines which financial resources are available for SBUs. When there is a divisional level between the corporate and SBU levels, the divisional strategy defines the allocation of resources across SBUs. Incidentally, in a company that is active in one market, the company level and the SBU level coincide, and the range is limited to one product group.

2.1.3  The product level and marketing mix level A product is something (good or service) that is concretely offered on a market. A product can be intended for different target groups. A combination of a product and a target group is usually called a product-market combination (PMC). Different varieties of a product are sometimes marketed; for example, there may be differences in sizes or packets and

34  INTRODUCTION AND MARKETING PLANNING

flavors. A company often brings individual products to a market, supported by the use of market instruments. Typically four categories of market instruments are distinguished: product (composition, packaging), price, distribution (channels), and communication (such as advertising and promotions). Because market instruments are filled in for products, the market instrument level corresponds to the product level.

2.1.4  The position of the brand A company uses a brand to distinguish its products from competing products. A brand consists of a word, name, symbol, letter, or sign (or combination of these). A brand is the bearer of a reputation or image. Reasoned from the point of view of the supplier, a brand is, as it were, the identity made visible that the product must radiate. At what levels do brands play a role? The most obvious is the product level. A product is almost always offered under a brand name. Examples of products are Pampers diapers, ABN AMRO student account, LG Television. The designation brand is traditionally associated with products. In fast-moving consumer goods markets, brand names are also most visible at product level: each product has its own brand name. Yet this is a limited view of the importance of brands. Brand names play a role not only at the product level but at all three levels in a company. Although companies like Unilever and Procter & Gamble make little or no use of the name of the company for consumers, Unilever is nevertheless a brand, for example, in the labor and financial markets. We also find brands at the intermediate division level: producers Van den Bergh Nederland and Iglo-Ola are also brands. In markets of services and consumer durables, the brand name at the product level sometimes corresponds to that at company level (e.g. Philips, BMW). We will take a closer look at brands and brand levels in Chapter 11.

2.1.5  Strategic, tactical, and operational decisions In the literature, a distinction is often made between strategic, tactical, and operational decisions. This concerns the long, medium, and short term, respectively. However, the distinction in that ‘term’ is not always clear. What is medium? In this book we define the difference between those three based on the content of the decisions. Strategic decisions are decisions at the corporate and SBU level and, in terms of marketing, relate to target group choices and positioning. Tactical (marketing) decisions relate to the resources and concern the four market instruments. In our opinion, operational decisions relate to the implementation of the plans: who does what, and when? In this book we will not go into this operational level. In practice, strategic decisions will last for several years and tactical decisions for about a year. But this is not absolute, because communication decisions (tactics/tools) can also be recorded for several years.

2.2 Core of the marketing strategy It is important to distinguish between: n the corporate strategy (Section 2.2.1) n the marketing strategy (Section 2.2.2)

THE STRATEGIC MARKETING PLANNING PROCESS 35

2.2.1  Corporate strategy: growth direction and value strategy At each of the levels described in the previous section, decisions are made and strategies are outlined. The content of those decisions differs per level. For example, a chairperson of a board of directors (corporate level) will not be concerned with advertising decisions (product level). Conversely, a margarine brand product manager (product level) will not be concerned with the decision to invest more in diaper sales; the latter is a matter for top management (corporate level). A clear connection can be made with strategic marketing decisions and the levels from Section 2.1 This connection is summarized in Figure 2.2. Three types of decisions need to be made at each of these levels: 1 2 3

Where will we compete: in which markets and with which target groups? How will we compete: with what distinction do we profile ourselves in the chosen markets? Who are we going to compete with: with whom do we want to work?

These kinds of decisions are interrelated. For example, the choice of a market (where?) is especially useful if you can gain a competitive advantage there (how?). And the choice for a partner (with whom) is partly determined by what you are good at and also less good at (how?). The elaboration on the three questions depends on the level. At the corporate level, the question ‘Where will the company compete?’ is that the management of a company or division is (among other things) concerned with determining the desired positions (for example, desired growth) of product groups and brands. This will have to be done in such a way that the desired business objectives (such as a certain growth in turnover) can be achieved with all products together. Growth can be achieved: n with existing products and brands, but also with new ones n with existing customers and target groups, but also with new ones

The times at which the goals must be achieved are also a matter for top management. From the desired goals to be achieved with the various brands, top managers will also have to determine the available resources. Ambitious plans require a lot of money.

Figure 2.2  Types of strategies and levels

36  INTRODUCTION AND MARKETING PLANNING

In practice, making choices about goals and investments is not a one-sided top-down matter. Objectives and budgets at lower levels are negotiated between top and lower management. Product managers or brand managers will have to try to sell their ambitious plans to the management. A convincing plan gets more money. At the corporate level, the question ‘How are we going to compete?’ relates to the choice of the so-called value strategy. Does the company want to position itself towards customers through leadership in quality and innovations, through efficiency and low prices, or through relationship building? The corporate strategy also specifies whether the company wants to grow on its own or with the help of others (‘With whom?’: cooperation, acquisition, merger).

2.2.2  Marketing strategy: target group and positioning At the level of the marketing strategy, a distinction can also be made between where and how. The where question involves a more detailed description of the target group. The how question of the marketing strategy involves the distinguishing power or competitive advantage. What reason should a customer buy your brand and not another brand? That competitive advantage should be sustainable as well. The concept of a sustainable competitive advantage has become central to the literature on competitive analysis and strategies since the early 1980s (Porter, 1980, 1985). Simply put, a sustainable competitive advantage means that a brand: n is good at something (strong point), n in which its competitors are not good (and also difficult to become good at: sustainable), n and is important to the customers.

Three ‘parties’ (the three Cs) thus play the most important role in the choice of competitive advantage: 1 the company: the company or the brand itself 2 the customers: the buyers 3 the competitors: the competitors Analysis of these three Cs is therefore essential. Companies that have a competitive advantage will be able to achieve the best financial results in the industry. Therefore, every company should strive to gain a sustainable competitive advantage from its products. The definition of the term ‘sustainable competitive advantage’ shows that there is an important difference between a strength of a company and a sustainable competitive advantage. Not every strength leads to a sustainable competitive advantage. This is only the case if the following two conditions are met (see also Figure 2.3): 1 2

The competitors do not have that strong point: it is therefore a relatively strength. The strong point is relevant: it matters to customers.

So a company can be good at something, but if it is not relevant to the customers that the company is so good at it or if the competitors also have that strong point, it will not yield anything. An example of the latter is airline safety. Because (almost) every

THE STRATEGIC MARKETING PLANNING PROCESS 37

Figure 2.3  The sustainable competitive advantage

company is safe (this is also an absolute necessity), safety is not a sustainable competitive advantage. If a company has a particular strength, it is imperative to check whether its competitors have the same strength (this is determined in the competitor analysis; see Chapter 7). After that, the strength must be converted into an advantage for the buyers, for example, in the form of better quality or a lower price. This advantage must also be communicated to the customers (for example, by means of advertising). The next question is whether the competitive advantage is also sustainable in the sense of defensible (see Case 2.1). For example, a company with a technological advantage that is easy to imitate will probably soon lose that advantage. If the competition is able to use an even better technology, the initial advantage can even turn into a disadvantage (leapfrog or leapfrogging). In practice, the defensibility of competitive advantages is the biggest problem. Virtually every advantage can be and is quickly followed. Research also shows that followers sometimes manage to achieve higher market shares than innovators (Kerin et al., 1992; Bowman & Gatignon, 1996). Pioneers will therefore have to adopt a flexible attitude and also try to learn from the experiences of the followers (Christen, 2000). In order to understand the defensibility of the competitive advantage, the company can try to predict what the competition will do. This is one of the objectives of the competitor analysis.

2.3 Content of the strategic marketing planning process We start this section with the importance of an environmental analysis.

2.3.1  Importance of an environmental analysis A manager who has a problem can arrive at a solution in two ways: quickly and with little substantiation or somewhat less quickly and well substantiated (see Figure 2.5). Sometimes the first way is very successful.

38  INTRODUCTION AND MARKETING PLANNING

Case 2.2  Sustainable competitive advantage

Volvo is safety Although all cars are basically quite safe, there are differences. Ever since its founding in 1927, Volvo has been committed to making the safest car ever. In 1959, Volvo invented the three-point seat belt, and today every car has it. But also the layered windscreen, crumple zones, and certain forms of side protection, all things that are now also in other cars. Defensibility is difficult, but through continuous innovation, Volvo remains the safest. The idea of a sustainable competitive advantage is closely linked to the concept of positioning. Positioning means determining the place of a brand in the minds of customers in relation to the products of competitors. What image or what associations does a company want to give to the brand? Ries and Trout (1981) have called this: ‘positioning, the battle for your mind’. Positioning is about choosing those brand associations that will: n be relevant to the customers n be unique to the brand

Moreover, if a brand succeeds in communicating the desired associations in such a way that those brand associations are strongly anchored in the target group, then three important requirements for a successful brand are met: strong, relevant, and unique. Keller (2019) also mentions high brand awareness as a requirement (Figure 2.4).

THE STRATEGIC MARKETING PLANNING PROCESS 39

Strong brand Much brand knowledge among target group

‘Mind share’ Brand awareness High

‘Heart share’ Brand associations Strong, relevant, unique

Figure 2.4  Strong brand equity according to Keller and Swaminathan (2019)

In Figure 2.4 we make a distinction between mind share and heart share. We do this because brands have both a functional/informative side and a more emotional one. The brand personality and the values that the brand represents play a role in the latter. A brand must therefore appeal to someone’s head and heart. Brand awareness is mainly focused on mind share because it is about whether someone has heard of the brand. People’s associations with brands can potentially lead to a more emotional relationship with the brand. Good positioning therefore requires an in-depth knowledge of the psychology of the customer. Another important requirement for positioning is focusing: daring to opt for targeted positioning. A wide choice is not a choice, is often said. The search process often boils down to searching for a word on which a brand can distinguish itself. The choice of that word is difficult, essential, and subtle. Difficult, because with general characteristics such as quality, young, dynamic, and reliable, a brand is usually not distinctive, while many brands want to be just that. It is also difficult because companies often do not dare to choose. With a central message, ‘so many other good things are not being said’. Essential, because in fact it talks about the central choice of the brand identity. Everything must be controlled from that identity. Subtle, because it requires a lot of creativity and empathy with the customer and other parties in the environment to come up with the ‘right’ word. Brands that have made a clear choice in 2023 (and before) are, for example, IKEA (affordable home furnishings), Red Bull (‘gives you wings’), Volvo (safety), and Pampers (best for the baby). The concept of positioning is sometimes associated exclusively with communication. It would then mainly be about the slogan or simply about ‘what fun stories we are going to tell in the campaign this year’. Brand positioning, however, goes much further: it controls all activities related to the brand, that is, production, personnel, purchasing, all market instruments, and so on. After all, the positioning is the promise to the customer, and that promise must be kept. This is only possible if everything is aimed at getting it done. It starts with the people who answer the phone, and it ‘ends’ with how satisfied a customer is with the product. Brand positioning therefore not only has an external function (promise to the customer) but also an internal one: towards the employees. Communicating the brand positioning to internal target groups is called internal branding (see also Chapter 14).

40  INTRODUCTION AND MARKETING PLANNING

Incidentally, in our view, the concept of positioning is not essentially different from concepts such as (desired) reputation, identity, vision, or competitive advantage. Because brands exist at different levels in an company, positioning also exists at multiple levels: at the corporate and product level. At company level, this concerns the reputation of the company, also known as corporate identity or simply reputation. At Philips, the brand name is the same as most of its product names, so the corporate identity is consistent with that of all of its products.

Short-cut route

Systematic route

Management question

Research question

Theory: systematically applied to

Practice

Holistic choice process: Brainstorming, alternatives Choice for strategy

Systematically obtained, better knowledge

Figure 2.5  Management problem-solving approaches

A manager does not have to be an analyst to achieve success. In this book, however, we take a different approach. We believe that with better substantiation, the chance of success is greater. The ‘better’ lies in using a good system and the right tools based on a (marketing) theory and more and better knowledge because all parties in the company’s environment are analyzed. The explicit formulation of alternatives is also part of the better (more scientific) approach to practical management problems. A ‘more scientific’ approach to a marketing problem does not mean that the result becomes less practical. The final choice of a solution requires a more holistic approach: creativity, innovation, and market awareness. Good homework forms the ‘input’ for this. How a company should do its homework and then translate it into goals and strategies is the content of the strategic marketing planning process. In Section 2.3.2, we first provide an overview and global structure of the process. We then discuss the phases of the process in Section 2.3.3. Finally, we conclude with some remarks about the course of the process (Section 2.3.4).

THE STRATEGIC MARKETING PLANNING PROCESS 41

Case 2.3  Evidence-based marketing

Medicine is all about being ‘evidence based’. Doctors will base their decisions on evidence-based knowledge and on a thorough analysis of the patient. And that is normal. Now try this exercise: replace the word ‘medicine’ with the word ‘marketing’ and ‘doctors’ with ‘marketers’, and you have an uncanny reflection of what is happening in our industry today. The sad fact is that even we marketers, the supposed experts in positioning, branding, and communication, have become suckers for the sales patter of Google, Facebook, and various industry ‘gurus’. Instead of spotting hucksterism for what it is, our bias towards the new and the novel stymies us. In fact, we love new and exciting things, even when they are vastly inferior to old ideas. Snapchat strategies versus television campaigns, anyone? I am not alone. Only in the past few weeks, I met representatives of an international airline who believed that their core customer base was millennials, whereas the analysis showed that few people under the age of 40 flew with them. So, what to do? Let’s start with some simple basics: don’t fall into the traps that various vendors and slick agencies tell us. Stop the nonsense such as ‘Facebook marketing’, ‘inbound marketing’, ‘content marketing’ – these are fake names invented to brand something that has been around for years. Remember: it is essential to adopt the practices and mindset of evidence-based marketing. Why? So then we can see the forest, the trees, and everything in between. Let’s make it even easier and have this as our mantra: tools change, tactics occasionally change, strategies can change, but marketing principles never change. Source: Colin Lewis, Marketing Week, 9 May 2018

42  INTRODUCTION AND MARKETING PLANNING

2.3.2  Overview of the process In the (marketing) literature, various authors (see, for example, Leeflang, 2003; Ferrell & Hartline, 2010; Aaker, 2013) outline the various steps that a company can take to arrive at a strategy. The way in which this process is worked out is not the same for all authors. In Figure 2.5, we show the steps that we believe a company could take in the planning process. In this subsection, we will explain the figure globally. We will go into more detail in Section 2.3.3.

Phase 1 Analysis

Mission, customer value and market definition

External analysis

Internal analysis

Customer analysis Industry analysis

Internal analysis

Competitor analysis Analysis of distribution and suppliers

SWOT Phase 2 Strategy Corporate objectives and strategy

Marketing objectives and strategy

Phase 3 Tactics Product, Price, Place, Promotion

Organization of marketing and personnel

Figure 2.6  Overview of the strategic marketing planning process

THE STRATEGIC MARKETING PLANNING PROCESS 43

The overall design of the process is that a combination of a internal analysis (analysis of the company and the brand itself) and a external analysis (analysis of the environment) forms the basis for the formulation of marketing objectives and strategies and then of the marketing tactics (implementation). The combination of strengths, weaknesses, opportunities, and threats forms the input for the phase in which a strategy is chosen. The goal of the external analysis is to gain insight into the opportunities and threats (opportunities and threats) that are to be expected.

Situation analysis (Part 2) Part 2 follows the internal analysis (at all levels) and the various phases of the external analysis (mainly SBU and product level). These two parts together form the situation analysis. The order of the phases within the situation analysis can differ per author. We start with the internal analysis, because that includes the evaluation of the results (control). We consider the strengths and weaknesses of the company and the brand more or less as preconditions within which the strategy must be developed. After all, financial characteristics, management culture, corporate mission, and so on cannot be changed quickly. Within the external analysis, something similar applies to the competitor and industry analysis: these can also be regarded as preconditions. This does not apply to the most important target group: the customer. Marketing is ideally suited to ‘teach something’ to target groups. In principle, the customer can be easily influenced. Because in theory and practice a lot of attention is paid to achieving value for the customer, the external analysis therefore starts with the customers. In our view, insight should be obtained on a continuous basis into the wishes, satisfaction, and perceptions of customers and non-customers. This customer analysis forms the source of a variety of information in other analysis phases. Then the other parts of the external analysis take place: first an overview of the entire industry and then specific analyses of the competitors, distributors (or other intermediaries), and suppliers. Finally, a separate SWOT analysis follows, in which results from the internal and external analysis are linked. The first blocks are the analytical part of the planning process.

Corporate and marketing strategies (Part 3) After the analytical part, business objectives and corporate strategy are chosen; these mainly answer the question of where and when to compete. Because the analyses are often performed for SBUs (markets), and a company often operates in several markets, different situational analyses will form the basis of the company strategy. If the company strategy opts for a new market, a new analysis must be carried out. Subsequently, the marketing objectives and marketing strategies are chosen. This concerns sales goals and target group and brand decisions. These decisions mainly determine ‘how the company will compete’.

Implementation (Part 4) The market instruments are determined on the basis of the marketing strategy. This is the marketing tactics. The marketing tactics can be regarded as part of the marketing implementation. After the decisions have been recorded in a marketing plan, implementation takes place. In addition to the organization of marketing and communication, attention

44  INTRODUCTION AND MARKETING PLANNING

to employees is also of great importance. Proper execution is impossible without good internal management.

2.3.3  Description of the phases We now describe the stages of the marketing planning process.

Mission, customer value, and market definition (Chapter 3) A situational analysis of a brand and a market cannot be carried out until the situation we are talking about is known: how is the market defined? Without market definition, for example, no market share can be calculated. Is Coca-Cola active in the soft drinks or ‘colas’ market? This makes quite a difference to the size of the market share and also to the number of competitors. To find out, the mission of the company must first be studied. Within this, statements are normally made about the markets. This is a precondition for the development of the marketing strategy. From the point of view of positioning (the core of the marketing strategy), it is also important to know which customer value focuses on the company: the main line along which the company competes with other companies (see also Chapter 3). The brand positioning should not conflict with this. Finally, the current product-market combinations are mapped out and the market is specifically defined in terms of customer needs. This concerns the determination of the current market: the market in which one is currently active (what business are we in?).

Internal analysis (Chapter 4) The internal analysis starts with the question: what have been the results so far? This forms the control: an evaluation of the results achieved. For other authors, such as Kotler and Keller (2016), control is the very last phase of the planning process (analysis, planning, implementation, control). At the same time, control always forms the starting point of a new planning phase: it is a cyclical process. We choose to start with a ‘look back’. The desired results or objectives must be analyzed. We start Chapter 4 with a brief explanation of objectives. The results of the strategy (and goals) can be measured in profit, sales, market share, and so on; the choice of measurement unit depends on how the objectives are formulated. In addition to financial criteria, customer-oriented standards are also used, such as customer satisfaction (the balanced scorecard [BSC]) and sustainability goals. This step gives a first impression of where any problems lie. The analysis is carried out as disaggregated as possible, so not only at the product and instrument level but also within these – if possible – by regions, customer groups (segments), varieties, and retailers. Finally, the internal factors that are important in finding a (new) strategy are examined. To this end, the strengths and weaknesses of the company, the SBU, the product, and the market instruments are determined. This is done through the eyes of the target group as much as possible. The strengths and weaknesses are compared (at a later stage) with those of the competitors. If the strengths can be translated into added value of products for customers, they provide starting points for sustainable competitive advantages. The weaknesses – if they threaten to create strategic problems – must be improved. The latter can take place through in-house development or through collaboration with competitors.

THE STRATEGIC MARKETING PLANNING PROCESS 45

The internal analysis is also called the micro-analysis. The external analysis then consists of a meso analysis (regarding the industry, the market, the competitors, and the customers) and a macro analysis (trends outside the industry). In this book, we do not use this classification, and we also combine a part of the meso analysis (industry) with the macro analysis. Chapters 5 through 8 deal with the external analysis.

Customer analysis (Chapter 5) The central premise of this book is that a company’s policy should be aimed at creating optimal value for the customer, matching the brand identity. Continuous contact with the target group is therefore essential. A manager responsible for a brand must have an ongoing knowledge of the ‘psychology of the customer’. A good customer analysis (including potential customers) provides for this. More specific objectives of the customer analysis are: gaining insight into their characteristics (who are the customers, can segments be distinguished, which customers are the most profitable?), their needs (the importance of concrete and abstract product characteristics), their perceptions (how do they view their own product and competitors?) and their behavior (information search behavior, buying behavior). The customer analysis is performed for an entire market (SBU level) and for individual segments and products (product level). The customer analysis also forms a source of data for other phases in the situation analysis and is therefore the core of the situation analysis. For example, there are direct lines to the competitor analysis (competitor identification, success factors, and competitive strengths and weaknesses), the distribution analysis (brand position with retailers), the industry analysis (expected market growth), and the internal analysis (brand strengths and weaknesses).

Industry analysis (Chapter 6) After the customer analysis, the process moves from macro to micro. First there is an analysis of the entire industry, and then a closer look is taken at some of the interest groups within it: competitors, distributors, and suppliers. A first goal of the industry analysis is to find possible opportunities and threats, especially from the macro environment. A second goal is to gain a summary insight into the attractiveness of the market. To this end, the industry structure is analyzed, among other things. The market attractiveness mainly influences the objectives/investments that are determined per SBU. The industry analysis analyzes the following three categories of factors: 1 2 3

macro-environmental factors, such as socio-cultural and political developments aggregated market factors, for example, market size and market growth industry structure factors, such as the intensity of competition and the power of retailers

Because it is particularly important to gain insight into the future attractiveness of the market, the company should try to make predictions. Given the great uncertainty that exists in a company’s environment, it is advisable to define scenarios, for example, scenarios about macro-environmental factors such as the business cycle. The industry analysis primarily takes place at the SBU level, that is, for the entire market. In addition, a company can also investigate the attractiveness of market segments.

46  INTRODUCTION AND MARKETING PLANNING

Competitor analysis (Chapter 7) The aim of the competitor analysis is to gain insight into the future behavior and the strengths and weaknesses of the company’s main competitors. The future behavior of competitors provides insight into potential opportunities and threats. A company that is aware of the strengths and weaknesses of its competitors is able to assess its own relative formulate strengths and weaknesses (see Figure 2.3). A competitor analysis also provides insight that can be used to find potential collaboration partners. A competitor analysis can be performed at all levels. At the product level, the most important competitors are the providers that target the same target group as their own company. The competitor analysis is fed on a number of points from the customer analysis (identification of competitors, strengths, and weaknesses of competitors).

Distribution and supplier analysis (Chapter 8) After analyzing the customers and the competitors, the other parties (interest groups) in the industry are subjected to a critical analysis. As we explained in the strategic marketing concept (see Section 1.2.2), distributors are an increasingly important interest group for manufacturers due to their increasing power. A distribution analysis takes place on three levels. At the macro level, it concerns the distribution structure in which online channels are evidently growing. At the meso level, it concerns the distribution of power within a group of distributors (such as retailers). And at the micro level, the behavior of individual distributors is analyzed, such as that of Delhaize. From the customer analysis, information about purchasing behavior at and satisfaction with retailers can be included in this phase. A final interest group that deserves further analysis is the suppliers. A good relationship with suppliers means that purchasing can take place in a more efficient, effective, and sustainable manner. Certainly the latter (sustainability) is becoming increasingly important.

SWOT analysis (Chapter 9) The SWOT analysis forms the connecting link between the various analyses and the strategy phases. First, it is important to weigh up the possibilities for the value strategies. Based on a selection of strengths, weaknesses, opportunities, and threats, ideas for the marketing strategy are then brainstormed. ‘Facts’ are thus creatively translated into ‘ideas’. In the SWOT analysis, some alternative directions are finally indicated (options). Finally, by confronting the options with a number of selection criteria and preconditions, the product manager will come to a decision about the desired strategy. It is important to reiterate that this is where the creative process begins. A strategy can never be ‘calculated’ or ‘derived’ from points in the SWOT. In this book, therefore, no scoring and weighting system is linked to the SWOT. The SWOT is the inspiration and basis for strategic choices.

Corporate objectives and strategies (Chapter 10) A first step in this respect is a reassessment of the company mission: should the company’s business be changed? The objectives of the company are also laid down. Subsequently, a portfolio analysis can be performed. In a portfolio analysis, the expected incoming and

THE STRATEGIC MARKETING PLANNING PROCESS 47

outgoing cash flows of different SBUs or brands are compared with each other. Such an analysis can also be done during the internal analysis. Based on this, it can be decided in which SBUs or brands the company wishes to invest more and in which less. Partly on this basis, the company strategy is formulated. The corporate strategy involves a choice of positions of and investments in SBUs and brands. Finally, the company must choose the competitive growth strategy (either through self-development or through collaboration). All components of corporate strategy commit resources and people for an extended period of time and are therefore unlikely to be significantly changed from year to year. Usually there will be adjustment. We also emphasize the interaction with the marketing plans: the business decisions will largely be fed by the SBUs. That is why feedback is indicated from the next planning step in the planning process (see Figure 2.6).

Marketing objectives and marketing strategies (Chapter 11) After the formulation of the business decisions, the marketing objectives and marketing strategies are chosen. Marketing objectives are formulated per product, for example, growth of the market share of product Y to 34% in one year. The marketing strategy is the choice of the target group (including segmentation) and the desired positioning of the brand. We also include decisions about the brand elements brand name, design, and logo. The marketing strategy is the link between the business strategy and the market instrument decisions and is therefore of crucial importance. Without an explicit implementation of the marketing strategy, the various market instruments are out of control. The specific choice of brand identity is a multi-year matter that must be propagated for a long time consistently.

Market instrument decisions (Chapters 12 and 13) The marketing strategy is then translated into marketing tactics: decisions regarding the market instruments (the four Ps) product, price, place (distribution), and promotion (marketing communication). Incidentally, for the product market instrument, an important part of the strategic decisions has already been determined by the implementation of the business and marketing strategy (such as brand decisions). Because of the important role of marketing communication, including various digital possibilities, we discuss this market instrument in a separate chapter (Chapter 13).

Organization of marketing and personnel (Chapter 14) Finally, the plans must be converted into actions: implementation. In many companies, the implementation often goes wrong. An organization geared to the customer is important: bring the customer in-house through customer managers. All communication must be aligned with the identity and preferably directed by a ‘reputation manager’. The principle of the ‘part-time marketer’ is also relevant: especially in service organizations, but also in retail, customer orientation and behavior according to the core values are everyone’s business, and the importance of good staff is therefore evident. We conclude Chapter 14 with some planning tips.

48  INTRODUCTION AND MARKETING PLANNING

2.3.4  Properties of the planning process At the end of this section, we would like to review the planning process described from two dimensions: n the importance of analysis and creativity n the breadth of the process

Analysis and creativity Analytical thinking is usually convergent thinking: the homework should lead to a solution. Creativity requires divergent thinking: coming up with ideas outside the existing frames of mind. Looking at the planning process, the first part is clearly analytical: the homework must be done accurately and using the right methods. From the SWOT onwards, the creative approach becomes increasingly important: appropriate positioning must be applied, and the chosen core values must then be communicated in a clear and often creative manner via online and offline media channels. To stay ahead of the competition, standard solutions are often not enough.

Width of the process In terms of scope, the SWOT starts broad: all possible internal and external aspects are included. Although the analysis is limited to one market, various interesting issues can play a role in and around that market, which can also lead to innovations. But during and after the SWOT, a different mindset is needed. First, within the SWOT, the most important issues should be identified. Subsequently, a positioning must be established that also requires focus. After the marketing strategy has been determined, the process will broaden again because the chosen message must be widely disseminated from all activities of the company. This is necessary because without clear (and perhaps somewhat ‘exaggerated’) communication, no position in the mindset of the target group is reached. This ties in with Sharp’s studies mentioned previously, which have shown that ‘presence’ has a strong influence on purchase. In this way, a hourglass view of the planning process is created (see Figure 2.7).

2.4 Structure of a marketing plan Figure 2.8 contains an overview of the components of a marketing plan. The various components largely parallel the structure of the strategic marketing planning process. A marketing plan does not develop company objectives or company strategies. A marketing plan is essentially developed for a single brand. In the figure, we also give an indication of the length of the various parts. Without attachments, a marketing plan will be around 25 pages. In practice, it can be observed that marketing plans are not always completely written out in ‘report form’. Sometimes the headlines of all parts in a (PowerPoint) presentation will suffice. That presentation is then the marketing plan itself. There is nothing bad about that in itself. The length indications in Figure 2.8 relate to the number of pages or sheets in the presentation.

THE STRATEGIC MARKETING PLANNING PROCESS 49

Broad situation analysis incl. customer analysis

Focused positioning

Make big by innovative and appropriate use of product/service, price, place and communication

Figure 2.7  Hourglass schedule

1  Management summary

The summary makes it possible for top management to take in the most important points of the plan in a very short space of time. The management summary shows the main conclusions from the SWOT analysis, the goals set in the plan, the chosen strategies, and the financial expectations. In the summary, the arguments that people have for the chosen strategy are also very important. Although the summary should be short, it should also be very concrete. 2  Introduction and background

The ‘introduction and background’ section serves as a general introduction to the marketing plan and as a framework within which decisions are made. The following points are included: n First of all, it contains a statement of the company’s mission and objectives, as well

as the SBU objectives. It can be assumed that these must be regarded as given for the product/brand. n Subsequently, the specific market for the product is defined on the basis of the dimensions mentioned in Chapter 3. Without this designation, it is unclear what

50  INTRODUCTION AND MARKETING PLANNING

Part

Number of pages

1 Executive summary

1-2

2 Introduction and background

2-3



Corporate mission and corporate objectives, SBU objectives

• Market definition and product brand background • Results evaluation 3 Situation analysis

6-10

• Internal analysis • Customer analysis • Industry analysis • Competitor analysis • Distribution analysis 4 SWOT analysis

2-3

• Key issues ( SWOTs ), environmental vision and core problem • Value strategy • Marketing strategy options plus choice option 5 Marketing objectives/expected results

1

6 Marketing strategy

2-4

• Target groups • Brand positioning • Brand name and design 7 Market instrument decisions ( marketing programs )

6-10

• Instrument objectives • Instrument decisions 8 Financial indicators and budgets

1-2

9 Evaluation criteria

1

10

10+



Attachments Any further market data and data on past marketing activities

• Possible explanations of situation analysis • Scenario analysis and contingency plans • Time and activity schedules • References

Figure 2.8  Content of a marketing plan for a product/brand Source: Based on Dibb et al. (2003)

THE STRATEGIC MARKETING PLANNING PROCESS 51

the plan refers to. You can also choose to display the results of the identification of the competition here (first step competitor analysis). The advantage of this is that a picture of the market is already created at the beginning of this section. Some background information is also provided with the product/brand. After all, not every reader of the marketing plan is fully aware of the situation to which the marketing plan relates. n Finally, the problem conclusion is given. This forms the starting point for the plan and is therefore placed at the beginning. In the planning process itself, the problem conclusion will not be addressed until later (see Section 9.3). Any time series of various variables of interest (such as market shares and advertising expenditure) can be used as product facts and be included in an appendix. 3  Situation analysis

Situational analysis is discussed extensively in this book. For the various components, predictions and/or assumptions (planning assumptions) of variables can also be displayed. This involves forecasts of variables such as macro-environmental factors, market data, and competitive behavior. For variables that have not been forecast, assumptions about future developments must be made. These assumptions (as well as the objectives) should be as specific as possible, for example, the expectations ‘no response from competitor G’ and ‘a 5% growth in market demand’. The explicit presentation of the assumptions is of great importance when choosing objectives and when evaluating the results later (in the internal analysis). If the predicted results are not achieved, this may be due to an assumption that turns out not to have been met, for example, a reaction from a competitor. In such a case, the company may have to choose an alternative strategy (this is shown in Section 10 – the appendices – of the marketing plan). In practice, the competitor and industry analysis are often presented together. 4  SWOT analysis

The SWOT analysis forms a summary of the situation analysis and provides starting points for strategies. 5  Marketing objectives/expected results

The results to be achieved in terms of sales, turnover and market share are an important reason why a certain strategy is chosen. Objectives are usually specified for several years, for example, for three years. 6  Marketing strategy

A brief description of the marketing strategy is not sufficient. Elements such as target groups, brand personality, and type of positioning must be detailed. The argument for the choice of strategy must also be presented here.

52  INTRODUCTION AND MARKETING PLANNING

7  Market instrument decisions

The plans must be translated in detail into concrete action programs for the coming year (annual plans). Four questions need to be answered: 1 2 3 4

What exactly will happen? When will it happen? Who does it? How much does it cost?

These decisions are tactical and operational. Detailed interpretation and division of tasks are important for proper implementation. This section contains both tactical and operational decisions. 8  Financial indicators and budgets

Financial insight is a very important part of the marketing plan. The following financial indicators must be included here: n the necessary budgets: budgets for sales promotion, sales costs, research, product

development, and so on

n the predicted costs, revenues, cash flow, and profit: these predictions have already

been used in the shareholder value analysis

This part is of great importance for higher management. It gives them insight into the investments required and the extent to which the plan will contribute to the company’s financial objectives. The financial part thus forms the starting point for the negotiations between the manager submitting the plan and top management. In order to gain insight into the risks, the ‘financial picture’ will always be assessed by top management in relation to the assumptions. An expected high profit is attractive, but high uncertainty about this is a major drawback. Top management will also try to estimate the payback period, which is determined, among other things, by when a profit will be made. If this moment is too far in the future, the plan will be considered unattractive. 9  Evaluation criteria

In order to verify during the course of the year whether the plan will achieve its objectives, the ‘evaluation metrics’ section (also known as performance indicators) must include two things: 1

2

First, the objectives and budgets must be translated (disaggregated) into regions, varieties, distribution channels, and periods within the year (e.g. for each month or quarter). For example: with the introduction of a new brand X, the aim is to achieve a market share of 5% in a year (marketing objective). This target is now translated as follows: a share of 2% must be achieved on 1 April, 3% on 1 July, 4% on 1 October, and 5% on 31 December. Subsequently, it must be indicated which information is required for the progress check. In other words: what standards will be used for the audit and how will they be measured? These measures depend on the objectives. For example: monitoring of progress takes place on the basis of Nielsen (scanning) data.

THE STRATEGIC MARKETING PLANNING PROCESS 53

10 Attachments

Particularly in a highly dynamic environment, it may be desirable to have alternative strategies ready in case something ‘unexpected’ happens (a contingency), such as the introduction of a competing product. These unexpected events may have already been analyzed in the scenario analysis. A contingency plan can be based on a previously considered but abandoned strategy. In an appendix to the marketing plan, it can be described in which scenario which option should be chosen. In addition, one must indicate as specifically as possible when a certain scenario becomes current, for example, ‘if sales are more than 10% below the targets’ or ‘if the weighted distribution does not exceed 70%’. For the sake of clarity and for ex-post control, it is important to include schedules of planned activities in the annexes. For the sake of clarity, for example, time bars can be used.

Summary Three levels can play a role within a company: the corporate level (top management), SBUs (product groups), and products. In a small company, these levels will coincide. Brands play a role at all levels. In order to achieve customer loyalty, brand reputation is important in addition to satisfaction. The choice of brand positioning (desired brand associations) should be based on the balance between customer needs and a brand’s unique strengths. Daring to choose is important. Essentially, the essence of the marketing strategy is to answer the question: why should a customer choose my brand and not the competitor’s? In order to make the best marketing decisions for a brand, a systematic approach to knowledge gathering is preferable. This book covers the strategic marketing planning process. Based on the chosen market definition and results evaluation, a situation analysis is performed: an internal analysis and an external analysis (ABCD: buyers, industry, competitors, and distributors/ suppliers). The data obtained in this way is further analyzed with a number of strategic analysis methods. Creativity is important in the translation process into strategies and ultimately a marketing plan. Finally, the plan must be implemented. Based on interim measurements, the implementation and the results are checked. The results of the evaluations form the input for a new planning process. Attention to digital and sustainable aspects is important in all phases of the marketing planning process. Marketing planning goes from broad (situation analysis) to narrow (focus in positioning) to broad again (magnifying message). A marketer must have analytical skills and be creative.

54  INTRODUCTION AND MARKETING PLANNING

Experience Disneyland Paris

Disneyland Paris is part of the Walt Disney Company. The park opened in 1992. Since then, the park has become the largest theme park in Europe. During the record-breaking year 2012, 11.2 million people visited the famous amusement park. In that year, Disneyland Paris celebrated its twentieth anniversary. This twentieth anniversary, with new attractions, major renovations in the parks and hotels, and great media attention, contributed to this high number of visitors. This proved difficult to surpass. In the years after 2012, partly due to the poor economic situation, the number of visitors gradually decreased. However, this decline seemed to be slowing: the number of visitors increased to a total of around 10 million people in 2018 and 2019, but then the COVID pandemic had a huge impact on visitor numbers. In the lockdown year 2020, there were only 2.6 million visitors, slowly increasing to 3.5 million visitors in 2021. Disneyland Paris is becoming less and less dependent on French visitors alone. According to Disney, the company’s new pricing policy – fewer promotions, discounts, and last minutes – is the reason that the number of French visitors has fallen in recent years. With the increasing number of visitors in the years before COVID, the company’s turnover also increased. However, this increase was also caused by visitors spending more money during their visit to Disneyland Paris: the average guest spending in parks has been increasing in recent years. According to Disneyland Paris, this increase is caused by continuous investments in ‘customer experience’. These investments fit in well with the mission of the Walt Disney Company: The mission of The Walt Disney Company is to be one of the world’s leading producers and providers of entertainment and information. Using our portfolio of brands to differentiate our content, services and consumer products,

THE STRATEGIC MARKETING PLANNING PROCESS 55

we seek to develop the most creative, innovative and profitable entertainment experiences and related products in the world. The Walt Disney Company is an international company that specializes in family entertainment. The company consists of four elements: n Parks, Experiences, and Products. In addition to Disneyland Paris, these

include the Disneyland Resorts in Los Angeles, Florida, Tokyo and Shanghai. Disney Parks, Experiences and Products brings the magic of Disney stories and franchises to life through theme parks, resorts, cruise ships, unique vacation experiences, consumer products and more around the world. With experiences created by Walt Disney Imagineering, beloved characters come to life for guests and consumers of all ages.

n Studio Entertainment, responsible for the production of the Disney films. n Media Networks: the television channels and streaming services of the Disney

Media Group. This includes Disney+.

n Direct-to-Consumer and International, with a focus on high-quality entertain-

ment through games, social media, and other digital platforms.

Disneyland Paris consists of two parts. On the one hand, there are the theme parks of the resort: Disneyland Park (including Fantasyland, Frontier Land, and Main Street USA) and the more television and film-oriented Walt Disney Studios Park. These parks host well-known attractions such as Big Thunder Mountain and Pirates of the Caribbean. The revenues in these parks are driven by two factors: the number of visitors and the spending per visitor (on food and drinks, admission prices, and merchandise). Next to the parks are the hotels and Disney Village. Visitors to Disneyland Paris can stay overnight here, but the hotels are also used for the organization of events and conferences. Disneyland Paris aims to increase sales and profitability in the future through increasing visitor numbers and increasing average spending per visitor. To achieve this, the company continues to invest in the ‘experience’ that Disney offers its visitors. After all, if expectations of the visitors are exceeded, this leads to repeat visits and positive word-of-mouth advertising. Continued investment is also necessary: ​​ the competition in the market is constantly growing, and the competitors are not sitting still either. An interview with Président Tom Wolber, adapted from the annual report of Disneyland Paris in 2015,1 illustrates the confidence with which Disneyland Paris faces the future: How do you see the 2015 fiscal year? Throughout the year we increased our efforts to enhance the guest experience and to make our resort something truly special. We launched an ambitious program to renovate ten of our iconic attractions, including the emblematic

56  INTRODUCTION AND MARKETING PLANNING

Space Mountain: Mission 2, and Mystères de Nautilus. These major innovations are starting to bear fruit. Revenue was up 7.3%, thanks to increases in theme park attendance, hotel occupancy rates, and average spending per guest. Disneyland Paris welcomed 600,000 additional guests this year, and average spending reached a record level of €53.8 per guest – an increase of 6%. How do these results reflect your strategy? These results demonstrate the positive impact of our long-term strategy to improve the quality of the guest experience and to increase guest satisfaction. This strategy is part of our constant drive for excellence, which is vital because our future lies in providing the very best quality. Continuous investments are necessary if we want to stay ahead of the competition and secure the future of Disneyland Paris. We operate in an increasingly competitive environment, as the leisure sector in Europe offers an ever-widening range of products and alternatives. We need to stand out to maintain our position as the sector leader. What is the key to the success of Disneyland Paris? Over the years, Disneyland Paris has strengthened its position as Europe’s leading tourist attraction. Our success is first and foremost the result of the commitment of our employees. Their talent, creativity, and enthusiasm bring the Disney magic to life every day for millions of guests. We are increasing our creative efforts to enchant our guests, drawing on the heritage of the Disney brand. Our brand represents the values of sincerity and excellence, as well as the importance of dreams, and is one of the pillars of our success. What are your priorities for the coming years? We continue our renovation efforts in our parks and hotels, and we continue to offer new experiences to our guests. This work is part of our constant drive for excellence, and is also part of the build-up to our 25th anniversary in 2017. For this symbolic date, we want our resort to be even more attractive, more magical, and more welcoming than ever. As Europe’s leading tourist destination, we should continue to do everything in our power to set an example in all areas, not only in our efforts to offer an experience but also in our HR policy or in our social and environmental responsibilities. Providing a family experience is what made Disney great. Visitors come mainly to meet the Disney characters in person. Disney offers a unique opportunity to get a cuddle from Mickey Mouse or to take a photo together with Donald Duck. These are memories and experiences that people really remember, that lead to a second or third visit, and that cost relatively little money in terms of investment. Celebrations accompanied by parades, festivities, and more shows to permanently enrich the Disney feeling will continue to play a major role in the parks.

THE STRATEGIC MARKETING PLANNING PROCESS 57

Questions 1

Three levels can be distinguished in a company. Illustrate these three levels for the Walt Disney Company. 2 Does Disneyland Paris have a sustainable competitive advantage? If yes, which one? Please explain your answer. 3 Define the marketing objective for Disneyland Paris, based on the information in the case. 4 Define the corporate strategy, the marketing strategy, and the market instrument strategies for Disneyland Paris. Use information from the case where possible. 5 a In the external analysis, several specific analyses have to be performed. Which analyses are these? b Provide, for each of these analyses, an example of information that is of interest to Disneyland Paris. Use information from the case where possible. 6 Disneyland Paris offers a real-life experience where people go to meet their favorite Disney figure or to enjoy a ride in one of the attractions in the park. It is not an online experience. Does this mean that digital marketing is not relevant for Disneyland Paris? Why (not)? 1

Disneyland Paris was an independent company until 2017, which was registered with the name Euro Disney S.C.A. In 2017 it was taken over completely by the Walt Disney Company. Since then, annual reports for Disneyland Paris were no longer publicly available. The optimism, of course, remained.

Part 2

Situation analysis

3 4 5 6 7 8 9

Mission, customer values, and market definition Internal analysis Customer analysis Industry analysis Competitor analysis Distribution and supplier analysis SWOT analysis

Part 2 discusses the various components of the situation analysis. A thorough situation analysis lays the foundation for well-considered objectives and strategies. We start the situation analysis with the definition of the market, which must fall within the mission of a company (Chapter 3). The first real analysis step is then the internal analysis (Chapter 4), including a review of the results to date. The external analysis starts with the customers (Chapter 5). With this, we want to express how important it is to have insight into the wishes and perceptions of the target group. After the customer analysis, an overview of the entire industry is first given in Chapter 6. We then take a closer look at some of the parties involved. Chapter 7 deals with competitor analysis. In Chapter 8 we look at the distributors (channels) and suppliers. We conclude this part with the SWOT analysis (Chapter 9).

DOI: 10.4324/9781003381488-4

Chapter 3

Mission, customer values, and market definition Phase 1 Analysis Mission, customer value and market definition (3)

External analysis

Internal analysis

Customer analysis (5) Industry analysis (6)

Internal analysis (4)

Competitor analysis (7) Analysis of distribution and suppliers (8)

SWOT (9) Phase 2 Strategy Corporate objectives and strategy (10)

Marketing objectives and strategy (11)

Phase 3 Tactics Product, Price, Place (12); Promotion (13)

Organization of marketing and personnel (14)

DOI: 10.4324/9781003381488-5

62  Situation analysis

Key points in this chapter n Know the function and components of a mission and a vision n Know the essence of customer value and the different values that exist n Know how to define a market: components and guidelines

Introduction The first step in the process of creating a marketing plan is to define the market. No analyses can be carried out without a market definition. A market definition for a brand must always fall within the mission of a company. First, the mission must be clear. That is why we discuss the company’s mission and vision in Section 3.1. Within the vision, the choice of customer values (Section 3.2) plays a major role: which customer needs does the company want to meet? In Section 3.3, we indicate how a market definition takes place. We describe this on different levels, and we end with some guidelines.

3.1 Developing a customer-oriented vision In this section we first look at the functions of the mission (Section 3.1.1). We then discuss the components of the mission in Section 3.1.2 and then come to corporate social responsibility (CSR). Finally, in Section 3.1.3, we discuss the vision of a company.

3.1.1  Functions of a mission Many organizations have a mission statement. But just as these missions are often vague, so is the literature about what exactly a mission entails and what elements it should contain. Based on a survey of 59 large companies in the United Kingdom, Klemm et al. (1991) come to four different types of missions: 1

2 3 4

The pure mission. This is a reflection of the company’s long-term goals, based on the philosophies of top management. For a publisher, for example: ‘We want to make a growing contribution to the provision of information and opinion-forming in Dutch society’. Strategic objectives. This is a rough representation of the desired direction and positions. For example: ‘Our mission is to establish Sony Ericsson as the most attractive and innovative global brand in the mobile phone market’. Quantified planning objectives. These are the concrete objectives for a certain period. For example: ‘We want to achieve a 10% higher profit next year than this year’. Market definition (business definition). This is a demarcation of the breadth and activities of a company. For example: ‘We publish newspapers and magazines’.

This summary shows that the missions formulated by companies vary from very broad to very limited. The goal of a mission is threefold:

Mission, customer values, and market definition 63

First of all, formulating a mission forces a company to reflect on its activities (‘What business are we in?’). It is thus an important part of the strategic planning process. Particularly in companies that are not very market oriented, it can be a good starting point in the planning process to first try to get the existing activities on paper. 2 The second function of a mission is an internal function: it helps to motivate the staff. Thus, a mission must contain elements of objectives that can be pursued by the employees. 3 A third function of a mission is to create a certain image to the outside world (external function). To this end, the identity of the company can be included in the mission, as well as, for example, social objectives. 1

According to the research of Klemm et al. (1991), the internal function is most important: the main purpose of the mission is to sell the philosophies and ideas (values) of the top management to the employees. From the point of view of implementation and management, a mission is therefore an important instrument. An example of a very short, but at the same time extremely motivating, mission comes from a Japanese car manufacturer whose mission for quite some time was ‘Beat Benz’. The research by Klemm et al. also shows that a change in management is the most important reason for changing the mission. ‘Changes in market conditions’ are mentioned less often as a reason to change the mission. Research by Hooley et al. (1992) shows that there is a need to separate mission and vision. According to these authors, it is essential to formulate a short motivational vision about what the organization wants to achieve in the future. This is also called strategic intent (Hamel & Prahalad, 1989). On this basis, we can therefore say that a mission only fulfills an essential function if it motivates. Since this is often not the case in practice, it is argued that companies should formulate not so much mission statements but ambition statements. A mission is what the company is and does now; a vision is what the company wants to achieve in the future. That vision is motivating. We agree with these definitions and show in Figure 3.1 which choices should form the basis of a strategic business plan. We choose to first have the mission defined in order to indicate what the company wishes to achieve in the future (vision). We will discuss each of the components listed in Figure 3.1 in more detail in Sections 3.1.2 and 3.1.3. The mission: what do we do now? •

Definition of activities



Societal mission (external and internal) and other dimensions of corporate image

The vision/ambition: what do we want to achieve in the future? •

Belief: belief about what is important



Identity and positioning of the organization: value strategy



Long-term goals

Figure 3.1  Mission and vision of an organization

64  Situation analysis

3.1.2  Two types of missions and sustainability The mission consists of the following components: n the economic-technical mission n the social mission

Economic-technical mission The economic-technical component concerns the demarcation of the current activities: what business are we in? Markets can be defined in several ways. The most obvious way is to define markets based on products. A market then consists of all suppliers who bring a certain product to the market. For example, companies may be active in the beer market, the car market, the coffee market, the air travel market, or the personal computer market. A disadvantage of defining markets on the basis of products is that this only concerns the supply side: it does not show who the products are intended for or who the buyers are. The market definition should therefore also include the buyers. For example, a company can manufacture beer for home consumption or for use in the hospitality industry (or for both). Personal computers can be intended for individuals, schools, or companies. It is also possible to give a geographical demarcation of the buyers. Do you only serve the domestic market or also abroad? And in the latter case: which countries? In short, in addition to the products, one must also indicate who the customers are. Another important point of criticism of the use of the product dimension is that it does not look at the functions that the products fulfill for the customers. In other words: the underlying needs of the customers for whom the products are intended are not considered. There is then a danger that you will overlook competitors who fulfill the same function for the customers (i.e. who meet the same needs) but with completely different products. For example, a petrol company can use the product-oriented market definition ‘we sell petrol’ but also the customer-oriented definition ‘we supply energy’. In the latter case, you keep the option open to also supply other products that cover the same need, such as gas. Some authors (Abell & Hammond, 1979; Abell, 1980) therefore argue that a market definition should not only be formulated in terms of products but also in terms of customer functions. A classic example of a product-oriented mission are Swiss watch manufacturers, which for years used as a market definition: hand-made precision movements. Due to the advent of chip technology, they were overtaken by foreign manufacturers who could deliver the same quality at considerably lower prices (digital watches). It was only when sales of Swiss watches fell dramatically that the market definition was reformulated based on consumers’ need to ‘know what time it is’. Subsequently, new production methods were also used and cheaper watches were produced (Swatch). All in all, we conclude that a market definition can contain the following dimensions (similar to Abell [1980]: customer technologies, customer groups, customer functions): n Products (customer technologies): ‘We design systems that link customer needs to

the supply of information’.

n Customer groups (segments): ‘Our target groups are private individuals and compa-

nies in the Netherlands’.

Mission, customer values, and market definition 65

n Customer functions (needs): ‘We help our customers to find information on the

Internet more effectively and efficiently’.

Societal mission: sustainability The other component of the mission is of a social nature. For example, external social goals relate to climate, internal goals to matters such as the working atmosphere, employment, and fringe benefits. This has everything to do with the aforementioned sustainability, also known as the ‘three Ps’: companies should not only have an eye for Profit but also for People and the Planet. Nowadays, every company should consider corporate social responsibility of paramount importance. The term CSR is also used with different meanings. We can distinguish the following facets of CSR, two external and one internal: n Sustainability, that is, doing business in an environmentally friendly manner. As

indicated in Chapter 1, this has become a very important issue worldwide in recent years. n Social projects. These can be various ‘charities’. n Internal social policy. This is in fact sustainable human resources management and is related, for example, to a positive action policy for immigrants, women returning to work, or the elderly. A partial aspect of this is the combination of work and care. There seems to be an increasing focus by employees on a more balanced work-life balance. By responding to this, companies can retain their people for longer. CSR therefore means that in addition to profit, there is also attention for people (external and internal) and planet, the well-known trilogy people, planet, profit. The term ‘sustainability’ is therefore (as mentioned earlier) used for both the P for Planet and the P for People. In this book we use the term sustainability for the ‘planet’ side of sustainability. So, as indicated in Chapter 1, acting sustainably is acting in such a way that future generations are not saddled with the social ‘costs’. We regard personnel as another issue.

3.1.3  Vision of a company The vision is the entrepreneur’s dream. It is the view of the current top management of a company about the function of existing and new products in the future and about the role that the company can play in providing them. In our opinion, the most important part of the vision is to indicate what the company wants to mean to the customer: what value does the company want to provide? The vision (see Figure 3.2) largely stems from the existing core competencies: what are we best at? Figure 3.2 shows that a vision contains the following components: n Opinions about what the company considers important in the environment and espe-

cially among the target group. (‘We believe that over the next five years there will be a strong consumer demand for local products’.) n The identity of the company as it is translated to the customer (‘Our aim is to be the most locally oriented manufacturer of food within five years’). The company will often base this on its core competencies or core competences.

66  Situation analysis

Vision of the company: A motivating ambition

Vision about the environment: Expected customer trends

Identity of the company: Core competences and value strategy

Long-term objectives

Figure 3.2  Components of the vision of a company n The company’s long-term goals (‘We want to become the largest provider of local

food’).

It is important that the vision contains a clear motivational aim, which the entire staff within a company can agree with. The latter is also important: a vision should not be imposed on the staff as a forced straitjacket. It is important that support be created for this. Being able to formulate a clear and challenging ambition is an important requirement for a leader. A clear ambition is a strong tool for creating teams. In practice, however, many organizations lack challenging visions, and when they do exist, they are not always sufficiently shared with the workforce. We will come back to this in Chapter 14. At the end of this introduction we make a comment on the place of the vision in the planning process. Can the formulation of a vision take place prior to the situation analysis? Can an organization make decisions about the future without an extensive situation analysis? We choose to initially consider the vision more or less as given in the marketing planning process. This has to do with the level at which these matters operate: formulating a vision is a matter for top management (‘the leader’); the strategic marketing planning process concerns individual markets and SBUs. For example, if a company has not chosen a clear value strategy, it will still have to do so after the situation analysis. We will come back to this in the SWOT analysis in Chapter 9.

3.2 Customer values In Chapter 1, we indicated that having a competitive advantage is essential. Different ‘models’ can be used for the choice of such an advantage. In this section we present some important ones. But first, let’s take a look at what ‘customer value’ actually is.

3.2.1  What is customer value? Customer value is defined as the utility that a customer derives from a product, where we define utility as the difference between revenue (in the broad sense) and cost (in the broad sense). In short: Customer value = ‘Revenue’ product – ‘Cost’ product

Mission, customer values, and market definition 67

Case 3.1  A vision should be motivating

The vision of Ikea ‘To create a better everyday life for the many people’. This vision goes beyond home furnishing. We want to have a positive impact on the world – from the communities where we source our raw materials to the way our products help our customers live a more sustainable life at home. If you’ve ever visited IKEA, you’ll have probably worked out what our business idea is – ‘to offer a wide range of well-designed, functional home furnishing products at prices so low that as many people as possible will be able to afford them’.

This equation should not be interpreted as a mathematical expression. The matters that we (will) discuss here cannot (in principle) be expressed in numbers. It’s about the thought behind it. We already mentioned in Chapter 1 that products are not only about the ‘real’, functional ‘returns’ but that emotional aspects – the associations with a brand – also play a role. An advantage that lies somewhat in the middle between functional and emotional benefits is the degree of customer friendliness that a customer experiences with a provider: how you feel treated and how ‘nice’ they are to you. The polite customer friendliness of a provider has several advantages for a customer. First, of course, emotionally: it just feels nice when people are nice to you, for example, in the hospitality

68  Situation analysis

industry when you go out for dinner, but also when you are being treated by a doctor. Customer friendliness also has practical advantages: if they know you, they already know what your preferences are, and it is easier to buy something, for example, in a clothing store. Costs are not just about monetary costs but about ‘sacrifices’ in a broad sense, so, for example, also the effort to be able to buy the product somewhere. Finally, ‘costs’ also include societal costs, such as the ecological footprint. So: Customer value = (Functional and emotional benefits) + (Customer friendliness) – (Price and customer sacrifices and societal sacrifices)

3.2.2  The Brand Benefitting Model Based on the aforementioned definition of customer values, a company can therefore choose from various options to satisfy customers. In other words: to make a choice from the brand promises. That is the basis for the Brand Benefitting Model developed by us (Figure 3.3). On the left side of the model are the revenues for the customer; on the right side are the ‘costs’. There are three types of revenue (benefits): 1 2

The highest quality (in the narrow sense). This applies to products that score best in tests or services that are delivered with a high degree of professionalism. Things like innovation and creative listening to the customer are of great importance. Service and customer orientation. These two concepts belong together: a company that handles complaints properly, for example, offers good (aftersales) service on

A company should: •Have all values on a sufficient level •Excel in one

Increase value for customer

Quality Best performance

Service Interaction and service

Lower the costs for customer and society

Price Lowest price

Convenience Easy access and convenience

Sustainable Low footprint

Emotional value Feelings and imagery

Figure 3.3  A classification of brand promises: the Brand Benefitting Model

Mission, customer values, and market definition 69

3

this point and is customer oriented. We do not count getting ‘customized’ advice that is done online as part of this benefit. We mean real customer attention and service (see Case 3.3). Strong emotional associations. We have placed this at the bottom of the model because, in our opinion, brands should always create emotional associations.

Companies can also be best at lowering the sacrifices. These are: 1 2

3

The lowest price. Convenience. There are two forms of convenience: n easy access to product or service, for example, short waiting times and quick accessibility; n ease of use: products that are simple or services that are clear Socially responsible, so very sustainable and no ‘future costs’ for society.

If a company scores sufficiently on all benefits, it must then also enable the link to the customer’s feelings by adding emotional values to the product or service. These are therefore at the bottom of the model. By competing both instrumentally and emotionally, a company applies so-called two-way positioning (see Section 11.3.3). In our opinion, a combination of instrumental and emotional positioning has two main advantages: n It provides better opportunities for finding distinctive core values because compet-

ing on quality alone, for example, is not distinctive.

n It offers the strongest opportunities to build a relationship with the customer because

the customer is addressed at both ‘the head’ and ‘the heart’.

If we make a link with the content of the core of marketing, then it can be said that the Brand Benefitting Model lays the foundation for the search for that promise that forms the best fit between the strengths of the company and the wishes of the target group. The model can also be used in the internal analysis to determine how strong the company is on the various brand promises. The same can be done with the competitor analysis. In anticipation of the models discussed in the following, it also applies to the Brand Benefitting Model that companies must first ‘score’ on all five benefits and then try to excel in one benefit. For example, it is obvious to expect that in the very near future, all brands will have to have a certain degree of sustainability as a precondition to be purchased. That does not necessarily mean that you are top at it as a brand, but it does mean that you are sufficient.

3.2.3  The value strategies of Treacy and Wiersema In the much-cited article ‘Customer Intimacy and Other Value Disciplines’, Treacy and Wiersema (1993) (T&W) present three possible value disciplines (or value strategies): 1 2 3

product leadership operational excellence or leading in low cost for the customer customer intimacy or an individual customer approach

70  Situation analysis

1  Product leadership Product leadership is the development of innovative, value-added products. This strategy is used, for example, by Procter & Gamble, which, in all markets in which it operates, maintains that Procter brands are the highest quality in the category and best serve the consumer need for which the product is made. Other examples of companies that seem to opt for product leadership are technologically strong companies such as Apple, Microsoft, Philips, and Sony (see Case 3.2).

2  Operational excellence Operational excellence means to excel in the proper and efficient execution of all business processes. An ‘excellent production process’ must lead to the customer having to incur as few ‘costs’ as possible. In addition, a low price is the most obvious way to meet

Case 3.2  Sony: innovation in technology and entertainment Sony’s business falls into technology and entertainment (such as the PlayStation and Sony Pictures [movies]) – so basically ‘hardware’ and ‘software’. Sony’s mission is to inspire and ‘fulfill your curiosity’. Sony says it has an unlimited passion for technology, content, and services, and, through its continuous innovation, for delivering new exciting entertainment, creating unique new cultures and experiences. ‘Everything we do is to move you emotionally’.

Mission, customer values, and market definition 71

a customer need. Incidentally, this is not necessary: ‘costs’ can also be non-financial, such as the effort to buy the product (convenience). ‘Always delivering on time’ can also be part of it. Important in this value strategy for a company is standardization and the achievement of economies of scale. This strategy is chosen, for example, by the airline easyJet, which saves costs in as many areas as possible (including the ‘service’ en route: food is only provided for an extra fee) and is therefore able to compete at very low prices. Other companies that excel in operational excellence are McDonald’s (see Case 3.3), Aldi, IKEA, and, in the United States, Wal-Mart. This value strategy is explicitly about excelling in efficiency. In principle, every company will of course try to keep its own costs as low as possible and to have the internal processes run as smoothly as possible, but that does not mean that these companies excel in low costs for the customer.

3  Customer intimacy Customer intimacy means an individual customer approach (customer leadership or the best in relationship marketing). Obtaining ‘intimate’ relationships with the customer

Case 3.3  Operational excellence

McDonald’s manages to keep costs low through uniform choices McDonald’s is a good example of an unambiguous global formula. By applying a ‘global strategy’, McDonald’s is able to achieve enormous cost advantages. It seems that for fast food, it doesn’t make much difference which culture you operate in. In this case, perhaps you can also turn it around: McDonald’s has created the fast food culture itself in various cultures. That, too, is part of marketing: teaching consumers something instead of just following them.

72  Situation analysis

through the provision of customized products and/or through a policy that is completely focused on attention to the individual customer and customer loyalty is paramount. Many online providers, such as Amazon, Netflix, and bol, but also small and medium-sized enterprises (SMEs), seem to choose this strategy because they know exactly what people’s preferences are. Based on this, they can make recommendations and offers. But this is not ‘true customer focus’. Customer intimacy is also normal in business markets: personal contacts and products and services tailored to individual customers (companies) are common in industrial markets. In small and medium-sized companies, a truly personal, individual customer strategy also seems to be applicable. There are also opportunities for implementing customer intimacy in service markets and consumer retail. In marketing practice, however, many service providers in the Netherlands are more concerned with sales than with building relationships. Few providers excel in this strategy in other industries as well. There are companies that pay attention to individual customer retention (such as KLM). But that doesn’t mean the company excels at it. Customer intimacy therefore seems to be able to offer a competitive advantage in many industries in the future. T&W argue that every company must make a basic choice of excelling in one of three disciplines: what value does the company want to best provide? This choice determines the entire business: production, personnel, marketing, and so on. In addition, the other two value disciplines must also be at a sufficient level. This last condition is sometimes forgotten in the description of T&W. This addition is very important, because T&W state that a company can only excel in one of the three if, for example, a minimum level of quality of internal processes (operational excellence) has been achieved (see Figure 3.4). So, in fact, a company can only excel in one discipline when all three disciplines are at

A company has to: • First have all three strategies at a sufficient level and • Then excel in one of the three value strategies

Product leadership

Operational excellence

Customer intimacy

Higher gains for the customer

Lowest costs for the customer

Most attention to the customer

• Product quality/ innovations

• Low price

• Good at customer relations

• Brand name

• Low other sacrifices

• Products and services tailored to the customer Not yet very widespread

Figure 3.4  Value strategies

Mission, customer values, and market definition 73

a decent level. A company must therefore first get things ‘right’ in terms of innovation, efficiency, and customer focus before it can achieve excellence. Incidentally, due to the growth of the internet, the distinction between the value strategies has become blurred. This is especially true of the difference between operational excellence and customer intimacy, which can be remarkably almost the same online, because in the online examples mentioned, the online technology provides a ‘customized’ advice or loyalty program, respectively. This gives the customer the feeling that something is being done especially for them. But this has essentially nothing to do with personal customer relationships, because no one at the provider is involved! There are, however, more comments to be made about the classification of T&W. That’s not how brand thinking works, and sustainability plays no role. It is also the case that the value strategies are not really defined in terms of customer needs: they say more about the internal processes of a company. Our Brand Benefitting Model does meet those requirements. At the same time, T&W’s supply orientation is also an advantage: it makes it easier to categorize the activities of companies.

3.2.4  Format of Porter The classification of T&W shows similarities with the generic competitive strategies of Porter (1980). Porter lists three ways in which a company can distinguish itself: 1 2 3

differentiation: distinguishing itself from the competition cost leadership: striving for the lowest cost level in the industry a focus strategy: focusing on one segment or niche

Porter also mentions a fourth strategy: ‘stuck in the middle’. This means that no clear choice has been made. According to Porter, strong profitability is never achieved with this. We agree with the latter. However, Porter’s classification itself is not very telling. After all, differentiation must follow each provider (competitive advantage). The question is mainly what. Lowest cost says little about customer needs, and focus is a targeting strategy and says little about where the company excels.

3.2.5  Conclusions about the classifications We draw the following conclusions about the classifications of strategies: 1

2

A general conclusion that applies to all classifications is that a provider must make a choice about what it wants to excel in. This corresponds to one of the ‘brand laws’ to be covered later in this book, namely ‘focus’. At the same time, the provider must score sufficiently on other customer values. For all classifications, the question is also justified whether they relate to the entire company: can different customer values be chosen within a company? Hendry (1990) states in his article ‘The Problem with Porter’s Generic Strategies’ that Porter’s concept should be involved at the SBU level. If we extend this to the classification of T&W, we see that a value strategy must be chosen within an SBU but that different value strategies are possible between SBUs. The clearest is a value strategy for an

74  Situation analysis

3

entire company, but if there are more or less autonomously functioning divisions or SBUs within a company, then differences in value strategies are conceivable. Porter’s and T&W’s classifications are not both based on customer needs and therefore lack consistency. The relationship with the internet is also difficult to explain.

All in all, the Brand Benefitting Model is best suited to really think in terms of customer values. T&W can be used to look at the internal processes of companies. These must then be translated into customer values, which is the subject of the Brand Benefitting Model.

3.3 Market definition In this section, we will successively discuss: n n n n

market definition at the SBU level (Section 3.3.1) market definition at the product-brand level (Section 3.3.2) market definition and new activities (Section 3.3.3) the importance and danger of the market definition (Section 3.3.4)

3.3.1  Market definition at the SBU level For convenience, we defined a strategic business unit around a specific market or product category in Chapter 2, for example, the SBUs salad dressing, children’s clothing, student accounts, and travel insurance. This definition implies that an SBU is not always clearly visible as an organizational unit in a company. A market definition at the level of an SBU takes place in a similar way to the mission: on the basis of the dimensions products, target groups, and needs. There are differences between the corporate level and the SBU level: n Since marketing plans are drawn up at the SBU level, the market definition at the

SBU level should be as concrete as possible, while somewhat vaguer terms can be used in the mission statement. n An SBU’s market will by definition be narrower than that of the company; the sum of all the SBUs market definitions will, in theory, correspond to the company-wide market definition. Defining the customer’s need has a direct influence on the breadth of the competition. A competitor is, by definition, a provider that can meet the same customer needs. The way in which the need is defined therefore determines the competition. So not only are instrumental needs important but also properties derived from products, such as prestige and status. These values can also be used in the market definition. We illustrate the use of the dimensions at the level of an SBU with an example (see Figure 3.5). A manufacturer’s SBU ‘jam’ examines the possibilities in three different dimensions: 1 2 3

customer function customer groups customer technology

Mission, customer values, and market definition 75

The need that is being addressed is defined instrumentally in this example and is the need for spreads. Alternative needs are pie filling and dessert components. Possible customer groups are home users, catering, healthcare, and canteens in companies. Alternative customer technologies (corresponding to the need for sandwich fillings) are peanut butter, sprinkles, sandwich spread, cheese spread, cheese, and meat products. Within these dimensions, the following market definition has been chosen: ‘We meet the need for spreads among home users by making jam’. Incidentally, we should note with regard to Figure 3.5 that it is in principle constructed for the level of the final customers (consumers). The use of the three dimensions mentioned is not only important for defining the current market but also makes it possible to think about possible growth directions in a structured manner when making business decisions. In particular, the well-known four growth strategies of Ansoff (1957; see also Section 10.3.2) can be directly linked to the axes in Figure 3.5. The relationships between the market definition dimensions and Ansoff ‘s growth strategies are shown in Figure 3.6. Figure 3.6 shows which growth strategy is applicable for a particular combination of changes in market dimensions. For example, if one wishes to grow within the existing three dimensions, there is market penetration. This is also the case if only the customer function dimension is changed. Growth along only the customer group dimension implies market development, while growth with only expansions of the product dimension (i.e. for the same needs and customers) is called product development. Change in both the customer groups and products dimension means diversification. If these are related products that cover the same needs, then there is related diversification. If other needs are also met, then there is unrelated diversification.

Customer functions

Desserts Cake filling

Sandwich filling Customer technologies Home users Catering industry

Jam

Sandwich spread Cheese Peanut butter Cheese spread Sliced meat

Health care Company cafeterias Customer groups

Figure 3.5  Market definition for a jam manufacturer

76  Situation analysis Customer function

Customer groups

Buyer technology (producer)

Growth strategy according to Ansoff

Example jam manufacturer







Market penetration

Price reduction jam

×





Market penetration

Emphasize another application: jam as pie filling



×



Market development

Selling jam to the catering industry or abroad





×

Product development

Manufacturing peanut butter for consumers



×

×

Related diversification

Sell peanut butter abroad

×

×

Unrelated diversification

Fruit juices or readymade pizza fabrication

Figure 3.6  Market dimensions and growth strategies; – or × means: no or change of this dimension

Figure 3.6 can serve as a checklist when generating growth options. Generation of options is covered in the SWOT analysis in Chapter 9. Final decisions on growth directions are made after the situational analysis accompanying the corporate strategy. That is why we return to growth strategies in Chapters 10 and 11.

3.3.2  Market definition at product-brand level In addition to a market definition at the SBU level, a more detailed definition can be helpful for brands in further analyses. In concrete terms, this could involve a division of two of the three dimensions mentioned above: target groups and products/services. Then the following three steps must be taken: 1 2

3

First, all products are listed. For companies that produce goods, this can probably be done quickly. This is already a lot more difficult for providers of services: what are the products of a bank? Then the various (customer) target groups of the organization are described. An obvious division is the distinction between private individuals (final customers) and companies (business markets). But of course it is possible to segment within these groups according to various (segmentation) variables that range from general background characteristics (age, type of company, retail chain, etc.) to more product-related variables, such as heavy versus light ‘users’ or price buyers versus quality seekers. Finally, it must be indicated which combinations of products and target groups are current for the organization.

Figure 3.7 contains some fill-in schemes that can be used for this. An advantage of overviews such as those in Figure 3.7 is that they can be the starting point for later analyses. Case 3.4 is an example of market dimensions in sports markets.

Mission, customer values, and market definition 77

Figure 3.7 Worksheets for defining product-market combinations. Mark each section with an ‘x’ if that combination exists for the organization

3.3.3 Market definition and new activities Defining the market (at the company, SBU, and product level) for the situation analysis seems to imply that the definition is not influenced by the outcomes of the situation analysis. In practice, this influence does exist. If, for example, the market for newspapers and magazines on which a publisher is active develops very unfavorably, this may be a reason to adjust the publisher’s mission (for example, to be active in the consumer market of the press) and to become active as well in information provision for companies. In that case, the question becomes what should our business be? (information provision for companies), answered differently than the question what business are we in? (consumer market press). Here the relationship with the vision becomes clear again: the vision is the difference between the current and the desired market. A difference in the field of activities now and what is planned does mean that this new field (in the example, news offerings via the internet) must also be analyzed to determine whether this new market is attractive.

78  Situation analysis

Case 3.4  Offering several markets

Market dimensions in sport markets Organizations in sports markets (clubs, associations, stadiums, etc.) deal with two target groups: spectators/viewers and advertisers (sponsors). The definition of the ‘product’ sport is ‘battle’. The special thing about this product is that it is not stable. Its course and outcome are always uncertain. There are two forms of sports marketing: marketing of sports and marketing through sports (sponsorship). Organizations dealing with the marketing of ‘struggle’ (sports) can apply the planning concepts described in this book. It is about selling your own product as well as possible to viewers and advertisers and building relationships with these target groups. Marketing through sports is mainly about communication. Sponsors can use the medium of sports organizations to achieve brand objectives (familiarity, image) and to build their own relationships (e.g. invite customers to skyboxes). Paris Saint-Germain is an example of a club/brand that has consciously worked on its image since its acquisition in 2011 by Qatar Sport Investments, going from a relatively unknown brand, sometimes associated with lower social classes, to ‘the one and only Parisian football club’ with a different logo (a stylized Eiffel Tower) and investments in top players who themselves possess considerable ‘brand equity’ such as Neymar, Messi and Ibrahimovic. The result is also entrance tickets are extremely expensive.

Mission, customer values, and market definition 79

Finally, one may wonder whether ideas for new activities emerge if one analyzes only the existing markets from the existing SBUs. In this regard, we note that both the SWOT analysis and the reconsideration of the mission should explicitly pay attention to signals that point to opportunities outside the current activities. Summarizing the foregoing, we can indicate the following four steps in defining the market and formulating the mission: 1 2 3 4

Start from a definition of the market in which one is currently active. Perform an external analysis of the environment. Also analyze opportunities and threats outside the existing market. Based on the external (and internal) analysis, analyze whether there is reason to become active outside the existing market. In other words: define the desired market. If yes, perform a new external analysis with the changed market definition. This is necessary because with a different market definition, there is also a different competitive situation, different market growth, and so on. In the case of a broader definition, the number of competitors will be higher.

After conducting another external analysis, the company must then ask itself whether it still finds the chosen market attractive. If so, the planning process continues. We have summarized this in Figure 3.8. In short, the phases ‘definition of the (current) market’, ‘external analysis’, and ‘formulation of business decisions: definition of the desired market’ are completed when there is no reason to change the market definition. Incidentally, we should note that in practice these steps are usually completed only once or at most twice: first for the current market and then for a more broadly defined market (see Case 3.5).

Definition of the (current) market (Chapter 2)

Internal analysis

External analysis

Definition of the desired market (Chapter 9)

Continuation of planning process

Figure 3.8  Market definition and external analysis

80  Situation analysis

Case 3.5  Market definition

Board games or online games Suppose a manufacturer uses the current market definition/mission: ‘manufacturing board games’. An analysis of the board game market now shows that sales are declining. An important cause of this seems to be the rise of online games. Based on this observation, the manufacturer must make an important choice: not to change the mission and try to maintain sales of board games through marketing efforts or to adjust the mission and decide to also enter the online gaming market. The choice of whether to adjust the mission depends, among other things, on the situation in the online games market. The manufacturer therefore carries out an additional external analysis, namely of the online games market. This shows that there is very strong competition in this market and that completely different knowhow is needed to gain a strong position in that market. On this basis, the manufacturer decides not to adjust its mission but to try to restore its sales of board games by focusing more on the use of board games around the holidays. In practice, repeating a situation analysis is also often carried out when the company is considering becoming active abroad. In that case, the market abroad must be analyzed in the second round.

3.3.4  Importance and danger of the market definition In an article that has become a classic entitled ‘Marketing Myopia’, Levitt (1960) warned against an overly supply-oriented definition of a market. In the mission, we already mentioned the example of the too-narrow, product-oriented market definition of Swiss watch manufacturers (Section 3.1.2). It is of great strategic importance how broadly or narrowly a manager

Mission, customer values, and market definition 81

defines the market. After all, if a company defines the market broadly, there will be many competitors. However, if a company starts from a niche (or segment), the number of competitors is by definition limited. There is therefore a direct relationship between the market definition and the number of competitors: market definition can be regarded as ‘defining the competitive set’ (Lehmann & Winer, 2008). This implies that there is also a direct relationship with the concept of market share. Because the market share is calculated over the defined market, a narrow market definition (for example, the market of health yogurts) implies a higher market share than a broad market definition (the market of yogurts). It is not uncommon for us to see in practice that equities are calculated on sub-markets instead of entire markets. In this context, Lehmann and Winer distinguish four levels of competition: 1 2 3 4

Product form competition: Competition between brands targeting the same market segment, such as Pepsi Light versus Coke Light. Product category competition: competition between products with similar properties, such as different soft drinks. Generic competition: products that meet the same consumer needs, such as beverages. Budget competition: competition for consumer money, such as food and entertainment.

Market definitions in annual marketing planning are usually based on product form or product category competition. In Chapter 7, we discuss these forms of competition in more detail in the identification of competitors.

Summary In order to carry out a situation analysis, it must first be known in which market the company is active and what customer value the company is pursuing. These are important preconditions within which the marketing strategy must be developed. The market definition has to do with the mission of the company and the customer value with the vision. Studying these two should lead to the identification of the market and customer value. Organizations are best managed when there is a clear mission and a common vision. A mission concerns a demarcation of the current activities and possible social goals. A vision refers to the future. Which development in the target group does top management consider important? What identity should the organization have (value strategy choice)? And what are (other) long-term goals? A choice for a customer value is very important: a company that does not specialize in anything will achieve low profitability on average. In principle, companies can choose from the following promises: best product quality, best service and customer attention, lowest price, highest convenience, best durability. In addition, emotional positioning is important. Incidentally, specialization is only possible after the company has reached a sufficient level in terms of innovation, quality of processes and customer focus. The market for the organization is defined in the mission statement. At the level of the SBU, a further market definition takes place on the basis of the dimensions products, needs, and target groups. The market definition chosen at that level forms the starting point of the situation analysis. At product or brand level, the target groups dimension can often be broken down even further in order to obtain a more detailed definition of product-market combinations. It is important to use a demand-driven market definition that is not too narrow, because otherwise a company overlooks competitors and runs the risk of being overtaken by an unexpected angle.

82  Situation analysis

Coffee is an experience

It happens millions of times a week – a customer receives a drink from a Starbucks barista – yet it’s unique every time. It’s a snapshot: a hand reaching over the counter to pass a cup of coffee to another outstretched hand, a name on a Starbucks cup, a brief break with a latte. But every contact with a customer also creates a connection. Starbucks is committed to honoring that connection in everything they do – from striving for the best-quality coffee to working with partners and suppliers to conduct business responsibly – and has been since the beginning of the company.

The beginning – and why conquering the heart of coffee culture took so long In 1971, when the first Starbucks coffee shop opened in Seattle’s old Pike Place Market, it was just a one-shop business. Starbucks sold a selection of the world’s best freshly roasted coffee beans from this small shop. The name, inspired by the story of Moby Dick, evoked the romance of the early days of coffee in the 18th and 19th centuries. In the years that followed, Starbucks increasingly focused on the romance of the coffee experience. The Italian coffee house tradition was copied: a place for conversation and a sense of togetherness. A sense of home. Starbucks grew in the 1980s and 1990s and successfully internationalized as well. Starbucks set foot in several European countries. However, the expansion to Italy was long delayed. For good reason – food touches the heart of Italian culture, and Italians don’t take it easy on American corporations trying to change their culture. Large American

Mission, customer values, and market definition 83

corporations like Ben and Jerry’s and Häagen-Dazs, for instance, tried to sell ice cream in the Italian market, with mixed results, to say the least. When Ben and Jerry’s opened a shop in the touristic Piazza del Duomo in Florence years ago, they were shunned by the Italians, who regarded the hard American ice cream as an insult to Italy’s wonderfully soft gelato, as well as the American tourists, who didn’t travel all the way across the Atlantic for ice cream they could get back home. The shop closed after about two years. Häagen-Dazs was another American brand that met the same fate in Florence. If there is any culture in the world that takes its coffee seriously, it’s the Italian. Coffee is part of Italian culture, a ritual engrained in people’s habits. People start the day with an espresso that they drink standing at the counter of one of the tens of thousands coffee bars that you can find in even the smallest villages. The Starbucks way of imitating – and Americanizing – Italian coffee culture can be considered an insult by Italians. Therefore, the introduction had to be planned carefully. The first Italian Starbucks opened in Milano in 2018. Starbucks picked Milan as its entry point, a city that matches tradition with a modern global lifestyle, and also a city of fashion and finance. This contrasts with Naples and Rome, where the espresso culture is much more sacred. Located in a trendy square near some of Milan’s top tourist attractions, the 25,000-square-foot building is outfitted in Tuscan marble and gleaming copper, featuring extravagances such as a 500-pound in-house coffee roaster, augmented reality (AR)-configured walls, an aperitivo bar, and a liquid nitrogen affogato station. Old mixed with new at Starbucks Milan, a perfect metaphor for the meeting of American and Italian coffee cultures. The marble floor of the store was constructed in a traditional Palladian style, while the ceiling was built using the latest technology. The building’s facade is an imposing structure that used to be the city’s historic post office. Starting in 2018, Starbucks gradually expanded to around 20 stores in northern and central Italy, with the first Starbucks finally opening in Rome in 2022.

Starbucks changes – step by step Starbucks has become a global success. Since its beginning, the company changed gradually to what it has become now. Nowadays, in addition to good coffee, Starbucks also serves all kinds of trendy drinks. This started with taking over The Coffee Connection in 1994, including the ‘Frappuccino’ that has since been for sale at all Starbucks locations. This was followed by further changes in the offerings, like adding cheesecake and a number of other snacks. In addition to coffee, you can also get tea at Starbucks. Starbucks has hosted the tea brand Tazo since 1999. Another milestone was the introduction of the sub-brand ‘Starbucks Reserve’: exclusive, premium coffee, available at selected Starbucks locations. The largest stores in cities such as New York and Chicago got a special Starbucks Reserve corner, where a real barista prepared the special coffees. Due to the success of

84  Situation analysis

Starbucks Reserve, Starbucks decided to open its first Starbucks Reserve Roastery in Seattle. These ‘coffee theme parks’ are heaven for coffee lovers. Coffee beans are roasted on site and transported through transparent tubes to the coffee bars. Each Starbucks Reserve Roastery has its own style, combining industrial with luxury. You can also drink coffee cocktails or buy Starbucks coffee with a whiskey flavor. Starbucks is an experience, and sometimes even more than that. For some people it even replaces the workplace. In addition, for many, Starbucks remains a short stopover for a coffee to go and a quick snack. The most important thing for Starbucks is that customers do not consider themselves a customer but a kind of family friend. When you place your order, you will first be asked what your name is. They you hear someone shouting ‘one latte for Roger’. And then it’s ‘Roger, your latte is ready’. And when you leave: ‘Bye, Roger’. It gives the feeling ‘they know me here; they like me’. The feeling of home is further enhanced by the relaxed chairs and the tables littered with newspapers, comic books, and magazines. The free Wi-Fi makes the coffee store the perfect place to work or meet your friends in a homey atmosphere. Starbucks has become a real status symbol in many countries in Europe. In the Netherlands, for example, you can see that after people have finished their Starbucks cup, they continue to carry their cup for a long time. Starbucks is a strong brand, but something else plays a role in the Netherlands. ‘For us, the memory of America is also very much attached to it’, according to Dutch communications advisor Marc Pos. When you walk into Starbucks, your mind is in New York. Any Dutch person who has been to America remembers his Starbucks visit there. The memory is what makes Starbucks so much fun. You feel like a cosmopolitan, and at the same time it feels familiar. The Dutch are real coffee drinkers, but much has changed in this country in less than 20 years. The Dutch used to drink a cup from one large pot of coffee, shared with all family members. But now it’s all about variation, surprise, and experience. ‘There is an evolution in coffee going on’, according to the commercial director of Starbucks Netherlands. ‘Not so long ago it was “do you want coffee?”, now it is “what coffee do you want?” Everyone has their own preferences, their own tastes’. Young shoppers and millennials are looking for variety and surprise. Their expectations regarding coffee flavors, coffee experience, and brands are formed in the out-of-home coffee world. In addition, it also has to be top-quality coffee from the best arabica beans and prepared with real milk. Starbucks is the brand that has not only made coffee trendy, it is certainly the brand that continues to surprise with new flavors and blends. An important strategic step for Starbucks was its introduction in supermarkets in the years following 2010. From then on, coffee with the Starbucks logo was also available in European supermarkets. This made it possible for consumers to make Starbucks coffee at home. In Europe, the sale of coffee products in supermarkets

Mission, customer values, and market definition 85

is the result of a collaboration with the Swiss food giant Nestlé. The whole coffee beans and roasted and ground coffee of Starbucks are combined with capsules (cups) developed with the technologies behind Nespresso and Nescafé Dolce Gusto. These capsules can be used in machines that also make Nespresso and Nescafé coffee. Starbucks was not afraid that the brand would be perceived as less special by consumers if it were available everywhere. The company sees the arrival of the new products as a reinforcement of the brand. Retail experts agree: ‘In a coffee store you experience drinking a cup of Starbucks coffee very differently than at home on the couch. People are willing to pay extra for the Starbucks experience. Coffee is emotion’. A final development for Starbucks was stimulated by the coronavirus pandemic. Before, almost all sales were in Starbucks stores and retail, but due to COVID-19, delivery boomed. People order Starbucks coffee from their home or workplace, sometimes several times a day. One might think, why order coffee and have it delivered? But Starbucks lovers do because of the unique brand experience.

The view of a Starbucks general manager Bas Rietveld is general manager of Starbucks Netherlands. He emphasizes the importance of experience. ‘We have a Reserve Bar in our Amsterdam Starbucks location’, says Rietveld, pointing to a bar with an immense coffee machine. We offer coffees that are not available anywhere else in continental Europe. Single blends, hand roasted, truly unique. Some of our guests have a coffee passport. It lists the unique coffees they have tasted. Very nice, those are the real enthusiasts. ‘We always refer to our employees as partners’, says Rietveld. They are professionals, baristas, they know coffee. They share the coffee experience with our guests. When we have a meeting with each other, at the store or at the head office, we always start with a coffee tasting. All the time. In addition, people are trained several times a year, everything to keep coffee knowledge updated. According to Rietveld, sustainability is also an important theme. For example, Starbucks stopped serving its Frappuccino in transparent cups in 2023. ‘That doesn’t seem that much of a strategic challenge, but it is. Our iced coffees are “Instagrammable” in a transparent cup. You see them regularly on social media. So we have to come up with an alternative’.’ Reducing the environmental impact of the cups coincides with two other efforts: developing solutions for recyclable cups and dramatically increasing the use of reusable cups by Starbucks customers. Rietveld says: ‘For example, we encourage Starbucks customers to use their own reusable mugs or cups for their drinks’.

86  Situation analysis

Starbucks: mission and core values www.starbucks.com describes the mission and core values extensively: From the beginning, Starbucks set out to be a different kind of company. One that not only celebrated coffee but also connection. We’re a neighborhood gathering place, a part of your daily routine. Get to know us and you’ll see: we are so much more than what we brew. We call our employees partners because we are all partners in shared success. We make sure everything we do is through the lens of humanity – from our commitment to the highest-quality coffee in the world, to the way we engage with our customers and communities to do business responsibly. Our Mission To inspire and nurture the human spirit – one person, one cup and one neighborhood at a time. Our Values With our partners, our coffee and our customers at our core, we live these values: n Creating a culture of warmth and belonging, where everyone is welcome. n Delivering our very best in all we do, holding ourselves accountable for

results.

n Acting with courage, challenging the status quo and finding new ways to

grow our company and each other.

n Being present, connecting with transparency, dignity and respect.

A culture of inclusion We’re committed to upholding a culture where inclusion, diversity, equity and accessibility are valued and respected. Your entire experience – starting with your application – is designed to be the beginning of an inspirational journey, where you are treated warmly and with transparency, dignity and respect. We actively hire individuals with disabilities and provide reasonable accommodations and assistive technologies that enable people to do their jobs. Starbucks is committed to offering reasonable accommodation for job applicants with disabilities.

Corporate social responsibility at Starbucks Starbucks’s commitment is reflected in the actions that Starbucks and coffee farmers around the world are taking to ensure the future of coffee remains sustainable and strong. Starbucks.com lists six examples: 1 Sustainable purchasing and cultivation. Starbucks coffee is 99% ethically sourced, and the company is on a mission to make coffee the world’s first

Mission, customer values, and market definition 87

sustainably sourced agricultural product. Starbucks buys coffee verified by C.A.F.E. (Coffee and Farmer Equity Practices). Developed in conjunction with Conservation International, these guidelines provide comprehensive social, environmental, and economic criteria to help sustain and strengthen coffee communities. 2 Open source agronomy. Starbucks Farmer Support Centers in Hacienda Alsacia in Costa Rica and in eight other coffee countries around the world bring together agronomists, researchers, and farmers to make coffee more sustainable and profitable. 3 Climate-resistant coffee trees. Starbucks has donated more than 31 million climate-resilient coffee trees. Farmers, whether they grow coffee for Starbucks or not, can use these trees to replace diseased or old trees. Starbucks aims to supply 100 million trees to farmers by 2025. 4 Loans for farmers. The Starbucks Global Farmer Fund has invested €41 million in coffee-producing countries around the world, funds that farmers can use to renovate and strengthen their farms and farming practices to be even more productive and sustainable. 5 Support in difficult times. Starbucks is using the Farmer Support Centers to share information and supplies during the difficult COVID-19 period. In addition, the Starbucks Foundation donated $1 million to support education, communications, supplies, and materials aimed at helping prevent COVID-19 in coffee, tea, and cocoa farming communities. 6 Invest in a variety of high-quality coffee. Starbucks also sources high-quality coffee grown by smaller coffee growers from a wide variety of places around the world. Female coffee growers also receive special attention. Inspired by www.starbucks.com, consulted on September 6, 2022, and the Forbes article ‘Why It Took Starbucks 47 Years to Open a Store in Italy’, September 13, 2018. The interview quotes with Bas Rietveld are based on an article in Move-On Magazine (www.moveonmagazine.nl/koffie-thuis-laten-deliver-yes-do-that-starbucksfans) also accessed September 6, 2022.

Questions 1

2 3 4

Treacy and Wiersema distinguish three value disciplines. a Which value discipline was chosen by Starbucks? Please explain your answer. b Explain whether the T&W model is fully applicable to Starbucks. Which brand promise is central to Starbucks according to the Brand Benefitting Model? Explain your answer. Create a ‘three-dimensional’ representation of the market definition for Star­ bucks at the consumer level. The book distinguishes four levels of competition. Identify potential competitors of Starbucks for each of these levels

88  Situation analysis

5 6 7

Assess the mission statement of Starbucks. To what extent does this mission statement fit in with the components and objectives of a mission as defined in the book? The book distinguishes three components of corporate social responsibility. Give examples of each component for Starbucks. The case describes Starbucks’s step-by-step transition process. Name the most important changes and indicate which growth strategy from Ansoff’s matrix each change corresponds to.

Chapter 4

Internal analysis

Phase 1 Analysis Mission, customer value and market definition (3)

External analysis

Internal analysis

Customer analysis (5) Industry analysis (6)

Competitor analysis (7) Analysis of distribution and suppliers (8)

SWOT (9) Phase 2 Strategy Corporate objectives and strategy (10)

Marketing objectives and strategy (11)

Phase 3 Tactics Product, Price, Place (12); Promotion (13)

Organization of marketing and Personnel (14)

DOI: 10.4324/9781003381488-6

90  Situation analysis

Key points in this chapter n Know how to define objectives for a company n Recognize the importance of sustainability and the trade-off with growth

objectives

n Be capable of analyzing a brand’s strengths and weaknesses n Use the customer perspective in the internal analysis

Introduction In Chapter 3 we defined the market. Chapters 4 to 8 map out the company’s internal and external environment. Within that environment, the analysis of (potential) customers is the most important. Customer wishes can change the fastest and can best be influenced by the company. All other components of the situation analysis generally change less quickly and are much less easily influenced by marketing policy. This applies not only to competitive behavior and industry trends, for example, but also to many internal matters, such as management culture or financial position. In short: many parts of the situation analysis can be regarded as preconditions for marketing strategy formation, while customer behavior can best be influenced and offers the most opportunities. With regard to the order of the elements of the situation analysis, we choose – for practical reasons – to start with the company itself. Most of the data is available from the company itself. Starting with the company also offers the opportunity to first look back at what has been achieved so far and to see where any problems lie. The external analysis then takes place in Chapters 5 to 8, starting with the most important group: the (potential) customers. This chapter has two goals: an evaluation of the results so far and an analysis of its own strengths and weaknesses. It is important to determine what makes the company unique. When one’s own strengths and weaknesses are compared to those of the competitors, insight is gained into the relative strengths and weaknesses relative to the competition. These relative strengths and weaknesses are compared to the opportunities and threats in Chapter 9. We start in Section 4.1 with a brief consideration of how objectives should be formulated and what their role is in the planning cycle. The first step is then a reassessment of the company objectives (balanced scorecard). This place in the planning process therefore involves a reassessment of the goals; new goals are set after the SWOT. Section 4.2 discusses the application of the balanced scorecard. Section 4.3 outlines a design for an evaluation of the ‘other results’ (control). Sections 4.4 and 4.5 show how the internal analysis can be carried out further, at the company and brand levels, respectively.

4.1 Objectives and the PDCA cycle Goals and planning go hand in hand. We will first explain this on the basis of requirements for goals and the so-called PDCA cycle.

Internal analysis 91

4.1.1  Requirements for objectives Formulating an objective has two functions. First, the objective within the company serves as a guideline for what one wants to achieve. An objective, therefore, has, among other things, a communicative and a motivational function: everyone knows what is being worked towards. A second function of an objective is that the goal is an instrument in the planning process: a goal is a standard for answering the question of whether a strategy is successful. If the objective is achieved, the company can be satisfied (and perhaps continue on the same footing); if the goal is not achieved, the strategy probably needs to be changed. Based on the aforementioned functions, an objective should meet five requirements, summarized in the acronym SMART (originally introduced by Doran, 1981): 1 2 3 4 5

Specific Measurable Ambitious Realistic Timed

Specific means that it must be clear what the objective is about. Measurability means that it can actually be registered whether the objective has been achieved. The objective must therefore be expressed in measurable variables and preferably be quantitative: expressed in numbers. In practice, objectives are often used that are not quantitative, for example, ‘achieving a high market share’, ‘a reasonable profit’, ‘being able to continuously offer high-quality products’, or ‘a good working atmosphere’. Although it is not in itself objectionable that a company has such qualitative objectives, it should be realized that they cannot play a role in the planning process. At most, they have a motivating effect, but the question is ultimately whether the management has achieved the goals: for example, is there a good working atmosphere now? Ambitious or challenging means that one should not start from objectives that are too ‘low’. Choosing an aspiration level that is too low results in a decrease in motivation to perform. However, the objective must be realistic. It must be reasonably possible to achieve the goal. Although a target such as ‘a doubling of the market share in one year’ is challenging and ambitious, it is generally not feasible. This then leads to the unnecessary situation that virtually every strategy will fail. Timebound means that an objective must be defined for a specific time period. If this does not happen, then one cannot determine the moment at which it can be verified that the goal has been achieved. If the planning horizon is longer than one year (for example, three years), it is wise to indicate a time frame so that interim evaluations are possible. For example: we want to achieve the following market share development with the new product X over the next three years: 10 % in year 1, 12% in year 2, and finally 14% in year 3. In summary, therefore, an objective is preferably expressed in numbers, contains a time indication, and is motivating and achievable.

92  Situation analysis

4.1.2  The PDCA cycle Measuring results and therefore data is only meaningful if something is done with it in a meaningful way. Verhoef et al. (2016) state that the analysis of (big) data should always lead to better ways to deliver customer value and ultimately to value for the company. Measuring outcomes is directly related to goal setting. The so-called PDCA cycle is often cited in this context: Plan, Do, Check, Act (see Figure 4.1) ‘Plan’ refers to making plans, for example, a marketing or business plan, including measurable objectives. ‘Do’ is then the actual implementation, for example, the marketing of a new printing technique, including all kinds of related communication. ‘Check’ is to see whether the objective (e.g. a desired turnover in year 1) has been achieved. And ‘Act’ refers to adjusting the execution if necessary. The results evaluation referred to in this section corresponds to the check phase. If a company wants to check whether goals have been achieved, the relevant goals must be measured. The (continuous) measurement of results is part of marketing intelligence. Marketing intelligence means that a company collects and analyzes all information necessary for marketing decisions. Part of this is measuring those variables that play a role in checking outcomes. This then concerns the choice of metrics. Metrics are the variables that a company wants to measure quantitatively. The development of metrics receives a lot of attention in marketing science. This is important for companies because metrics can be used for control, such as in the PDCA cycle. Some companies already do a lot of research and measurements themselves as manufacturers of fast-moving consumer goods (FMCGs). But also in healthcare, everything and anything is measured. Healthcare institutions are also obliged to do so by the government and health insurers. On the other hand, there are companies that measure virtually nothing, for example, many small and medium-sized enterprises that do not (or do not think they have) the time and money for it.

Plan

Act

PDCA

Check Figure 4.1  PDCA cycle

Do

Internal analysis 93

Data • Already available • From new research

Information Descriptive and explanatory

Marketing dashboard Main metrics and results Figure 4.2  Purpose of marketing intelligence

A first step in marketing intelligence is to look at what is already available, for example, the results of customer satisfaction studies, or everything that becomes available online. The second step is to see if more is needed, for example, about the competition or about your own image. The third step is to convert data into information through analysis. A distinction can be made between descriptive methods and explanatory methods. Descriptive methods summarize developments and show them in a compact way. Explanatory methods try to establish relationships between developments, for example, differences between young and older consumers or the relationship between image and loyalty. The most important results can be summarized in a ‘marketing dashboard’, which provides an overview of the most important metrics (variables) and their interpretation. Figure 4.2 summarizes this.

4.2 Step 1: application of the balanced scorecard The method of the balanced scorecard developed by Kaplan and Norton (1992, 1993) can be helpful in choosing goals. This method means that in joint consultation between lower, middle, and higher management, measurable goals are set for four fields – finance, customer satisfaction, efficiency, and innovation: 1 2

financial goals customer-oriented goals

94  Situation analysis

3 4

internal and social goals innovation goals

From around 2000, a discussion has started whether, and if so how, goals related to ‘sustainability’ should be added to these four categories (see, among others, Figge et al., 2002; Kalender & Vayvay, 2016; Hansen & Schaltegger, 2018; Jassem et al., 2022). After a systematic review of relevant literature, the latter concluded that there are two views on the role of sustainability in relation to the BSC: 1 2

In each of the four fields, separate attention is given to the effect on sustainable goals. There is a fifth pillar needed: sustainable goals.

Some authors believe that sustainability should not be included separately in the BSC. They view sustainability as part of the strategy and argue that the BSC is not a strategy framework. In fact, they say that the ‘theory’ does not need to be adjusted but that sustainability can play a role from all goals. This view ties in with our view in Chapter 1 and that of Kotler (2011) that (in our case) there is no need to change marketing theory per se but that sustainability can, and perhaps should, play a role in all planning stages. Nevertheless, in the context of making sustainability initiatives visible and stimulating, we consider it justifiable to choose the other perspective, namely to make it visible separately. So, given the enormous importance of sustainability, we add a fifth ‘pillar’ to the BSC (Figure 4.3): 5 sustainability goals.

4.2.1  Financial goals Almost every company will set financial goals for itself. These goals can be set in terms of profit, gross margin, cash flow, share price, and so on. Some financial measures can be measured in absolute terms, others in relative terms, for example, in relation to turnover (profit margin) or in relation to capital employed (return on investment; ROI). For a more extensive treatment of financial indicators, it suffices to note that the literature on this subject can be studied. Setting financial goals is obvious but at the same time one-sided. Kaplan and Norton state that it is important to also set goals with regard to the building blocks of, for example, profit. Those building blocks include costs and revenues. Revenues, in turn, are influenced by customer perceptions of the quality and degree of innovativeness of the company’s products. By also formulating goals with regard to costs, customer-oriented standards, and innovation, according to Kaplan and Norton, a more balanced interpretation of the goals is given.

4.2.2  Customer-oriented goals In addition to financial goals, goals can be set that relate to (potential) customers. Such goals are also called marketing objectives. This includes: n ‘hard’ goals such as sales, turnover, and market share n more underlying (‘softer’) goals, such as:

Internal analysis 95

Financial Customer

Sustainability

Strategy and goals Internal process

Innovation

Figure 4.3  Sustainability and the balanced scorecard † customer satisfaction † customer loyalty or brand loyalty, to be measured on the basis of interviews

and/or analysis of data on purchasing patterns

† perceived quality or other image aspects of the brand: ‘How does the buyer

view his own product and the competing products?’

† quantity and content of complaints

Customer satisfaction and customer loyalty are closely related, but they are not the same (Oliver, 1999). The pursuit of customer satisfaction and customer loyalty is currently receiving a lot of attention, which can be explained by the focus on value management. Customer loyalty has two dimensions: a behavioral dimension (measured, for example, as the share of the brand/company in the customer’s category purchases: the customer’s ‘market share’) and an emotional dimension (the customer’s attitude towards the brand, to be measured via questionnaires).

4.2.3  Internal and social goals Internal and social goals are about internal effective and efficient functioning. The goals here relate to efficiency and personnel. Measures for efficiency are, for example: n n n n n

turnover compared to investments turnover rate debtor term liquidity overhead costs

96  Situation analysis

Measures for satisfaction of staff are: n n n n n

working atmosphere and morale personal development employee turnover sick leave turnover per employee

The personnel-oriented goals have everything to do with the P of People and its ‘sustainability’: social goals, in other words. Dealing well with personnel is essential, also in order to be able to attract new personnel to the labor market (see Case 4.1). For

Case 4.1  The importance of good personnel management

The millennial It seems more and more that young people in 2023 want a different work balance than generations before them. Private life and sufficient freedom are considered essential. That, together with the emergence of major staff shortages after the coronavirus in 2022, makes the importance of being an attractive employer even more important. For all these reasons, you increasingly see employers making provisions for staff to be able to relax sufficiently in between. Ping-pong tables at work are typical facilities for millennials, it is said.

Internal analysis 97

that reason, following Kalender and Vayvay (2016), we have supplemented the designation ‘internal goals’ with ‘social’.

4.2.4  Innovation goals Innovation is the basis of success. Only companies that regularly introduce new products are relatively successful. The extent to which the company learns from past experiences also plays a role here. Measures for this are, for example, the percentage of successful product introductions, the turnover from new products, or the number of concrete new product plans in progress.

4.2.5  Sustainability goals Every organization will have to deal with the climate. We have already mentioned the good example of Unilever. As stated, we choose to make sustainability goals visible separately. Elaboration into criteria can be emissions, waste, use of materials, and so on (Figge et al., 2002). Figure 4.4 shows a elaboration of the BSC. The vision formulates long-term goals for financial growth, customer satisfaction, costs, sustainability, and innovation. If top management considers driving customer focus and brand building important and also recognizes that this entails additional investments, the financial goals can be set somewhat lower and the customer-oriented goals higher. The long-term goals are then made more concrete for the short term. For example, ‘strong improvement in customer satisfaction’ is translated into ‘improvement of brand image’, ‘increase in frequency of use’, and ‘increase in customer satisfaction’. Subsequently, each of these factors is described as how it is measured. For example, improvement of the brand image is measured by the percentage of people in the target group who associate the brand with the identity characteristic ‘cheeky’. Sustainability can be measured by CO2 emission. Finally, the numerical goals themselves are indicated. The latter takes place in consultation with top management and middle management, with the goals being assigned to specific managers. The BSC has the advantage of a comprehensive planning and control process. Formulating joint measurable goals can also strengthen team spirit, but that depends on how the goals were achieved. If this is done top-down, this is unlikely to lead to an increase in motivation and team spirit. If it can be embedded in a process that actually leaves responsibilities to lower management, it can be helpful.

4.2.6  Economy versus sustainability Especially with the addition of sustainability goals, it is clear that there is an interdependence between the five types of goals. We are referring in particular to the tension between economic and sustainability goals. The tendency of many managers is to want to grow economically. Given the sustainability challenges mentioned, the question is whether this is still wise. Case 4.2 elaborates on this further.

98  Situation analysis

Vision Long term

Short term

Criterion

Objective

Improvement brand image

Aided recall of brand association ‘cheeky’

From 63% to 73%

Increase in usage frequency

Increase in usage frequency

From 12% to 15%

Increase in customer satisfaction

Grade (1–10) customer satisfaction

From 7.3 to 7.8

Financial growth Strong improvement customer satisfaction

Internal: stable costs Sustainabiliy: lower CO2 emission

Improvement of innovation

Figure 4.4  Balanced scorecard with customer part elaboration

4.3 Step 2: evaluation of the results In the evaluation of results, we are talking about analysis of quantitative data (‘data’). The first step has been outlined for this: a review of the five main objectives. But there is a lot more data, and, as we mentioned earlier, more and more data is coming. That is why we take a closer look at measures of customer-oriented variables (Section 4.2.2). Two types of customer-oriented data can be distinguished: n own collected data from research by means of, for example, questionnaires or reg-

istration of purchases

n data on customer online behavior, such as search and information behavior, but also

purchasing behavior and after-sales behavior such as expressions of (dis)satisfaction

We now focus on the first category. Additional online analyses are discussed in the next chapter. Each organization measures its own sales and turnover. These are examples of customer-oriented variables. In many cases the analysis of this data can go deeper. The level of detail in the analysis of customer data depends on the availability of data.

Internal analysis 99

Case 4.2  To grow or not to grow: that is the question

Is Black Friday still relevant today? Black Friday: consumers can buy all kinds of things at special prices, very handy also during the holidays. A great opportunity for an entrepreneur to get some extra turnover, right? Black Friday comes from the United States and has now grown into a Black Friday week (Amazon) or in some cases two weeks. Yet some entrepreneurs do not participate. IKEA does something different: Bring Back Friday: to make it more sustainable, you can bring your second-hand furniture to IKEA and get money in return. And retailer Dille & Kamille started in 2018 together with Trees for All Green Friday and in 2022, on the same ‘Black’ November 25, 2022, they even closed completely, and staff did volunteer work! These companies realize that they can benefit from these great promotions in the longer term because their reputation, read: their brand, is strengthened, justly, because in this time of environmental degradation, it is becoming increasingly clear that things can only be saved if we no longer assume ‘growth, growth, growth’ and therefore also ‘buy, buy, buy’. For an entrepreneur, the message is clear: think about your long-term brand reputation. Fair and sustainable are the future. In this way, as entrepreneurs, we may teach our customers, read: ‘the people’, that things can be done differently.

100  Situation analysis

Most of the data is available for food markets (Nielsen, IRI, and GfK retail panels). We first discuss analyses that may be performed with this data. We then conclude with a few remarks on industries other than those of daily consumer goods (fast-moving consumers goods). For the food markets, the following sales developments may be analyzed: 1 2 3 4 5

market developments: sales developments for the total market and market segments (varieties) manufacturer’s brands: a developments per brand in total and by packaging units b regional differences in brand developments competitors: a identify biggest competitors b developments and sales of competing manufacturers position of manufacturers’ brands and competitors in the various retail organizations plus development over time (sales and distribution analyses) sales developments at retailers with and without promotions (provides indicative insight into the effects of promotions)

If the company also has data from household panels (GfK) or customer sales figures from its own databases, sales analyses can also be carried out that are broken down into target groups. Such detailed analyses are necessary because it is difficult to identify causes from aggregated figures. For example, a slight increase in sales may seem like a good result, but this may be the result of strong growth in region A and a stabilization or even a decline in region B. This then leads to the conclusion that there are problems in region B, for example, a disappointing distribution. An accurate analysis of the market share can also give indications of problems (Hulbert & Toy, 1977). Is there a decrease or an increase? Incidentally, the market definition is crucial in a market share analysis (see Section 3.3). With a smaller market, the share automatically becomes larger. An instrument that can be helpful in the market share analysis is the Parfitt & Collins analysis. The market share of a brand is split into (the product of) three components: 1 2 3

Degree of penetration. This is the percentage of households that have ever bought the product. The percentage of repeat purchases: The extent to which the same brand is bought again after purchasing a brand. The usage intensity index. This is the degree to which buyers of the brand use more or less of the relevant product group.

For example, if these three components assume the values 10% (penetration), 40% (repeat purchases), and 1.5% (consumption), the market share will be 6%. The development of these individual components provides a better insight into potential problems than does the progress of the market share as a whole.

Internal analysis 101

The Parfitt & Collins analysis is often used in combination with awareness measures. The following indicators are then relevant: 1 2 3 4

Awareness (spontaneous or assisted): percentage of people who know the brand Consideration set: percentage of people who are considering the brand Trial: percentage of trial purchases Repeat: percentage of repeat purchases

For online analysis, variants are often devised such as: ‘awareness, engagement, conversion, loyalty’. This is in fact the same. The size of the various percentages, and in particular the differences between them, are an important starting point when formulating market instrument objectives. This leads to low awareness and a (relatively) high trial, concluding that communication should be intensified. A low trial may be related to too high a price or too limited distribution. A low repeat has more to do with the performance of the product itself. Accurate analyses are also possible in other industries, although they are less detailed. The main data limitation outside FMCG markets is that data is often not collected centrally and therefore no (hard) sales data from competitors is available. But every company can register its own sales in detail and also have customer research carried out (by research agencies). It is important to ensure that the registration of results takes place over a long period of time and consistently. As long as market shares are not used, but with their own sales data or customer satisfaction measurements, many organizations can measure and analyze results in detail.

4.4 Step 3: internal analysis at company level Various models are available that are helpful in the strength-weakness analysis. Figure 4.5 contains an overview. In this section we discuss the methods at the corporate level. We will not yet discuss portfolio analysis here: it is so closely linked to corporate strategy that we will discuss it in Chapter 10. The brand level is discussed in Section 4.5. Method

Source of data

Result

Customer Values

Management

Main direction of competitive advantage

Checklist functional areas

Management

Judgment per functional area

Marketing audit

Management

Marketing orientation

Portfolio Analysis (Chapter 10)

Management

Overview and strength current activities

Customer perception research

Customers

Customizable judgments

Four or five Ps

Customers

Judge (functional) brand performance

Checklist brand values and brand personality

Management or customers

Scores brand values or brand personality traits

Company level

Brand level

Figure 4.5  Methods for the internal analysis

102  Situation analysis

Brand benefit

Current level

Desired level

Quality

6

7

Service

7

8

Price

6

6

Convenience

7

7

Sustainability

4

6

Emotion

7

8

Figure 4.6  Possible outcome of a management discussion about the current and desired brand benefits

4.4.1  Brand benefits as an analysis model In the previous chapter, we discussed customer values. Managers can give themselves marks for each of the brand benefits and then indicate the desired improvements in the strategic choices. Figure 4.6 contains an example of the outcome of a management discussion based on the Brand Benefitting Model (‘brand benefits’). This can be very helpful in discussions about the brand positioning.

4.4.2  Management’s assessment of functional areas At the company level, strengths relate especially to functional areas. The core skills of a company are often referred to as core competencies (Prahalad & Hamel, 1990). A checklist can be used to analyze strengths and weaknesses at the company level. Figure 4.7 provides a more specific checklist. This list concerns possible strengths and weaknesses of the various functional areas in a company: n innovation: technological skills, R&D expenditure, patents, and so on; also the eco-

logical footprint can be seen as part of innovation

n production: added value, capacity, and so on n financing options: short term, long term, possibility to finance from the parent

company, and so on

n management and organization: quality of (top) management, organizational struc-

ture, corporate culture, and so on

n personnel: motivation and customer focus n marketing: staff customer focus, product quality, digital maturity, online presence,

strength of advertising (agency), and so on

The strengths and weaknesses mentioned in Figure 4.7 are not independent of one another. For example, the attitude and motivation of the staff strongly depend on the

Internal analysis 103

Innovation n n n n n n n

Technical product superiority Ecological footprint New product capabilities Research & development Technologies Patents Digital maturity

Production n n n n n n

Cost structure Flexibility in production Means of production (machinery, etc.) Access to raw materials Vertical integration Production capacity

Financing options n n n n

From the operational activities From resources available in the short term Opportunities for raising equity and loan capital Willingness of the parent company to finance

Management and organization n n n n n n n n n n

Quality of top and middle management Leadership Knowledge of the market Company culture Organizational structure Strategic objectives and plans Entrepreneurial qualities Planning system Staff turnover Quality of strategic decision making

Figure 4.7  Possible strengths and weaknesses (sources of benefits) at the corporate level Source: Based on Aaker (2013)

104  Situation analysis

Staff n Staff attitude and motivation n Customer orientation

Marketing n n n n n n n n n

Product quality Width of the product line Segmentation Distribution Relationship with distributors Quality of sales promotion Digital marketing Representatives Services

Figure 4.7 (Continued)

quality of top management and the organizational structure, while the same motivation in turn influences the creativity and innovative capacity of the company. With regard to the analysis of the financial position of the product and the company, we note that the (known) financial ratios can be calculated and analyzed. These relate to: n liquidity: the extent to which a company can meet its current financial obligations,

measured, for example, by the current ratio (current assets/current liabilities)

n the financial structure (solvency): to be measured, for example, by the debt ratio

(loan capital/total invested capital)

n the activities: for example, the turnover rate of the stock (turnover/stock) and the

average credit term of creditors (average amount due/turnover × 365 days)

n profitability: to be measured, for example, by the gross or net profit margin or the

return on equity (net profit/equity)

Another model often used for firm-level strength-weakness analysis is McKinsey’s rather elaborate 7S model, which consists of: n n n n n n n

shared values strategy structure systems staff style of management key skills

Internal analysis 105

4.4.3  Marketing audit Measuring the quality of the marketing (department) is the subject of a marketing audit. A marketing audit is an independent review of all marketing activities in the company or in the SBU. This concerns: n An evaluation of the extent to which a company operates in a market-oriented

way: † Are there clearly formulated objectives and strategies? † Do the objectives and strategies explicitly take environmental factors into account? † Do the strategies actually match the environmental factors? † How do customers view the company and its products? † And so on. n The knowledge that a company has of the environment: † What is known about macro-environmental developments, industry structure factors, competitors, and customers? † And so on. n The analysis that the company has made of the environment: † Is market research being carried out? † Are predictions made? † Does a strategy evaluation take place regularly? † Is there a marketing information system? † Is big data used?

A checklist must be used to carry out a marketing audit. Figure 4.8 shows such a checklist developed by Kotler (see, for example, McDonald, 1995; Kotler & Keller, 2016). This checklist contains 15 questions with a maximum score of two points for each question.

Customer vision 1 2 3

Does management consider it important to organize the company in such a way that customer needs are properly met? Does the company develop different products and marketing plans for different segments? Does the company consider marketing important throughout the organization?

Integrated marketing organization 4 5 6

Is marketing coordinated and directed high up in the organization? Does marketing work well with research, production, purchasing, logistics and financing? How well is new product development organized?

Figure 4.8  Marketing effectiveness review instrument

106  Situation analysis

Adequate marketing information 7 8 9

When were the latest market research studies, environmental analyses, distribution analyzes and competitive analyzes carried out? How well informed is the company about the potential profitability of segments, customers, territories, products, channels and sales orders? What efforts are being made to measure and improve the cost-effectiveness of marketing?

Strategic orientation 10 To what extent is formal marketing planning done? 11 How clear and innovative is the current marketing strategy? 12 To what extent are setbacks and scenarios taken into account in the planning?

Operational efficiency 13 How well is the marketing strategy communicated and executed? 14 Does management effectively use the marketing tools? 15 Does management show that it responds quickly and decisively to new developments? Figure 4.8 (Continued)

The total number of points is a measure of the effectiveness of marketing in the company. It is also assumed that each item has the same weight. Digital aspects could be added for various aspects to the somewhat outdated instrument in Figure 4.8. For example, with marketing information: ‘To what extent does the company use digital analyses/big data?’ And with strategic orientation: ‘How digital is the marketing strategy developed?’

4.5 Step 4: internal analysis at brand level The methods described previously provide insights at the company level. It is also essential to assess the strengths and weaknesses at brand level. Insight into strengths and weaknesses at the brand level is largely obtained by a manager from the customer analysis. It is about knowing how the customer views the brand (attitudes). In the context of value thinking, it is relevant to use a customer perspective in the strengths-weaknesses analysis. What the customer thinks is the truth the manager is dealing with. The performance of customer analyses is discussed in Chapter 5. Various methods are provided there that are helpful, in particular for measurements of perceptions. Perceptions or associations determine the brand image, and brand associations should be strong, unique and relevant. Checklists can be used when measuring customer perceptions, for example, the Brand Benefitting Model. Another simple model that can be used is one that measures performance around the marketing instruments. It is then advisable to add the P for personnel as the fifth. The market instruments in themselves say little about how

Internal analysis 107

Marketing instrument

Benchmark

Product

Quality

Price

Price perception, 'value'

Place (channels, locations)

Availability, findability

Communication

Communication style, clarity, attitude towards ads

Staff

Expertise, customer focus, service

Figure 4.9  Measuring the functional brand strengths

customers perceive them. That is why we translate them into customer-oriented measures (Figure 4.9). The 5P model emphasizes the functional properties of a brand. But brands also have emotional properties. A distinction can be made between personality characteristics (such as a masculine brand) and end values (such as freedom). In this book we discuss various models that can be used for this, such as: n the means-end chain of meanings (Chapter 5) n Jennifer Aaker’s Brand Personality Scale (Chapter 11) n the Value Compass (Chapter 11)

It is therefore important for a manager who performs an internal analysis not only to determine what the functional core competencies are but also to determine the emotional characteristics. As a result of the internal analysis, it must be clear, among other things, what the DNA of the company or brand is.

Summary An internal analysis aims to evaluate the results and to make a strength-weakness analysis. There are four steps: 1

2 3

4

During the evaluation, an inventory is made of which objectives are available at the various levels and whether the objectives set have been achieved. The principle of the balanced scorecard says that in addition to financial goals, other – underlying – goals should also be measured and reassessed: measures of innovation, customer satisfaction, and social and societal goals. Subsequently, the customer-oriented standards in particular are subjected to a detailed analysis in order to gain insight into any problem areas. Strengths and weaknesses are examined at organizational and brand level. At the organizational level, strengths or weaknesses can be identified through self-assessment of strengths and weaknesses in the different functional areas and by conducting a marketing audit that also considers digital skills. At the brand level, both functional and emotional strengths should be considered, examining the entire palette of brand attributes. In practice, knowledge of customer perceptions will also form the basis of an internal analysis.

108  Situation analysis

How Wal-Mart found its footing in the Amazon era

This is not a story about rebranding. Although the US’s largest retailer has evolved its marketing, product mix, private-label offerings, agency and vendor relationships, strategy, and more, Wal-Mart insists that there’s no fundamental change in how the company operates. ‘As business and technology advance and customer habits continue to change, it requires any brand to pause and refresh or redefine as necessary’, according to Wal-Mart’s management. That adaptability has helped Wal-Mart reverse the streak of sales declines that marked 2013 and 2014. Today, despite hiccups during the COVID-19 period, the company boasts continuous sales growth. To survive the retail carnage that pushed Sears and Kmart toward irrelevance and dragged down success stories like Target and Kroger, the $485-billion giant remade itself as a unified online-offline proposition. It has rolled out drive-thru pickup of grocery orders and has installed automated kiosks where people can collect orders inside. It’s using technology more smartly to maximize checkout orders at walmart.com. For customers who shop in person, the chain has improved its quality with revamped produce sections and higher-end exclusive or private-label apparel, food, and nonfood items. But through all of this, Wal-Mart hasn’t lost sight of its signature low-price proposition. Although the old slogan ‘everyday low prices’ has been transformed into ‘We don’t just save you money, we allow you to live better’, the slogan is the fundamental tenet of a cult masquerading as a company. Over the years, Wal-Mart has relentlessly wrung tens of billions of dollars in cost efficiencies out of the retail supply chain, passing the larger part of the savings along to shoppers as bargain prices. In the United States, wherever Wal-Mart competes, average grocery prices are 14% lower than elsewhere.

Internal analysis 109

Needless to say that part of these savings have also been realized by continuous pressure on the already low wages for Wal-Mart sales clerks. Wal-Mart’s huge advantages in buying power and efficiency force many rivals to close. For every Wal-Mart supercenter that opens, two other supermarkets will close. As the number of supermarkets shrinks, more shoppers will have to travel farther from home. Meanwhile, the failure of hundreds of stores will cost their owners dearly and put thousands out of work, only some of whom will find jobs at Wal-Mart. Most likely at lower pay: Wal-Mart is blamed sometimes for the sorry state of retail wages in America. On average, Wal-Mart sales clerks – ‘associates’ in Wal-Mart terminology – earn an average of around $13.90 an hour, or around $28,000 a year. As a comparison, the federal poverty line for a family of four in 2022 was $27,750. The low-cost strategy is obvious, but what might most separate it from its competitors is that Wal-Mart knows change is expensive, and sometimes you have to lose money to make it. Wal-Mart management recognizes that the big retailers of the past made decisions to preserve the models they created. Wal-Mart has decided it wants to be a retailer for the long haul, even if that means being a little suboptimal in its returns. Wal-Mart is [also] willing to invest in a new business model, even one that it’s kind of bad at and will take them ‘a while to get good at’.

Save money. Live better Wal-Mart’s vaunted lower prices have made life harder for such rivals as Target, Kroger and Dollar General, even if the primary intended targets were Amazon and hard discounters like Aldi and Lidl. A Wal-Mart marketing manager once emphasized this point as: ‘None of our marketing efforts matter unless we have price leadership. We’re always maniacal about not letting people get distracted from price’. But price is a game no retailer wins all the time. Avoiding the fate of failed retailers rests at least as heavily on delivering the second half of Wal-Mart’s slogan, ‘Save Money. Live Better’, with a bigger focus on convenience and quality. Nowadays, it’s not only price. Over the past years, convenience is increasingly becoming a driver for consumer behavior. That’s partially based on expectations raised by online shopping and other digital services. But the demand for more shopping convenience also stems from sobering factors specific to the United States: both parents working in 60% of two-parent households, people working an average of five hours longer a month than a few years ago, and people tethered to work via smartphones, which put them in contact with their jobs on average 13.5 hours a day, or, as the marketing manager puts it, ‘nearly all their waking hours’. Wal-Mart reaches every demographic in the United States, but to win on convenience, the retailer is focusing more on a segment it calls ‘busy families’. They’re the most intense combination of being busy and money challenged. Busy families have the highest bar in terms of delivering on price, quality, and convenience.

110  Situation analysis

Wal-Mart believes that if they can deliver on this segment, they can probably deliver on everybody. This group is a little higher income than Wal-Mart defined their customers in the past. But that doesn’t mean Wal-Mart is going upscale as much as it’s targeting a segment that’s more suburban and multicultural than its prior core. ‘They’ve found the right balance between promotion and everyday low price’, according to a consultant. The company has removed some of the clutter of bargain-bin store-floor displays, for example, but hasn’t done away with them entirely. Most shoppers give Wal-Mart credit for having the lowest prices most of the time, the consultant says – or at least being close enough that it’s not worth the effort to shop around. In combination with the emphasis on convenience, the company also gives more significance to the store experience. So there is a focus on making sure checkout lines aren’t longer than three deep and generally keeping the store experience ‘clean, fast and friendly’. Wal-Mart has improved customer satisfaction as a result, according to its own measures and external sources such as the American Customer Satisfaction Index, which tracked a major lift this year. Add to clean-fast-friendly the three-legged stool of price-convenience-quality. Winning on those last three is key for Wal-Mart to succeed across the biggest customer base in America. Just based on trading area, Wal-Mart skews a lot more Middle American or red state than its more coastal, blue-state competitors Amazon and Costco. But Wal-Mart’s demographics look pretty much the same as America’s. According to Wal-Mart, there are three very different groups of shoppers who are particularly interested in Wal-Mart’s defining proposition of saving money: n people living paycheck to paycheck n people scrimping on basics to pay for high-end purchases such as iPhones n well-off consumers who got that way in part by frugality

Linking online and offline Amazon is on track to pass Wal-Mart as the biggest US retailer: between 2021 and 2026, Amazon stands to grow its US retail market share from 10.8% to 14.9%, whereas Wal-Mart’s share will shrink from 13.2% to 12.7%. But Wal-Mart’s e-commerce is growing as well. Winning in e-commerce is crucial for all segments of shoppers, who all want convenience. To try to buttress an online presence still dwarfed by Amazon, WalMart has enlisted its huge portfolio of stores. Wal-Mart finally appears to be breaking through in making ‘bricks and clicks’ work together in a way that meaningfully affects online sales growth. Free two-day delivery on millions of items without an Amazon Prime-like annual fee was one key to sparking a surge in e-commerce sales. Discounts for store delivery on nearly a million items are also helping. And the chain put advertising weight usually reserved for the brick-and-mortar stores behind the online sales efforts.

Internal analysis 111

Wal-Mart is also using tech to tweak its pricing strategy. Under Wal-Mart former e-commerce chief Marc Lore, who was CEO of online retailer Jet.com before Wal-Mart acquired it in September 2016, the retailer started experimenting with bringing Jet’s more complex pricing model, which bestows steeper discounts on larger orders. Shoppers might get a lower price on Wal-Mart.com, for example, by adding baby wipes to a basket that includes diapers. The whole variety of inducements looks to be working, with a stimulating effect on Wal-Mart’s online presence.

Mixing up the product mix With rivals like Aldi, Lidl, and Costco competing largely based on their privatelabel programs, Wal-Mart is putting more resources into its own brands, too, and not just the lowest-cost tiers but also higher-end products. Consequently, Wal-Mart sells private-label products aimed not just at the biggest mass brands but also emerging players such as L’Oréal USA’s Matrix salon brand. ‘Aspirational products at disruptive prices’ was how Wal-Mart described its product development effort. This includes some Wal-Mart ‘exclusives’, such as a Keurig K-Cup coffee maker hitting stores now priced at $59 – $30 or more below prices elsewhere – and Yankee Candles priced around $10 less than they sell for elsewhere. As an example, Wal-Mart has significantly staffed up development for its own baby-care brands, focusing on everything from pouch meals to baby wipes and strollers, with products priced 25% to 50% below branded rivals. Winning in packaged goods is key to winning online and offline with those ‘busy families’. And families with newborns are among the busiest. They eat at home more and buy more of just about everything as they establish households. ‘Wal-Mart.com was built on big-ticket purchases like TVs’, according to a Wal-Mart official ‘What’s happening now is a much more balanced approach where consumables play a much bigger role in customer acquisition’.

Everyday low supplier pricing? While Wal-Mart has seldom hesitated to throw its weight around to get better prices, it’s starting to use its power in new ways. One example was in what appears to be a first for the retail industry: Wal-Mart recently conducted a review to streamline the army of third-party field merchandisers that help place displays and products in its stores, culling the firms involved to 5 from more than 30. It was an audacious move because outside marketers, such as P&G and Unilever, pay the firms for their efforts, not Wal-Mart. But Wal-Mart was able to engineer a roster that made the process more efficient in its stores, a spokesman says. It also ensured that each supplier had an in-store marketing force dedicated specifically to the chain. The expectation is that the resulting supply-chain savings get passed back to Wal-Mart.

112  Situation analysis

But it also meant forcing big suppliers like Unilever to switch vendors. ‘Right now they’re in a fairly enviable position in that they’re indispensable for shoppers and suppliers’, according to Wal-Mart. ‘Suppliers may not be happy with how they do business in every case, but they can’t walk away. ‘ Wal-Mart acknowledges that the efforts to get more efficient may mean some added tension with suppliers. Then again, suppliers have plenty of grumbles about other retailers.

Wal-Mart as startup Even as Wal-Mart wields its bigness in new ways, it’s playing with small flanker brands in e-commerce. Counting Jet.com, it has acquired a number of small e-commerce players whose customers often weren’t big on Wal-Mart, including Hayneedle, Shoebuy, ModCloth, Moosejaw, and Bonobos. Perhaps one true sign of a shift is that Wal-Mart says it’s not imposing itself on these brands. Wal-Mart describes this approach to the newly acquired online retailers this way: ‘Imagine if you get purchased by the world’s largest company and you have access to those resources, and yet they aren’t really going to change you. All they want is for you to be better versions of yourselves’.’ Whatever you call it – reinvention or something else – Wal-Mart is ‘not going down the path of generational decline like Sears and Kmart’, as the marketing manager of Wal-Mart puts it. But that doesn’t mean that the work is done.

Questions 1 2 3

4 5 6 7 8

Which brand promise (Brand Benefitting Model) has been chosen by Wal-Mart? ‘The second-worst thing a manufacturer can do is sign a contract with Wal-Mart. The worst? Not sign one’. Explain this expression. a  Use the information in the case to identify strengths and weaknesses for Wal-Mart. b Use your analysis of strengths and weaknesses to determine the DNA of Wal-Mart. Illustrate with an example how Wal-Mart could use big data to finetune its operations. Create a means-end chain for Wal-Mart by using the information in the case. What is the relation between key success factors and the competitive advantage of an organization? Illustrate this relation for Wal-Mart. Define objectives for Wal-Mart. Use the balanced scorecard. Use the information from the case, but make your own assumptions wherever necessary. According to marketing theory, a strategy can only be developed after an extensive situation analysis. But some organizations seem to focus initially on their own core competencies, without adapting the strategy to the (external) environment. Which choice did Wal-Mart make here? Explain briefly.

Chapter 5

Customer analysis

Phase 1 Analysis Mission, customer value and market definition (3)

External analysis

Internal analysis

Customer analysis (5) Industry analysis (6) Internal analysis (4)

Competitor analysis (7) Analysis of distribution and suppliers (8)

SWOT (9)

Phase 2 Strategy Corporate objectives and strategy (10)

Marketing objectives and strategy (11)

Phase 3 Tactics Product, Price, Place (12); Promotion (13)

Organization of marketing and Personnel (14)

DOI: 10.4324/9781003381488-7

114  Situation analysis

Key points in this chapter n n n n n

Be able to apply segmentation based on data Know the most important consumer behavior models Know how to measure needs and perceptions of customers Know how to measure brand image Be able to deal with primary and secondary sources of customer data

Introduction Marketing is about customers and brands. That is why we start the external analysis with an analysis of the (potential) customers and the brand image. In this chapter we refer to customer analysis as an indication for any form of research in which information is collected from (potential) customers. This is also referred to as market research, which is not only quantitative (often questionnaires) but can also be qualitative. Section 5.1 outlines the goals of a customer analysis. Section 5.2 then discusses segmentation. In Section 5.3, we discuss some (simple) models of customer values. Sections 5.4 and 5.5 are devoted to research into customer wishes and perceptions, respectively. Section 5.6 specifically discusses measuring brand strength. In Section 5.7, we discuss individual customer data that has become increasingly available as a result of digital developments. Section 5.8 provides some basic guidelines for primary research, broken down into qualitative and quantitative research.

5.1 Goals of the customer analysis An important common thread in this book is the starting point that in practice a company must strive for customer satisfaction and for the alignment of the brand identity and brand image. The question, then, is how a brand can achieve this. To find out, it is essential to ‘talk’ to those customers. What do they want (wants) and what do they think of you (perceptions)? This chapter provides a further structure for a so-called customer analysis. We already note that a customer analysis is not the only source for insight into customer wishes. The biggest problem with market research is that it is difficult for people to indicate what they would like (in the future). Future needs are usually underestimated by people. Therefore, data from a buyer analysis cannot always be used as direct or sole guidance for trading but must be interpreted and then combined with other sources. With this caveat in mind, we now move on to what can be called the most important phase in the situation analysis. Customer research can be used for various purposes. Malhotra et al. (2017) distinguish between three methods of research: n explorative: qualitative research n descriptive: quantitative research (survey and observation) n causal/explanatory: quantitative research supplemented with † experiments and/or † statistical correlation study

Customer analysis 115

This classification is clear but does not yet establish a relationship with the required data. Ferrell and Hartline (2010) classify the customer analysis according to the six Ws: 1 2 3 4 5 6

Who are our current and potential customers? What do our customers do with our products (including use situations)? Where do our customers purchase our products? When do our customers purchase our products? Why (and how) do our customers choose our products (including perceptions of brands/products and needs)? Why do potential customers not purchase our products?

Although Ferell and Hartline’s classification can be used very well, it has the limitation that no distinction is made between the different (strategic) goals of the customer analysis. A customer analysis itself actually has different use situations, where different information has to be collected in one situation than in another. In our view, there are four use cases or goals of the buyer analysis: 1 2 3 4

use for segmentation and target group selection (Chapter 11) use as a basis for strengths-weaknesses research (Chapter 4) and brand positioning decisions (Chapter 11) use for checking results achieved (Chapter 4) and measuring the effect of market instruments (Chapter 13) use in competitor identification (Chapter 7)

Goal of customer analysis:

Required data from

information for the benefit

primary research

Type of research

Research discussed in

of 1 Segmentation and target group selection 2 Positioning and strengths and weaknesses

Who, what, where,

Quantitative

Section 5.2

Value hierarchy and

Qualitative and

Section 5.3

customer

quantitative

when, why?

satisfaction: why, why not? 3 Results analysis (control) and effect study

Why, why not: brand

Quantitative

Section 5.3 and 13.10

awareness, brand associations, customer satisfaction , among others

4 Competitive analysis

Who, what, why, why not: chosen brand and competitors

Figure 5.1  Goals of the customer analysis

Quantitative

Section 7.2

116  Situation analysis

Each of these goals requires specific information (division by questions) and a specific research approach (division by research method). Figure 5.1 summarizes this. The first three of these goals are discussed in detail in this chapter.

5.2 Segmentation research 5.2.1  Requirements for segments A segment means: a group of (potential) customers. Segmentation research ties into the first dimension of marketing strategy: the choice of target audience (targeting). In this context, the STP trilogy is often referred to: segmenting, targeting, positioning. Segmentation is research. Targeting (and positioning) is strategy and therefore making choices (see Chapter 11). The core idea of segmentation is that people often have different needs and that it is more profitable to approach people differently with your marketing (for example, with different products) instead of everyone in the same way. A group of customers can be considered a segment if the following segmentation requirements are met: 1 2 3 4

Homogeneity/heterogeneity. Within a segment, the response to a marketing activity should be as homogeneous as possible and between segments as heterogeneous as possible. Sufficient size. Segments that are so small that profitable operation is impossible do not make sense. Measurable/identifiable. It must be possible to identify the customers in segments in some way so that results and strategies can be linked to concretely described segments. Moreover, without identification, it is difficult to estimate the size of the segment. Accessible. To use market instruments, in particular distribution and communication instruments, it is necessary to be able to reach the segment.

Only quantitative research can provide insight into these conditions. This type of research entails collecting a large amount of data from a large number of people and then attempting to identify groups of consumers that meet these requirements (segments).

5.2.2  Steps and methods A segmentation analysis is divided into three phases: 1 2 3

Collecting of the data Analysis of the data Description of the segments (personas)

1  Collecting the data First, by means of, for example, in-depth interviews and group discussions with customers, attempts are made to gain as much insight as possible into the motivations, attitudes, and behavior of the customers. This knowledge is used to draw up a questionnaire that

Customer analysis 117

is administered to a large group of customers. For consumer markets, data must be collected on three categories of segmentation variables: personal variables, category-specific variables, and brand-related variables (see Figure 5.2). The last two collectively become behavioral variables because these variables relate to consumer behavior. Part of the category-related variables is the customer journey, both offline and online. Figure 5.3 contains an overview of segmentation variables for business markets (industrial markets). The data mentioned in Figures 5.2 and 5.3 can be considered the minimum background data collected from target groups.

2  Analysis of the data Segments must be distilled from the collected data. In principle, the following paths can be followed (see Figure 5.4): n Forward segmentation, also known as a priori segmentation. The buyers are

classified on the basis of general characteristics (for consumer markets, the

Category

Subcategory

Variables

A Personal (customer characteristics)

1

Geographically

2

Demographic and socio-economic

• • • • • • • • • •

Region/province/zip code area Urbanization degree Age Gender Family phase Family size Income Occupation Education Welfare class

3

Psychographic

• • •

Lifestyle (Final) values Personality

1

Benefits



Importance of product properties (relevance associations)

2

Buying behavior



Role in decision process (Initiator, Influencer, Decision maker) Search behavior (offline and online) Buying/shoppingbehavior (offline and online)

B Product (category)

(customer journey)

3

Usage Behavior

• • • • •

C Brand

1

Brand awareness

• •

2

Brand associations

3

Brand loyalty

• • • •

(Product) involvement and usage amount (light, moderate, heavy user) Use situations Usage status Compared to ‘own’ brand/phase in the buying process (degree of awareness, whether or not a buyer) Compared to competing brands: consideration set ‘Own’ brand (strength, relevance, uniqueness) Competing brands Behavioral loyalty (share of wallet, switching behaviour) Emotional (recommended, brand ambassador)

Figure 5.2  Most important segmentation variables for consumer markets

118  Situation analysis

Demographic

Usage variables

Purchasing approach

Situational factors



Industry



Business size



Location



Technology (required technology at customer)



Usage status (heavy user, light user, no user)



Customer capabilities (need for service)



Purchasing organization (central, decentralized)



Power structure (technical, financial, etc. )



Type of relationships (strong, weak)



Purchasing policy (leasing, service, systems, etc. )



Purchasing criteria (quality, service, price, etc. )



Purchasing process (customer journey, offline, online)



Urgency of delivery



Applications of delivered product



Order size

Personal



Degree of similarity with supplying company

characteristics



Risk attitude



Supplier loyalty

Figure 5.3 Segmentation variables for business markets Source: Adaptation of Bonoma and Shapiro (1983)

n

category A variables in Figure 5.2), and then whether there are differences in behavioral characteristics (product and brand-related variables) between the groups is examined. Backward segmentation, or segmentation based on behavioral differences (product category or brand variables). It starts from groups of buyers that show different behavior towards the product and then looks for general characteristics on the basis of which the groups can be described. The behavioral analysis is often based on differences in the importance that customers attach to certain product attributes (benefits: specific product-related variables). This form of segmentation is therefore called benefit segmentation. The major advantage of benefit segmentation is that – if segments are found – the requirement of homogeneity/heterogeneity is always met: there is a direct relationship with purchasing behavior. This means that different products/varieties can be developed for the different benefit segments. For this reason, researchers are increasingly using benefit segmentation in practice. Benefit segmentation usually uses two statistical analysis techniques: factor analysis to reduce the data set to fewer factors if necessary and then cluster analysis to create segments that differ as much as possible. The researcher must indicate which behavioral variables should be used to search for clusters.

Customer analysis 119

Case 5.1 Research into buying behavior

Women play major role in partner’s clothing choice Only a third of Dutch men between the ages of 25 and 65 enjoy buying clothes, and new clothes are mainly bought out of necessity. The role of female partners in the purchasing process should not be underestimated. For example, four out of five Dutch women indicate that they play a role in their husband’s or boyfriend’s clothing purchases. This is the conclusion of research carried out by menswear store Jac Hensen and market research bureau Markteffect among more than 2,000 respondents. Source: Adformatie, October 18, 2022

Personal characteristics of consumers

Forward segmentation

Product-related variables • Benefits, purchasing and usage behaviour

• Geographic, demographic/socioeconomic, psychographic

Brand-related variables Backward segmentation

Figure 5.4 Approaches to segmentation

• Brand awareness, associations, loyalty

120  Situation analysis

3 Describing the segments A profile is then drawn up for each segment found on the basis of the scores on the variables studied. We look for the most characteristic properties of the segments. The segments are named for identification. This then leads to a persona (Figure 5.5). This is often a rather subjective matter. Some market research agencies have developed their own general segmentation separate from products. A frequently used example is that of Motivaction (Case 5.2).

Case 5.2 Segmenting consumers

Motivaction segmentation and personas Based on a large study of various background characteristics and lifestyle variables, Motivaction has divided Dutch people into mentality segments or ‘personas’ (referred to as ‘environments’ by the bureau): 1 2

Traditional bourgeoisie: lower to middle class, strongly conservative, family is central, woman does the housework. Modern bourgeoisie: somewhat more modern than the traditional bourgeoisie, more focused on owning and pampering, family is important but also status, low education, all income classes.

Customer analysis 121

3 4 5 6 7 8

Post-materialists: middle to upper class, post-modern, non-materialistic, need for reflection and culture, idealism, more women than men. Convenience oriented: lower class, modern, very fond of convenience and entertainment, more women, less elderly. Cosmopolitans: critical world citizens, highest social class, modern to postmodern, pampering, impulsive. Postmodern hedonists: pioneers of the experience culture, more young and highly educated, independent. New conservatives: liberal-conservative, politically interested, especially higher educated, older men. Upwardly mobile: career-oriented individualists, international orientation, traditional, many young people, especially men.

An assumption in general segmentation methods is that segments have different needs for all products and services. That is of course not the case. For example, age can play a role in beer preferences, but not in cars. Another disadvantage of ready-made, ‘own’ methods of agencies is that the data and methodology are not disclosed. The realization is therefore a black box. It is therefore recommended to apply your own segmentation for your own specific category.

5.2.3  Guidelines for segmentation Segmentation is an important topic in marketing literature, primarily because of its strategic importance but also because it is a quantitative topic that can therefore be subject to a great deal of empirical methodical research. It would go too far to go further into (statistical) methods for segmentation here, but we can indicate that the methods used are becoming increasingly flexible. For example, it can be taken into account that a person ends up in not one but two segments. This is in line with the fact that people can have different preferences at different times. There are also more and more methods that make it possible to segment despite missing data, for example, if people have not completed a questionnaire completely (for an application in a political context, see Paap et al., 2005). A general finding seems to be that segmenting based on product-related variables gives better results than based on people’s background characteristics, such as age. Reasons for this can be: n People show less and less predictable behavior. n People’s preferences can differ greatly per usage situation. n Within households, individual members can have very different preferences.

Overall, the backward segmentation method is preferable. In all cases it is necessary to collect data on behavioral and background characteristics from a large number of (potential) customers. With the growth of digital consumer behavior, this has only become easier.

122  Situation analysis

Appropriate photo

Personal characteristics:

Family situation: Living situation: Course: Profession:

Name: Age: M/F/other:

Lifestyle: Personality:

Needs and usage behavior Needs:

Search and buying behaviour:

Involvement:

Brand behavior Brand awareness: Associations: Loyalty Fidelity:

Figure 5.5 Way to describe a persona

Segmentation therefore ‘ends’ with a representation of the different groups of customers: n n n n

their properties (personal variables) their needs (category variables) their perceptions (brand specific variables) preferably a summary name per segment: persona (see Figure 5.5) This forms the input for the target group choice, as discussed in Section 11.2.

5.3 Models of consumer behavior This book does not contain a chapter on consumer behavior. For detailed information on this, we refer in general to the literature. However, this chapter is about how you can investigate that behavior. Some well-known models from the literature can be used for this. That is why we cover some of them here. We start with a/the basic model of consumer behavior (Section 5.3.1). Then we go into: n n n

the multi attribute attitude model (Section 5.3.2) the means-end chain of meanings (Section 5.3.3) for service markets the SERVQUAL model (Section 5.3.4)

5.3.1 The standard consumer behavior model Figure 5.6 shows a basic model of consumer behavior described in many books (a.o. Kotler & Armstrong, 2021). At the bottom is the consumer’s purchasing decision process, already referred to in Chapter 1. He/she encounters a ‘problem’ (‘need’), collects information (googling, for example), evaluates various options, makes a decision, uses the product or service, evaluates the experience, and may relinquish it (waste).

Customer analysis 123

Possible influences on decision-making Cultural and social factors • Culture • Social class • Reference groups • Family

Psychological factors • Needs and motives • perceptions • Learning processes • Attitudes

Personal factors • Age and life cycle • Profession • Economic situation • Lifestyle • Personality

Consumer buying decision process Problem recognition

Looking for information

Evaluate alternatives

Purchase decision

Behavior after purchase

Figure 5.6 Basic consumer behavior model Source: Based on Kotler and Armstrong (2021)

Three kinds of factors influence this process. Cultural and social influences, such as family and friends; personal factors such as age, income, lifestyle, and personality (risk aversion, for example); and psychological factors such as motives, perceptions (how he/ she views products), learning, and attitudes. This model is not directly a model that can be easily translated into market research. It mainly serves as a general model to understand how consumer decisions can be made and what influences them. The models we discuss in the following deal with partial aspects of consumer behavior and form easier starting points for market research methods.

5.3.2 The multi-attribute attitude model The name of the multi-attribute attitude model seems more complex than the model itself (see Figure 5.7). The model simply shows that the customer value (utility) that a customer derives from a product is determined, on the one hand, by the importance that the customer attaches to certain product characteristics (for example, he attaches great importance to the price). The interest can then be interpreted as the customer’s need: for example, he wants a low price because he considers it important. On the other hand, the customer value of a product is determined by a brand’s score on those product characteristics (a high price therefore leads to little realized value). The name also simply means a combination of many characteristics that lead to a total judgment (attitude). From a ‘mathematical’ point of view, we could say that if the importance of all properties is combined (multiplied) by the scores on all those properties, a kind of total value of the product is obtained. The calculation example in Figure 5.8 shows this: the total score (‘usefulness’) that the shop in question earns from the consumer in question is 6.7. An important insight provided by the multi-attribute attitude model is that the question ‘Why does a customer buy my product?’ involves a combination of two completely different variables: category needs and brand perceptions.

124  Situation analysis

Relevance of product attributes (needs)

Scores of brands on product attributes (perceptions, image)

Value of a brand for a customer

Figure 5.7 Multi-attribute attitude model

Characteristic

Importance

Score shop A

Importance × score

(in %) Price level

40%

7

2.8

Broadness range

20%

8

1.6

Friendliness of staff

20%

5

1.0

Freshness products

10%

6

0.6

Store cleanliness

10%

7

0.7

Total

100%

6.7

Figure 5.8 Calculation example with the multi-attribute attitude model

The multi-attribute attitude model does assume that a product can be divided into separate properties and that these properties can also be properly named. In practice, this is not always easy: n n

Emotional (brand) characteristics in particular are difficult to include in the model. The importance that people attach to characteristics strongly depends on their underlying motives and the situation of use, as Woodruff (1997) also argues. For example, a consumer may find the price more important for daily shopping than for Christmas shopping.

The model in the next subsection meets this need.

5.3.3 Means-end chain The essence of the means-end chain is that people’s motivation to buy products often lies deeper than just the direct benefit. For example, a customer can buy a yoghurt dessert because it contains less fat (characteristic). The customer finds this important because eating less fat makes him look good (consequence), which in turn is important because it fits better with his personality (‘looks good’) whereby he feels valued in his environment

Customer analysis 125

(final value). Properties of products therefore lead to consequences that match someone’s personality and final values (see Figure 5.9 and Case 5.3). The name of the model comes from the idea that the physical properties of a product are a ‘means’ to achieve higher ‘goals’ (values). The higher motivations to buy a product (i.e. the means-end chain) can differ for a consumer depending on the situation in which the product or service is used. The aforementioned yoghurt dessert can be bought in the summer because of its fresh taste. Then there is a difference in motive, depending on the season. The higher values are often the basis for adding emotional attributes to brands through communication. The means-goal chain is hierarchical: ‘lower’ benefits serve to satisfy ‘higher’ goals. Woodruff (1997) also argues that consumers can receive customer value at three levels: at the level of product features, consequences, and goals. We divide the ‘goals’ into two levels: personality and final values. To find out the deeper values of consumers, the laddering technique can be used. Consumers are then continuously asked why they bought a product and why it is important (‘And why do you think eating less fat is important?’).

5.3.4  The SERVQUAL model The essence of a service is that it is intangible and transitory. But, just like with products, it is simply about delivering added value for the customer. In the case of services, the staff is very important, because they have contact with the customer. The service is delivered in interaction with the customer. Measured in terms of production value, services form a larger category in the Netherlands than (physical) products. The models from Sections 5.3.1 and 4.5.2 are in themselves suitable for use in service contexts. But a well-

Usage situations

Values and motives ‘Emotional’ values and motivation

Consequences Benefits of product use

Product characteristics (attributes) Product, price, place, communication

Figure 5.9  Means-end chain

126  Situation analysis

Case 5.3  Emotional motives

VanMoofs immensely popular, especially in Amsterdam Since 2019, the e-bike has been the most sold new bicycle. Meanwhile, more and more people seem to hate e-bikes, as with many products that become popular in a short time. Anti-social, lazy, energy hungry; if you have one maybe you shouldn’t put it in front of the door. A brand that is doing very well is VanMoof. Since 2017, the turnover of this Dutch brand has increased tenfold. Despite bad reviews, everyone, especially in Amsterdam, wants such a thing. Design, being seen with it, ‘being the boss on the road’: that’s what you want. A textbook example of emotional positioning, where down-to-earth competitors Batavus and Gazelle are bought by people who just want a good sturdy e-bike instead of one of those trendy VanMoofs. Despite this success the brand went bankrupt in 2023, due to their system of repair which could only be done by VanMoof themselves, leading to a endless queue of waiting and unsatisfied customers. Source: NRC, 6 June 2022 and 28 July 2023

known model of service quality has also been developed specifically intended for service situations (Parasuraman et al., 1985). This SERVQUAL model (short for SERVice + QUALity) is shown in Figure 5.10. Central to this model is that the quality of service is defined as the difference between the expected and the actual (perceived) service. If there is a gap between the two, there is no optimum quality. So giving the customer what he wants is the idea of the model. If there is a gap, it can have various causes. The model explores this by showing a number

Customer analysis 127

Expected service level Ideally needed level within the category ‘Gap’

Quality of service

Perceived service level Dimensions: 1. Reliability 2. Assurance 3. Tangibles 4. Empathy 5. Responsiveness

Performance of provider

Figure 5.10 The SERVQUAL model of quality of service

of other gaps (not shown in Figure 5.10), such as a difference between what management thinks the customer wants and what the customer really wants. Empirical research using the SERVQUAL model has revealed a number of dimensions of service quality: 1 2 3 4 5

Reliability: the extent to which the provider keeps its promises. Certainty: how certain is a customer about whether her expectations will come true (confidence in the provider). Tangibles: all tangibles of the service, such as folders and atmosphere in a bank. Empathy: the extent to which the provider puts himself in the position of the customer. Responsiveness: the willingness of the provider to listen to the customer and do what she wants.

Measuring service quality can be done by measuring both customer expectation and realization. This is done per dimension. Per dimension, different sub-aspects can be questioned. Expectation is measured as what a customer ideally wants, independent of the specific provider. Example: a customer attaches great importance to a provider of financial services showing that they know the customer (aspect of empathy). The two components expectation and performance show that the basis of the model stems from the multi-attribute attitude model. There, too, there is a requirement (general interest in the category) and a score (of the specific brand). Finally, we note that the demands people place on brands and the performance of those brands are not separate from each other. As customers have more and longer good experiences, the requirements increase. This is a tricky point, because it means that customers’ wishes are never stable and that they have to be ‘taught’ all the time what they can and cannot expect. This also emphasizes the importance of innovation. People are used to something new at a certain point, and then something new has to come.

128  Situation analysis

5.4 Measuring the importance of product properties The multi-attribute attitude model thus says that the ‘usefulness’ of a product for a consumer consists of a combination of: n The importance of product properties n The ‘score’ of the product on those properties

And all this in the eyes of the consumer. In this section we examine the ‘importance’ or ‘relevance’ of a product characteristic for a consumer.

5.4.1  Direct method: Likert scale One way to investigate the importance of dimensions is to ask directly about the importance, with or without a scaling technique, for example, a 5-point scale (Likert scale) from ‘very important’ to ‘unimportant’. For instance: Rate the importance of the following smartphone features to you:  

Not important at all

Fairly unimportant

More or less important

Important

Very important

Price Brand Camera function . . . A direct way of asking about importance has two disadvantages: n Customers often indicate that they find everything important. With a direct method,

they are not forced to take into account the interaction between product properties (e.g. quality and price). n Customers tend to think instrumentally: concrete product features are often referred to as important, while abstract image aspects are often decisive in reality. For these reasons, indirect methods such as conjoint analysis can also be used.

5.4.2  Conjoint analysis Conjoint analysis is a method to determine the importance of product properties. This is not done by asking but by deducing it from the choices consumers make in a simple experiment. Figure 5.11 shows how this works. The starting point is that a product consists of a bundle of characteristics. For example: the value (the ‘usefulness’) of a cake to someone is determined by five properties (step 1). For each of those properties, possible levels are determined for the experiment that are

Customer analysis 129

Figure 5.11  Setup of a conjoint analysis

realistic in practice (step 2). For example: the taste (tasty, neutral), the price (€1 or €2), the color (yellow or brown), the freshness (fresh or not fresh), and the brand name (Hostess or Twinkies). With conjoint measurement, a manager wants to find out how important those properties are. New properties can also be included. If the analyses are done on a large number of people, differences between groups of consumers can also be looked at (benefit segmentation). Subsequently, a number of so-called products are defined, where each product is defined as a combination of properties (step 3). For example: cake 1: has a good taste, has a high price, is brown, is not fresh, and is from Hostess. Cake 2: is averagely tasty, has a low price, is yellow, is fresh, and is from Hostess. And so on up to a certain number of cakes, for example, 18. It is not necessary to use all possible combinations (in the example, there would be 32), but a selection can be made using specially developed schemes. This concerns so-called fractional designs or fractional factor designs: overviews of combinations of profiles given a number of attributes and levels per attribute. All the consumer has to do is sort the cakes by preference (step 4). It can be useful to put each product on a card, with or without a suitable picture. The consumer can then arrange the cards in order. For example, in SPSS (a program used for statistical purposes), the preferences of the respondents are statistically explained from the composition of the profiles. For each respondent (or groups of respondents), it is then calculated how important the consumer considered each of the properties, for example, taste: 45%, price 27%, color 5%, freshness 9%, brand 14% (see Figure 5.12 for a possible outcome).

130  Situation analysis Taste Level Utility Yummy 60* Neutral 10

Price Level Utility €1 40 €2 10

Colour Level Utility Yellow 10 Brown 5

Difference between highest and lowest

50

30

5

Importance

45%**

27%

5%

Freshness Level Utility Fresh 25 Not 15 fresh 10

Brand name Level Utility Hostess 30 Twinkie 15 s 15

9%

14%

Figure 5.12  Possible outcome of conjoint analysis for cakes for one respondent * This means that level ‘nice’ of attribute ‘taste’ gives a utility of 60 units. The scaling or measurement unit is not directly important; it is about relative differences between levels. ** This is calculated by dividing 50 by the total of all differences (110).

Data from larger groups of consumers can be used for segmentation, product decisions, and pricing decisions. Advantages of conjoint analysis are: • •

the simple questioning: the customer’s selection process is simulated the fact that the interaction between characteristics is taken into account: respondents must implicitly consider which characteristics they find most important

Conjoint analysis is a commonly used method in marketing practice and theory and has various applications (Cattin & Wittink, 1982). We note that the results of a conjoint analysis or of the direct inquiry into needs provide an excellent basis for segmentation. After all, it is precisely in this phase that insight is gained into what customers find important (see also Section 5.2). When choosing respondents, the question is whether research should be carried out exclusively among customers or also among potential customers. There is something to be said for both choices. Investigating exclusively the preferences of existing customers fits in with the pursuit of relationships with customers. On the other hand, a brand cannot ignore the fact that new customers must always be attracted. So research among potential customers is also important. Conducting research among one’s own customers has the advantage that the preferences of the customers can be accommodated in a customer information system. If someone has been a customer for a long time, the importance of values can often be deduced from the purchasing behavior of users.

5.5 Measuring perceptions and associations How well or poorly do we provide the desired product properties? This question can be examined qualitatively as well as quantitatively: how do we and our competitors score on properties and consequences?

Customer analysis 131

In fact, brand perceptions are measured here. At this point a comparison is in order with the measurement of what Keller (1993) calls brand equity. According to Keller, brand awareness and brand associations are the sources of brand equity. These sources should lead to results in the form of satisfaction, brand loyalty, market share, and so on. To know if a brand is successful and why, it is therefore important to measure the sources and results of brand equity. Measuring brand associations can be done qualitatively or quantitatively.

5.5.1  Qualitative methods Qualitative methods are: n The direct association method. What do you associate brand A with? n Projective techniques. Indirect methods, such as having matching photos indicated

or describing the brand as a person with character. The latter method is very suitable for measuring psychosocial (abstract) properties of a brand and provides important information for the choice of brand positioning.

Another part of the qualitative analysis is gaining insight into consumer satisfaction and especially into the underlying causes of the level of satisfaction. Talking to consumers about what they think of the brand and why is often a big eye-opener for managers. As we will see in Section 5.7, qualitative research does not require very many respondents to get a fairly complete picture of what is going on with customers (and non-customers). Even if one decides not to conduct quantitative research, qualitative research is already extremely valuable and can be used individually for strategic decisions.

5.5.2  Likert scales and spider diagrams Also with quantitative methods, we can distinguish between direct and indirect methods. For example, direct methods use statements, where the respondent is asked to rate their level of agreement on a ranking scale (Likert scales). The rule of thumb for a Likert scale is that at least 5 categories are required to interpret the ordinal scale as an interval or ratio scale, that is, to calculate averages. For instance: To what extent do you agree with the following statements about the iPhone 14?  

An iPhone 14 is expensive An iPhone 14 is a good brand An iPhone 14 has a good camera function . . .

Totally disagree

Disagree

More or less agree

At sometime

Totally agree

132  Situation analysis 7

6

5

4

3

2

Soft

1 Sharp

Spares colours

Affects colours

Contains bleach

Without bleach

For delicate textiles

For sheets and towels

Smells good

Smells bad For normal washing machine

For drum machine Modern

Old-fashioned

Biological

Not biological Unsuitable for nylon

Good for nylon

Normal quality

Special quality Users of brand X about X Users of brand X about Y

Figure 5.13  Detergent images (semantic differential)

Scores from such a table can be displayed in two ways: with percentages of people who (totally) agree/disagree, and so on, or with scores where scores 1 to 5 can be chosen in the table and thus an average over respondents can be calculated, for example, a 4.1 on the statement ‘An iPhone is expensive’. A simple instrument that clearly displays both instrumental and abstract brand properties is the semantic differential: a graphical representation of brands’ scores on properties. Figure 5.13 contains an example. Another way to represent brand scores is in a spider chart, where, for example, eight properties are shown in a circle. Figure 5.14 contains an example of scores on values for users and non-users of a mustard brand. Both the semantic differential and the spider diagram can show comparisons between, for example, two brands (Figure 5.13) or two target groups (Figure 5.14).

5.5.3  Perceptual mapping Indirect quantitative methods to measure brand perceptions are methods for the benefit of perceptual mapping. Perceptual maps are certainly important and easy-to-understand research methods for positioning and communication decisions. In this technique, brands are placed in axes; for example, the axes say something about conservative/dynamic, tough/feminine, or other brand personality traits (see also the overviews of brand values in Section 11.4). Sometimes groups of consumers (segments) are also placed in such images.

Customer analysis 133

Figure 5.14 Spider diagram: scores on values for users and non-users of mustard brand

A valid way in which perceptual maps can be obtained is with the technique of multidimensional scale analysis. With MDS, brands, properties, and ideal points (wishes) of users are clearly placed in a figure using a statistical method, using simple questions to respondents. Figure 5.15 contains an example of a joint space (brand space) for the roll-your-own tobacco market. A brand’s score on a characteristic is obtained by drawing a perpendicular line from the brand to a characteristic. Figure 5.15 shows, for example, that tobacco brands C and F score highest on the characteristic dark, while brand A has a young and feminine image. The image of A is very similar to that of B. If A wants to grow at the expense of B, it must position itself differently, for example, as a somewhat stronger shag, that is, to the right (higher score on characteristic 9). Another advantage of this is that there is a segment of smokers that needs a strong and cozy brand (segment III), but such a brand does not exist. Some important advantages of MDS as a research method are: n n n

The results of MDS (graphic displays of brand positions) are easy to understand and as such an excellent communication tool for positioning decisions. MDS makes it possible to use more than two dimensions. The dimensions on which people rate brands are placed as vectors in the figure. The positions of the brands in space are ‘hard’; that is, they are calculated according to a quantitative method. This distinguishes MDS from commonly used qualitative

134  Situation analysis

x

7

4

x

x

II

F

x x

x

H

C

8

G

x

5 E D

I

III

x x x x x x x

9

x x

x x

A B 2 3

6

x

x

1

Explanation: A to H are the brands, 1 to 9 are the attributes, X is the ideal point of a consumer, I, II and III are segments. Attributes: 1 = pleasant, 2 = for young people, 3 = for women, 4 = bitter, 5 = tar, 6 = smells good, 7 = difficult to get used to, 8 = dark, 9 = smells strong.

Figure 5.15  Example of a joint space with features: tobacco brands

ways of placing brands in spaces.

n The method of data collection at MDS follows a true-to-nature approach: respondents

are asked to compare brands as a whole (as well as in the store, for example) and only afterwards are the properties placed in the figure. This makes MDS an indirect method in which respondents do not have to indicate what they consider important but which can be determined by the researcher afterwards on the basis of the results.

Reliable results of MDS can already be achieved with a small number of respondents. These results also lend themselves well to segmentation into, for example, use versus non-use. Taking measurements as described in this section provides insight into the strengths and weaknesses of the brand. That is why there is a link between the customer analysis and internal analysis. It is very important here to distinguish between customers and potential customers. Potential customers (i.e. non-customers) often view a brand differently than customers (see Case 5.4). An answer to the question ‘Why don’t potential customers buy our product?’ is important for winning new customers.

Customer analysis 135

Case 5.4  Difference in perceptions between customers and noncustomers

Will New Zealand remain a green and pleasant land? ‘100 per cent pure New Zealand’: Tourism New Zealand’s catchphrase used since 1999. Why mess with a good thing? The notion of a country blessed with pristine land, water, and air appeals not only to visitors; it goes to the core of what the country means to New Zealanders themselves. So the slogan has the ‘authenticity’ such expressions always call for. But there is a problem. New Zealanders are growing unsure about their country’s 100% pure image. One issue comes from the sheer numbers of tourists themselves. Another comes from the back end of a cow. Some of the most popular tourist places are getting ‘hammered’. Another problem is fragile landscapes ravaged to make way for cows, such as in the Mackenzie district, a dry upland rich in endemic plant and animal species that has been completely changed by irrigation. Conservationists are appalled that a rare ecology has been destroyed. Indeed, water gets to the heart of New Zealanders’ concerns. Dairy cattle need a lot of it and produce copious excrement and urine in return. This pollutes watercourses and fills lakes with algal blooms, despite new requirements to fence streams off from livestock. Some rivers have become too polluted to swim in. With images like that, it can’t be long before visitors notice there’s a problem in this pure, unsullied land. Source: The Economist, 21 September 2017

136  Situation analysis

5.6 Measuring brand strength In this section we will discuss brand power and brand value, the brand equity pyramid, the net promoter score, the brand power questionnaire, and the indirect measurement of the importance of product properties.

5.6.1  Brand strength and brand value Measuring brand strength: a brand is an important part of a company’s assets. The fact that people know a brand and have certain associations with it is ‘worth money’. For various reasons, it can be important to know how strong a brand actually is. Namely: n for the benefit of strategy formation and (adjustment of) the marketing policy n due to mergers and/or acquisitions n due to a financial valuation on the balance sheet (and/or due to possible damage due

to crisis situations)

The method by which the value of a brand must be measured depends strongly on which of the aforementioned motives plays a role. In the case of the latter two reasons, a manager will want to know the financial value of the brand. But when it comes to dayto-day strategy-making, one number is of little use to a manager because one number does not provide any insight into the strengths and weaknesses of a brand. For strategic marketing purposes, several separate dimensions of a brand will have to be mapped. In this context, Keller and Swaminathan (2019) compare a brand to an aircraft: a pilot will never rely on one ‘meter’ but on a multitude of them. We distinguish between two types of brand strengths: 1 2

Brand power: the power of the brand in the eyes of the customer. This involves different dimensions of the brand, such as the reputation and the image. Brand value: the financial value of the brand for the company.

There is, of course, a connection between these two concepts: a brand with stronger brand power (more brand knowledge) will also be worth more money (Figure 5.16). In this book, we focus on brand power. We agree with Keller (1993), who uses the term customer-based brand equity to indicate that brand strength is measured from the perspective of customers. Measuring the financial value of a brand is not easy and is often done by agencies. A well-known method is that of agency Interbrand. This estimates the annual future cash flow of a brand and multiplies it by a factor that depends on the brand strength of the brand. For more insight into methods to measure the financial value of a brand, we refer to the literature. All methods require a fair degree of subjectivity. Agencies often keep parts of the methodology secret. This makes it impossible to validate a method. We will now discuss in Sections 5.6.2 and 5.6.3 two commonly used models: Keller’s brand equity model and the net promoter score. Next, we present a way to measure brand

Customer analysis 137

Construct

Measured by

Brand strength

Customer perceptions

Brand value

Financial measures

Figure 5.16 Measuring brand strength

Brand loyalty

Functional part of the brand

Consumer judgements

Brand performance

Consumer feelings

Emotional part of the brand

Brand imagery

Brand awareness

Source: Based on and adapted from Keller (2013).

Figure 5.17 Customer-based brand equity: Keller’s pyramid

power with a comprehensive questionnaire: the brand power scale (Section 5.6.4).

5.6.2 Brand Equity Pyramid Keller (2019) outlines the so-called brand equity pyramid (Figure 5.17 shows a modified version), which he later renamed the brand resonance model. The hierarchical model states that a brand must first achieve brand salience (brand awareness): a brand must acquire a prominent position in the minds of customers. The importance of familiarity ties in with Sharp’s aforementioned findings (see Chapter 1). The second level relates to brand performance. This concerns the rational performance (left side) and the more emotional performance (right side). The third level concerns how the customer responds

138  Situation analysis

to the characteristics of the brand: what does he think of it, and what kind of feelings does the brand evoke? The highest level is about brand loyalty (brand resonance), which involves not only buying behavior (such as repeat purchases), but also emotional loyalty or even customer ambassadorship. The latter can occur if a customer feels actively involved with a brand. Reactions on social media are often an expression of this. For market research, Keller’s model means that all six boxes should be measured to know how strong a brand is.

5.6.3  Net Promoter Score Ideally, customers are very loyal to a brand and even show involvement. In practice this rarely happens. Nevertheless, it is important for a brand to know how loyal customers are. There are two types of brand loyalty: n emotional brand loyalty: a customer is a real ‘fan’ of your brand n behavioral brand loyalty: a customer always buys your brand: repeat purchases

Brand loyalty in terms of behavior seems to be the most important for a brand because it generates sales. Yet that is not entirely true. Repeat purchases can also come from habit and convenience without true, emotional brand loyalty. The risk is that customers then easily walk away if, for example, a competitor has a better offer. Naturally, a brand prefers to have customers who are emotionally and behaviorally loyal. We mentioned earlier that Sharp discovered that even real brand fans occasionally buy another brand, a form of ‘infidelity’, so to speak. One way to measure emotional brand preference is to ask about the likelihood that you would recommend the brand to others: the degree of ‘customer ambassadorship’. The question is then: ‘Please indicate on a scale of 0 to 10 how likely it is that you would recommend the brand to friends and family’. The interpretation of this scale is subjective. For example, the ‘report mark’ of 7 or 8 seems quite high. However, people are often rather indifferent about brands, so a figure of 8 does not mean that customers are actually active ambassadors and, for example, will spontaneously say in social media that they are so happy with their iPhone. It is often assumed

Figure 5.18  Net promoter score scale

Customer analysis 139

that people already have to score a 9 or 10 before they are active ambassadors. That is why Veldhoen and Van Slooten (2010) state that 9+ experiences must be created! Conversely, a ‘report mark’ of 6 does not necessarily mean that a customer is sufficiently satisfied. All these considerations led to the so-called net promoter score, a measure developed by Reichheld (2003). On this scale, the respondents are divided into promoters (scores of 9–10), passives (scores of 7–8), and ‘runaways’ (6 and below) (see Figure 5.18). Then the percentage of runaways is subtracted from the percentage of promoters. This yields the net promoter score (NPS). A percentage of 75 or higher is considered high. An NPS can also be negative: more scores of ‘6 and below’ than ‘9 and above’. This does not necessarily mean that the brand is performing poorly. In many categories, NPS scores are low on average simply because engagement is low. NPS scores also vary by country. While there is no academic evidence that this measure is ‘better’ than other measures (Keiningham et al., 2007), measuring the degree of recommendation itself is an interesting thought that is close to expected behavior. Incidentally, no clear scientific conclusion has yet been drawn about the extent to which the NPS is or is not a good predictor of a company’s profit. The NPS is particularly interesting as a benchmark for comparison.

5.6.4  Brand strength scale For marketing-strategic goals, it is recommended to measure the brand strength on the basis of a number of dimensions (the aforementioned ‘meters from an airplane’). The question then is which ‘meters’ are needed and how the scores are arrived at. We use some parts from the aforementioned models, apply some changes, and arrive at the following dimensions: 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

category involvement importance of properties brand awareness functional brand associations emotional brand associations uniqueness brand brand preference and loyalty customer properties

The main differences from Keller’s pyramid are that variables are ordered differently and category involvement and customer attributes are added. The eight types of variables correspond to the three types of variables covered in segmentation: categorized variables (1 and 2), branded variables (3 through 7), and customer characteristics (8). Figure 5.19 shows an example of a detailed questionnaire. The questionnaire also contains some items from a scale developed by Yoo and Donthu (2001). Specific scales can be used for the emotional associations, such as the brand personality scale or the value compass, both of which are discussed in Chapter 11. In Figure 5.19, we assume that management itself has chosen some specific associations with which it wants to be associated: the identity. The power of measurements often lies in comparisons. The measuring instrument outlined here (or variants thereof) is particularly valuable if the measurements are repeated regularly (monitoring or tracking) so that changes can be observed. Comparisons

140  Situation analysis

1

Category involvement † How often do you buy deodorant? † How important is buying deodorant to you?

2

Relevance of attributes Let me tell you some attributes of deodorant products in general. Would you indicate how important those qualities are to you? † † † † † † † †

3

Price Fragrance How long it works Ease of use Appearance product Feeling on the skin Environmental friendliness General quality

Brand awareness † I am familiar with Ax . † I can easily recognize Ax from other brands. † I can easily recall some of Ax 's features.

4

Functional brand associations The following questions are related to Ax . Please indicate to what extent you agree with the statements. † † † † † † † †

5

Ax is cheap. Ax smells good. When I use Ax it helps for a long period of time. Ax is easy to use. The Ax products look nice. Ax feels nice on my skin. Ax is environmentally friendly. Ax is of high quality.

Emotional brand associations Please indicate to what extent you think that the mentioned characteristics fit Ax . † † † † † †

Young Fun Daring Male Temptation Reliable

Figure 5.19  Example of a detailed questionnaire to measure brand strength: brand strength scale (BSS)

Customer analysis 141

6

Brand uniqueness † If you weren't buying Ax deodorant, what brand of deodorant would you

choose?

† To what extent do you find Ax clearly different from other deodorant brands?

7

Brand Use and Preference † Do you currently own Ax? † How often do you buy Ax?

Please indicate the extent to which you agree with the following statements. † Ax is my first choice in deodorant. † I would recommend Ax to my friends (brand ambassadorship). † If another brand is as good as Axe, I would buy Axe .

8

Customer Properties † † † †

Are you male/female/none? What is your age? What is your highest completed education? What class does your gross annual salary fall into ?[#brief]

Figure 5.19 (Continued)

between groups of customers (segmentation) are also interesting.

5.6.5  Indirectly measuring the importance of product properties We mentioned the difference between the importance of product features and the brand’s score on them. With the method of conjoint measurement described in Section 5.4.2, we also mentioned that asking about importance often gives less reliable answers and that it may therefore be better to find out the importance by means of, for example, conjoint measurement. The brand strength scale offers a simpler way to derive importance scores indirectly by asking for and combining two types of data: n the scores on (functional and emotional) characteristics n a performance measure such as brand ambassadorship

When the brand performance is explained by means of a simple regression from the scores, it is found which associations have the strongest influence on the final brand assessment. This implicitly ‘calculates’ the importance of those associations (see Figure 5.20). A concrete result is, for example, the price sensitivity. That is the influence of people’s opinion about ‘whether Ax is cheap’ on brand preference.

142  Situation analysis

Independent variable Scores on associations (e.g. Price perception)

Regression

Dependent variable e.g. Loyalty (e.g. Level of recommendation)

Regression coefficient = influence of assocation on loyalty = importance of association

Figure 5.20  Estimating the importance of associations retrospectively

5.7 Individual customer data In this section, we will successively discuss the possibilities of individual customer data, especially online data, and the selection of customers.

5.7.1  Possibilities of online data With the enormous growth of online behavior (of both customers and companies), individual data is ‘on the street’. This is a break with the previous century, in which obtaining data per customer was very difficult for manufacturers, and only retailers with, for example, a customer card had data per customer. There is now enough data, it seems. But is that true? What data is currently available online and what kind of information does that provide? Online data relates to: n n n n

Communication behavior: what do consumers do on social media? Search behavior: how do consumers search online (keywords, which sites, etc.)? Click behavior: which sites (and pages) have the most clicks? Buying behavior: what do consumers buy online?

The big advantage of this data is that it concerns actual behavior. This is in contrast to research with questionnaires. But this is where a limitation immediately comes into play: online data provides hardly any insight into the ‘why question’. What is also unknown are demographic and psychographic characteristics of consumers. The question is, incidentally, to what extent the latter is serious. Background characteristics of consumers are normally important for media accessibility. But consumer targeting can be done without that background data. Online consumers can easily be followed on the basis of their online behavior. If someone texts their family that they went to the dentist, don’t be surprised if they see a banner for toothpaste next. Another way to reach customers online is to send targeted messages to specific locations (mobile marketing or location marketing). By capturing the signal from smartphones, mobile

Customer analysis 143

providers know where people are. If someone approaches a drugstore, the offer of that drugstore can ‘coincidentally’ come across on the smartphone. We mention a few more pluses and minuses of online data. A plus is that online is ideal for experiments. For example, testing different websites or Facebook messages and seeing what the differences are in responses. This is called A/B testing. Limitations are that online consumers are not necessarily representative of all customers of a brand. In addition, online purchases still make up a limited portion of all sales. In addition, the rules regarding privacy have become stricter. In practice, there are two ‘systems’ for protecting the use of individual customer data: opt-in and opt-out. Opt-in means choosing to participate and that people must give explicit permission for the use of data (active permission, for example, with a loyalty card). Opt-out means choosing to ‘opt out’ and implies that it is tacitly assumed that individual data may be used unless objected to (passive consent, e.g. responding to a coupon promotion). Opt-in is becoming more important. This is also friendlier from a customer-oriented point of view. This is also referred to as permission marketing: you can only enter into a direct relationship with a customer if she has given explicit permission for this. In contrast to self-collected data, online data is often unstructured (Balducci & Marinova, 2018). To extract the right information from the large amounts of ‘unstructured data’, specific research methods are needed (Wedel & Kannan, 2016). For example, it may concern textual information from consumer reviews and discussions, which therefore requires textual analysis methods (Humphreys & Wang, 2018). But it also concerns artificial intelligence (AI). Because there currently (2023) is a lot of attention on artificial intelligence, we make some extra remarks about AI. The reason for growing attention to AI is probably that new, appealing applications of AI have been introduced, such as ChatGPT: an application that can produce impressive texts by simply providing some keywords. Some people think that AI is quite new. That is not true. It was ‘invented’ in 1950. And in marketing, ‘big data’ has existed since the invention of ‘scanner data’ in the 1980s and after the World Wide Web in the 1990s. Since then, market researchers have used statistical software to analyze this data. The central idea of AI is no more or less than to find patterns in data. The data can be hard data (numbers, texts) but also soft data such as sound and the relation between the data (e.g. speech recognition). A related method is machine learning: a specific form of AI aimed at enabling software to improve itself by ‘learning and doing’. Applications of AI are: self-driving Teslas, Google Home (or Nest), Siri, apps to make a drawing from text, and (thus) ChatGPT. For sure, new applications of AI will be developed in the future. The final question is how useful AI is for marketing. In our view, AI is helpful in the stage of analysis.

5.7.2  Selecting customers Companies that are able to obtain data on purchasing behavior at the customer level have various tools at their disposal to analyze that data. Of these we cover: n the customer pyramid n the customer portfolio analysis

144  Situation analysis

Share of sales Large customers Medium-sized customers Small customers

Former customers Non-customers, but target audience

Number of customers

Non-customers and not target audience

Figure 5.21  The customer pyramid

Customer pyramid The customer pyramid (see Figure 5.21) is a diagram that ranks (potential) customers. This ordering can be done, for example, on the basis of the annual turnover (per customer). It is plausible that a similar 80/20 rule exists for customers as for products: 20% of the customers could be good for 80% of the turnover. Of course this is a fairly arbitrary rule of thumb, and a different ratio may just as well apply, but the meaning is clear: a small number of customers are responsible for a large part of the turnover. Further down the pyramid, we find the medium and small customers, former customers, non-target customers, and finally the non-target people. Once an order of customers has been made, the next question is what characteristics the various groups have. Why is a large customer big and a small customer small? Why have customers left? Why are some audience members not customers at all? Figure 5.21 can be an aid to target group selection and value strategy. In theory, the best strategy seems to be the one with the strongest possible flow from bottom to top. There are several options for this: n turn a non-customer into a customer n retain customers n increase customer turnover

Each of these strategies requires a different approach. In the context of relationship marketing, it is often said that retaining customers is four times cheaper than making new ones. On the other hand, it is difficult to completely ignore new customers. Without growth, the customer base will shrink.

Customer analysis 145

Customer selection is also called customer discrimination. This may suggest an unethical principle, but is simply part of targeting.

Customer portfolio analysis Another tool that can be helpful in this context is the customer portfolio analysis. Each customer is classified according to two characteristics: 1 the extent to which the customer is a ‘heavy user’ in the product category: the (potential) size of the customer 2 the share of the brand turnover in the customer’s category purchases, or the customer’s market share The first criterion says something about the potential/expected attractiveness of a customer, the second about the current attractiveness. A concept that is often used in this context is the customer lifetime value: the value of a customer to a company, measured over the customer’s entire life, including the effect of recommendations the customer makes to others (ambassadorship). This concept shows that customer loyalty is essential for a company, because a customer who walks away can make a big difference in future revenue. There is a lot of scientific literature on measuring customer lifetime value (Gupta et al., 2006; Borle et al., 2008; Blattberg et al., 2009), which means that the use of this concept is also possible in practice.

5.8 Primary research: tips and pitfalls Primary data is data that an organization itself collects through fieldwork (market research). For an extensive treatment of market research, we refer to the literature on this topic (Malhotra et al., 2017; Cooper & Schindler, 2014). We cover a few points here. In market research, the following three choices must be made: 1 2 3

Choice of target group (who?). Among which target group or target groups should the research be conducted? This question is to a large extent decisive for the further design. Desired information and choice of quantitative or qualitative research (what?). We will consider this question in Section 5.8.1. Design (how?): n data collection n sample n method of questioning

5.8.1  Quantitative or qualitative research As always with market research, there are two basic types of research possible: 1 2

quantitative study qualitative research

146  Situation analysis

1  Quantitative research Quantitative research is by definition conducted among larger numbers of people. Due to the large-scale approach, ‘harder’ conclusions can be drawn than with qualitative research: after all, results are obtained in percentages. Another advantage is that differences between sub-target groups (segments) can be made visible, for example, differences in satisfaction between young people and older people or between different types of companies (an ‘explanatory’ goal). Because the type of fieldwork in quantitative research (online, written, or telephone) requires a structured approach, such a method is best suited for ‘factual’ research, especially descriptive. Quantitative research is not primarily intended to provide insight into the ‘why’ of certain results.

2  Qualitative research Qualitative research consists of personal (face-to-face) interviews with individuals (in-depth interviews) or groups (group discussion, focus groups). Qualitative research can be used as an independent resource to find out how people view the brand and what its strengths and weaknesses are. It can also be performed prior to quantitative research: as a source of inspiration for and/or pre-testing a questionnaire. The choice of a quantitative or qualitative approach should not be taken primarily on the basis of the impression that quantitative research is by definition more reliable than qualitative research. Of greater importance is the question of what kind of information one wants to obtain. If the organization wishes to gain insight into the percentages of people from the target group who are or are not satisfied with the product in the context of customer satisfaction survey and how the relationship is with the composition and backgrounds of the target group, then a quantitative approach is required. It should be realized, however, that such a survey cannot reveal the cause of any dissatisfaction. Information about these causes is often best obtained by looking at the comments added by respondents (e.g. at the end of a questionnaire). In this way, the biggest complaints emerge in a questionnaire. However, this concerns an incidental inventory of problems, which moreover is actually qualitative in nature. If one especially wants to know why there is dissatisfaction and what an organization can do about it, then a qualitative approach is more obvious. Figure 5.22 shows the ideal choice on this point: first qualitatively, then possibly quantitatively and then again qualitatively. Customer research will always start with qualitative research, whereby an initial inventory is obtained of possible problems and information that is relevant for setting up a quantitative study is collected. Such research can then be followed by quantitative research to provide insight into whether goals have been achieved, the extent to which certain problems occur, and differences between groups. Subsequently, a deeper qualitative analysis can be carried out among target groups to find out what causes any problems, and possible solutions can possibly be presented to respondents. Of course, the method described here is only possible with sufficient resources. With limited resources, at least some qualitative research will almost always be required,

Customer analysis 147

Qualitative research problem inventory and relevant factors

Necessary to know ‘percentages’?

Quantitative research quantification of results and differences between segments

Need for clarification of quantitative results?

Qualitative research further problem analysis

Figure 5.22  Research phases

because a small number of conversations with customers already provide insight into problems and possible solutions. Examples: n By talking to only a few customers, a large telecom company discovered that customers

did not find the various subscriptions as simple as the managers themselves thought.

n At a bank, the website, which was made with a lot of technical ingenuity, was given

a try by customers. They turned out not to understand many terms at all: the website was made far too much by the company and much less by the customer.

After the company has decided on the most appropriate type of study, decisions must be made on the further design and on the size and composition of the sample. We first elaborate on these topics for qualitative research (Section 5.8.2). Subsequently, in Section 5.8.3, we will discuss two specific examples of qualitative research. Finally, in Section 5.8.4, we discuss the quantitative research.

5.8.2  Qualitative research: tips We will give only a few short guidelines (for a more extensive treatment, we refer to Malhotra et al., 2017 and Cooper & Schindler, 2014). In qualitative research, one has to make a choice between individual conversations/interviews or interviews in groups. In

148  Situation analysis

general, it can be said that if people are interested in their own individual behavior (such as choice processes, usage behavior) of people, individual conversations are preferable. If the researcher is mainly interested in gaining insight into how ‘people’ think about the organization and its products, a group discussion can be chosen. A group discussion has the advantage that more issues and ideas emerge through the interaction within the group. Subsequently, the size and composition of the sample must be determined. The most crucial is the latter: the respondents must be carefully selected according to the relative composition of the entire target group. Suppose, for example, that the target group consists of 30% women over the age of 60. In that case, 6 women over the age of 60 should be included in a research group of 20 people. If respondents are selected in the ‘correct’ manner, the representativeness of qualitative research is, in principle, sufficiently guaranteed. A related point is the sample size. An important criticism of qualitative research is that a survey of a few people can never be the basis for strategic decisions of an organization. However, research shows that if approximately 15 to 25 respondents from a group are questioned, then virtually no new cases will emerge. After about 20 interviews, the researcher will therefore know ‘what’s going on’. Usually she even has a reasonable impression of the extent to which the target group is aware of this. In group discussions it is usually recommended to interview more or less homogeneous groups. Think of a few groups of customers, as well as one or more groups of non-customers (potential customers) and perhaps former customers. A common pitfall in market research is that only customers are interviewed. The results of such research are by definition not representative of the entire potential target group, because existing customers on average think more positively about the organization than customers who are with competitors. If we assume that every organization not only exists for its own customers but is also interested in potential new customers, this means that non-customers must also be questioned. With regard to group discussions, a group size of six to eight people is considered appropriate in most cases. We also note that the 15 to 25 respondents mentioned apply to each group to be studied about which the researcher wishes to make statements. If a researcher wishes to investigate the differences between, for example, male customers, female customers and non-customers, the standard therefore applies three times. If the minimum of about 15 people per group is assumed and group discussions of about 8 people are chosen at a time, then a minimum of six group discussions should be organized in this example. With regard to the method of data collection, there are open questions, in which it is the task of the interviewer to monitor whether all topics are covered. We do point out the danger of interviewer bias: inaccurate answers as a result of influences by the interviewer. Face-to-face examinations require expert questioning in order to collect information that is as pure as possible. The strength of good qualitative research lies in ‘creative listening’. In principle, two methods can be used to process interviews: 1 2

The researcher summarizes the results in a short summary text. Having recorded interviews (online) transcribed into text, highlighting words and having them analyzed with text analysis software such as Atlas.TI.

Customer analysis 149

5.8.3  Customer journey mapping and neuromarketing In this subsection we discuss two specific qualitative research methods: customer journey research and neuromarketing.

Customer journey mapping A popular tool in qualitative research is mapping the ‘customer journey ‘. This means that a researcher maps out the experiences of contact moments for individual customers from the very first contact to the last and everything in between. This is close to the decision-making and buying process as depicted in the basic consumer behavior model in Figure 5.23. This involves looking at how the customer has experienced the contact and how the organization can improve on it. So a hospital could map the patient journey by analyzing all contact moments on the patient’s experiences from the patient’s arrival at the reception up to and including discharge after surgery. In the literature, attention to the customer journey coincides with the attention to customer experiences (see, among others, Lemon & Verhoef, 2016). Figure 5.23 provides a schematic view that can be used in customer journey research. 1 2 3 4

An organization should first list all phases with contact moments. Customer satisfaction is examined for each phase. The outcomes are analyzed per phase by looking at what the organization itself has done. The results are used as input in internal discussions with staff.

Neuromarketing As we mentioned earlier in Chapter 1, the majority of customer choices are driven by unconscious drivers. It is therefore logical that researchers would like to look literally

Figure 5.23  Schematic view of customer journey research

150  Situation analysis

inside the head of that consumer. For example, researchers borrow techniques from the medical sciences and put respondents under a scanner and then make brain scans while a respondent sees an advertisement. At most, this provides an impression of the emotions of respondents to certain stimuli. But there are important caveats to note. First of all, the name ‘neuromarketing’ suggests all kinds of incorrect things, namely that there would be separate marketing based on ‘the functioning of the brain’. This misconception may also lead to marketing being seen as unethical because it ‘sneaky try to mislead us’. Neuromarketing therefore does not exist and can be better called neuromarket research, for example. A limitation of neuromarket research is that the link with behavior is often difficult to draw. Instead of trying to delve deeper into the mind of the consumer, a researcher could actually go less deep and put more emphasis on measuring behavior. The latter is also increasingly happening in much experimental psychological research.

5.8.4  Quantitative research: tips Quantitative research using questionnaires is now largely conducted online. It also happens by mail. The advantage of a written survey is the possibility of a longer questionnaire and the relative simplicity of reaching a very large number of people. On the other hand, the response is often very low (in consumer research, often no higher than 15%). Quantitative research involves a fully pre-structured multiple-choice questionnaire, because otherwise no quantitative analyses can be performed. Because an error or ambiguity in a questionnaire that has been sent out cannot be reversed, it is essential that the questionnaire be tested in advance until no ambiguities are indicated by the test persons (after being explicitly asked for). A model like the one described in this chapter can be used when constructing a questionnaire, but it is always good to also study other studies (including scientific studies) that have investigated similar problems. If relationships need to be explored, a conceptual model can form the basis for the format of the questionnaire. Studying literature also applies to the use of scales (items to measure constructs). There are even publications with entire overviews of scales in marketing and consumer behavior (Handbook of Marketing Scales). The method of asking questions and thus the use of items determines, among other things, the validity: are you measuring what you want to measure? For constructs in which several items (i.e. a scale) are used, the validity of the items can be checked afterwards by seeing whether they correlate sufficiently (Cronbach’s alpha). For the sample size, the larger it is, the greater the (statistical) reliability of the results. But this relation is not linear (it is a ‘root function’). Without going into formulas that can be used to calculate the reliability margins of answers, we can say that a rule of thumb is that at least 100 respondents must be reached per target group to be researched. Assuming an expected non-response of, for example, 20%, a minimum of 500 questionnaires would have to be sent per group in the case of a written survey. More important than the sample size is the sample composition. If the composition of the group of people who participated on characteristics relevant to the research does not correspond to the entire target group (is not representative), the results are unreliable. It is therefore very important to check afterwards whether the requirement of representativeness has been met. If the response group deviates from the target group, additional

Customer analysis 151

respondents must be obtained or so-called reweightings must be applied in the analysis. It is sometimes said that a study was representative because of its large sample size (or, conversely, unrepresentative because of its small size). This statement is nonsensical, because representativeness is not related to sample size. In well-known tables on statistical margins, numbers of approximately 380 respondents correspond to a confidence level of 5% in the results. These numbers are correct in themselves but say nothing about the representativeness. A representative group of 100 respondents may give more valuable results than a non-representative group of 1,000 respondents! With regard to reporting on quantitative research, it is advisable to make your own short summary tables or figures and not include SPSS output in the body of the report or even in the appendices. In conclusion: 1 2 3 4

Never automatically fall into the urge to create and administer questionnaires. Think carefully about the purpose of your research and then see what kind of information and therefore research is needed. When you create a questionnaire, study other studies first. Use existing scales as much as possible and use a conceptual model for explanatory research. In quantitative research, representativeness, that is, the composition of the sample, is more important than the size of the sample. A minimum of 380 respondents, for example, is therefore nonsensical. Preferably use theory and a conceptual model to draw up a questionnaire.

Summary Customer analysis is divided into primary research (market research) and secondary research (using existing sources, such as online data). A first application is to substantiate segmentation. Segment identification takes place by analyzing, on the basis of large-scale quantitative research, which groups of consumers or customers display similar preferences or comparable usage behavior and then describing these groups on the basis of the most characteristic features. The segments found are the basis for targeting decisions to be made later. A second goal of customer research is to provide the necessary information for making positioning decisions. To this end, one must gain insight into two different dimensions: what is important to customers, and how does the brand perform on the desired properties? Various models and methods can be used, each with its own specific utility. For example, conjoint analysis is suitable for finding out the importance of properties. The means-goal chain is an argument for digging deeper into motivations. Measuring brand perceptions can be done with Likert scales. Keller’s brand equity pyramid is part of the basis of the brand power questionnaire that has been presented. Eight dimensions are reflected in that list: category involvement, importance of attributes, brand awareness, functional brand associations, emotional brand associations, brand loyalty and ambassadorship, uniqueness, and consumer characteristics. These dimensions should be measured at least annually, allowing comparisons over time. The amount of online data, often not collected yourself, is increasing enormously. This data has the great advantage that it concerns actual communication, search, and

152  Situation analysis

purchasing behavior of consumers. Analyzing it requires specific methods (e.g. artificial intelligence). The internet is ideal for experimental research. Online data provides little insight into why consumers do or do not buy products. Stricter privacy rules also place restrictions on the use of individual data. A combination of qualitative and quantitative primary and secondary research provides the most complete picture of the profile and the wishes, perceptions, and behavior of (potential) customers.

Customer analysis 153



Kia in the UK: from ‘budget’ to premium

Kia certainly didn’t pull any punches when it came to describing how British consumers might see the brand. ‘Low value’, ‘budget’, and ‘small’ were just some of the words that Kia’s marketing director David Hilbert singled out. But that is all changing with the South Korean manufacturer investing in its ambitious plan to go premium and going full speed ahead in electric cars. The car brand has been in the UK for around 30 years, so Hilbert claims it is still ‘quite a new brand’, which is one of the reasons people on the street who know Kia but don’t own one ‘still have the perception that we do low-value or budget cars’. In recent years, however, Kia has set out to change perceptions by releasing more premium cars, such as its Sportage and Sorento models. Its flagship in the electric and hybrid car segment, the Kia Niro, has become one of the leading cars in that segment. Another crown jewel in Kia’s lineup is the Stinger. It is the result of nearly 10 years worth of design and engineering, and a model Hilbert, who joined the brand in 2016 to drive the transformation, argues redefines Kia as a ‘luxury performance’ brand. ‘The launch of the Stinger is a way to challenge those perceptions of the Kia brand. Over the past few years you can see how we’ve developed our product range to really move away from that initial small car status we had in the UK’, he says. ‘Our newer models are quite polarizing in their design, and that makes them stand out from the crowd’. As Kia has become a top 10 seller in the UK over the years, it no longer sees itself as a challenger brand but as a mainstream competitor, going up against brands such as Nissan, Hyundai, Renault, and Peugeot. Moving upmarket, however, does mean it will have to face off against a new set of brands. Hilbert believes its focus

154  Situation analysis

on tech, including safety features like a heads-up display, will set it apart from rivals. Features such as this will be added to its other models in future. ‘With the Stinger, you don’t have direct competitors, it’s mainly premium ranges of mainstream brands, like Vauxhall’s Insignia series or the high-end Ford or Volkswagen models. But we also touch on competing with premium brands, such as the Audi A5 and A4 series’, he explains. ‘With those premium brands you have to pay for the extras and added spec. But you get that as standard with the Kia Stinger. From a branding point of view, you could argue manufacturers like Audi are more premium than mainstream, but ultimately people buy cars on the exterior styling, and we believe we have a great looking car that will turn heads’.

Shift in marketing The move to attract a more premium audience has also led to a change of approach in marketing. With its target audience – mostly men who are ‘successful in their careers’ – being hard to reach and time poor, the brand decided to have multiple strands to the Stinger’s launch campaign. The introduction campaign of the Stinger involved a ‘hero’ TV ad and digital activity. A major part of the campaign also included an out-of-home takeover at Waterloo Station in London where passersby can see, touch, and feel the car. ‘The best way to shift perceptions is by people seeing and physically touching the car, and to see how far we’ve come in terms of quality and design’, according to Hilbert. A lot of promotional attention was focused around the Six Nations Championship over two major rugby weekends, when the English team took on Wales and Scotland. The brand doesn’t sponsor the tournament, but it wants to be associated with sporting events such as this. Sport has always been a ‘crucial ingredient’ of Kia’s marketing strategy. It has previously rolled out global sponsorship deals around football and invested heavily in cricket on a local level. ‘Sports helps us build Kia’s personality. As we are a relatively new brand we need to develop a personality and sports provides a good way of doing so’, he says. Yet the brand’s head of communications, Jane Fenn, insists it isn’t looking to become an official sponsor of rugby events just yet. ‘Obviously we have associations with football and cricket already, and rugby isn’t something that we’ve sponsored. At the moment that’s not our intention, it’s around trying to best reach our audience and knowing that the audience’s passion points are around sports’, she says.

The challenge of turning a brand around Kia is undoubtedly keen to attract a new demographic, as well as to keep its appeal among its existing customer base. When asked if there is a risk of alienating con-

Customer analysis 155

sumers by trying to appeal to too many different audience segments, Fenn quickly refutes this claim. ‘The fact we’ve got such a diverse product portfolio means the future for us is very much around being a brand that sticks at every single life stage. It’s about making sure we have models that fit into what people are looking for at any stage. I don’t see it being an issue’, she says. The car brand also claims to be realistic about turning its image around, and is taking a ‘long-term approach’. Hilbert says the UK car industry is ‘arguably one of the most competitive environments in the world’, due to the nation’s historic affection for cars. But a regional design office in Germany helps the Korean brand create new products for European tastes. He concludes: ‘If you think about where we were about 20 years ago compared to where we are now, we’ve gone from selling 10,000 cars a year to 100,000 in 2022. This is phenomenal growth and proves we are changing people’s perceptions. Models like the Stinger and the Niro inject even more passion into that and push the boundaries’. Source: Marketingweek.com, Feb. 5, 2018

Questions   1 ‘Kia is undoubtedly keen to attract a new demographic’. Do you agree that demographics are the most relevant segmentation variable for Kia? Explain your answer.   2 Use the multi-attribute attitude model to determine how Kia is perceived, as compared to two competing brands: Toyota and Ford. You decide the characteristics based on which you compare the brands and investigate by talking to at least five (potential) car owners.   3 Use laddering to define customer values with respect to cars: a Invite a car owner for an interview b Define the usage situation on which you wish to focus during the interview (motivation for using the car: commute, leisure, etc.) c Identify the benefits associated with using the car in that usage situation d Finally, define the underlying values for this car owner   4 Create a means-end chain for a premium car brand such as the Kia Stinger.   5 Create a persona for the Kia Stinger. Use the information in the case, but add on with your own desk research or by talking with car owners.   6 Kia focused its promotion around two rugby events. On which dimension(s) of brand equity do you expect this promotion to focus: awareness, identity, image, or resonance? Explain your answer.   7 Do you personally feel that the image associated with rugby matches with the brand image desired by Kia? Explain briefly.   8 Suppose Kia would like to measure whether rugby matches the brand image of Kia. a Would you advice qualitative or quantitative research? Or a combination? Explain your answer b Create an appropriate research design

156  Situation analysis

  9 Suppose Kia would like to use MDS to determine its position in the market. Which steps should be executed to do this analysis? 10 Measure the net promoter score for Kia by conducting a small survey among a number of car owners.

Chapter 6

Industry analysis

Phase 1 Analysis Mission, value strategy and market definition (3)

Internal analysis

Industry analysis (6)

Internal analysis (4)

SWOT (9) Phase 2 Strategy Corporate objectives and strategy (10)

Marketing objectives and strategy (11)

Phase 3 Tactics Product, Price, Place (12); Promotion (13)

Organization of marketing and Personnel (14)

DOI: 10.4324/9781003381488-8

158  Situation analysis

Key points in this chapter n Know the differences between and the goals of an industry analysis and a

competitor analysis.

n Know the components of an industry analysis. n Realize that a Porter analysis is only part of an industry analysis, which in turn

is part of an external analysis.

n Be able to perform a macro-environmental analysis for a company. n Know how to assess the attractiveness of a market.

Introduction This chapter will review the industry analysis. The most important goal of this type of analysis is to gain insight into opportunities and threats from the perspective of the industry and the macroenvironment as well as insight into the attractiveness of the market in which the organization operates. Insight into the attractiveness of the market is important in regard to issues such as determining the investment level. Section 6.1 discusses the concept of industry analysis in relation to the concept of competitor analysis; these two concepts are strongly related. In Section 6.2, the goal and structure of an industry analysis are outlined. We then review the various phases of the industry analysis. Section 6.3 focuses on the analysis of the macroenvironment. The so-called aggregated market factors (including the product life cycle) are reviewed in Section 6.4. In Section 6.5, the factors related to industry structure (including the five competitive forces identified by Porter) receive attention. Finally, Section 6.6 explains how the results of the entire industry analysis can be summarized into conclusions about market attractiveness. Because an industry analysis reviews not just the existing suppliers but also potential ones as well as parties that are not operating in the market directly, this chapter uses the term industry analysis. In this regard we are giving a broader meaning to that concept than is done in daily usage, where it typically refers to a group of businesses that produce or trade strongly related products, such as the house construction industry, the garment industry, and the shoe industry.

6.1 Competitive analysis: industry and competitors The question ‘What is competition?’ seems redundant. After all, everyone knows the answer. Nevertheless, we will briefly consider this, because in recent years in particular in the literature there has been a tendency to shift more and more cases and parties under the designation of competition and competitive analysis. Two meanings can be given to the term ‘competition’: 1 The degree of competition (rivalry, competitive struggle in a market): how strong is the competition in a market for the favor of customers? In other words, how intense is the competition? 2 Competitors: the collective name for all the company’s competitors.

Industry analysis 159

Because of these two different meanings of the concept of competition, a competition analysis consists of two parts (Alsem, 1991): 1 2

An analysis of the intensity of competition in a market. This part of the competitive analysis falls under the industry analysis. An analysis of the behavior of individual competitors. We refer to this as a competitor analysis.

The following differences exist between the two parts: n The main difference is that competitor analysis looks at individual competitors, while

industry analysis looks at competition as a whole (see Figure 6.1). In other words, the industry analysis is a macro-level competitive analysis, while the competitor analysis can be seen as a micro and meso competitive analysis (strategic groups). n Another difference is that completely different facets of competition are studied. The competitor analysis involves analysis and prediction of the behavior and reactions of competitor A, B, and so on. To this end, the strengths and weaknesses of the competitors are mapped out, among other things. Industry analysis looks at the competitive forces in a market, for example, the distribution of power among suppliers or the bargaining power of suppliers. Porter’s (1980) five forces model (see Section 6.5.2) is often used for this. In this chapter, we discuss industry analysis. Chapter 7 is devoted to competitor analysis.

6.2 Purpose and structure of the industry analysis One of the parts of a industry analysis is looking at the market structure, for example: How big are the different providers? Is there a strong concentration of power? And are the products very similar or are there important differences in the eyes of the buyers?

Competitive analysis

Competitive analysis on macro level

Competitive analysis on micro and meso level

Intensity: Competition as a whole

The competitors: individual competitors

Industry analysis

Competitor analysis

Figure 6.1  Competitive analysis

160  Situation analysis

Although all such questions are interesting in their own right, one has to wonder what should be done with the answers to these questions. If no clear goal of the analysis is established, there is a danger that all sorts of things will be sorted out without a clear relationship to strategy formation. And that would mean that the ‘homework’ has been done for nothing.

6.2.1  Purpose of the industry analysis With regard to the industry analysis, two objectives are explicitly set. We want to gain insight into: 1 2

the attractiveness of the market industry opportunities and threats (such as from macro-environmental factors)

The market attractiveness conclusions are particularly important for formulating growth strategies and marketing objectives for the market for which the analysis is being performed. For example, the finding that a market is relatively attractive (for example, because of expected growth) leads to a decision to invest and to the formulation of ambitious growth targets sooner than in a market that is found to be unattractive (for example, saturated). This shows that an industry analysis has a strong relationship with a portfolio analysis (see Section 10.2). After all, the portfolio analysis also aims to determine the investments per product-market combination. Gaining insight into possible opportunities and threats is a logical part of the SWOT analysis (see Chapter 9). The opportunities and threats are compared to the strengths and weaknesses at a later stage so that the company can then formulate possible strategies.

6.2.2  Structure of the industry analysis An industry analysis examines all possible factors that influence market attractiveness. We can classify these factors as follows (originally taken from Lehmann & Winer, 2008): 1 Macro-environmental factors: factors from outside the market over which the various providers in a market have little or no influence but which do influence the market, for example, government decisions. 2 Aggregated market factors: factors related to market demand that directly determine the attractiveness of a market, such as market growth. 3 Industry structure factors: factors that determine the intensity of competition in a market, for example, the distribution of ‘power’ in a market: the concentration. We have summarized these factors in Figure 6.2. The combination of the three categories of factors listed in Figure 6.2 determines the attractiveness of a market. When analyzing it, the main thing is to identify changes over time and preferably to make a forecast.

Industry analysis 161

Macro-environmental factors n n n n n n

Demographic Economical Socio-cultural Technological Ecological Political-legal (government)

Market factors n Market size n Market growth and stage in product life cycle n Economic and seasonal sensitivity Industry structure factors n n n n n n

Profitability Threat of new entrants Bargaining power of buyers Negotiating power of suppliers Intensity of competition Threat of substitute products

Figure 6.2  Components of the industry analysis

6.3 Macro-environment analysis We include here among the macro-environmental variables the variables that are difficult or impossible to control for the company and the other providers in a market. In Figure 6.2, we have listed the categories of factors that can be distinguished, the so-called DESTEP factors: demographic, economic, socio-cultural, technological, ecological, and political-legal. In the context of an industry analysis, these factors are important because they: n affect all companies in an industry in most cases n have a direct influence on the market size and thus on the market attractiveness n can also affect other functional areas in a company, such as personnel and pro-

duction

With regard to the aforementioned classification of macro-environmental factors, we can also note that there can be a mutual influence between the various categories of factors. For example, political decisions about income distribution can lead to changes in economic factors. A socio-cultural development such as growing environmental awareness goes hand in hand with a stricter environmental policy and with technological developments aimed at more environmentally friendly products, for example.

162  Situation analysis

For each factor, the company must first determine what influence it has had in the past. For factors that can be quantified, such as economic and demographic developments, use can be made of causal models (see Section 13.10.3). The manager must then indicate what influence she expects to have in the future. For the latter, the macro-environmental factor itself must first be predicted. Various prediction methods can be used for this (see Section 9.1.2). For each category to be discussed (see Sections 6.3.1 to 6.3.6), we discuss content, data sources, and predictability. Finally, in Section 6.3.7, we provide some general points for attention in the macroenvironmental analysis.

6.3.1  Demographic factors Demography literally means description of the people. Demographic factors therefore concern characteristics of the population and, in particular, developments therein. This explicitly does not concern developments in a brand’s target group, for example, the number of beer drinkers. Such developments are part of the market factors. Examples of demographic factors are: n n n n n

the size of the population in a given area the age structure of the population the number and size of households the degree of urbanization of the population in a certain area the composition of the population

A well-known example of a demographic development in many modern countries is the aging of the population: an increase in the percentage of elderly people (see Case 6.1). This has negative consequences for companies that market products for babies, such as diapers. However, a positive influence exists for markets for the elderly, such as trips for older people and magazines aimed at the elderly. Other demographic developments in some countries include a decrease in population growth and decreasing household size. In most countries there are central statistical agencies that maintain detailed data, which is accessible online, regarding both past and predicted demographic developments. Although demographic developments are important issues for marketing, their effects appear gradually and in the long term.

6.3.2  Economic factors Economic factors are important to many companies because these variables influence the extent to which consumers are likely to purchase certain products. Examples of these variables are consumer purchasing power, consumer confidence, the price level (inflation), and energy prices. The government and politics (see subsequently) have a strong influence on economic developments.

Industry analysis 163

Case 6.1  Ageing

‘Brands should stop seeing age as a defining feature of the over-50s’ New research conducted by Gransnet and Mumsnet among 1,028 of their users finds 78% of those aged 50 or over feel under-represented or misrepresented by advertising. This is worse for technology brands, cited by 87% of those questioned, followed by fashion brands (84%) and the entertainment industry (79%). Nearly two-thirds (62%) believe they are ignored because advertisers are too young to understand the demographic, with 88% saying brands and agencies should employ more older people. Some 93% think advertisers need to start asking what over-50s want rather than assuming, while 92% want advertisers to acknowledge their spending power. This has consequences for brands. Almost half (49%) of those questioned say they actively avoid brands who ignore them, while 69% suggest that if advertising were more representative of their age group, they would be more receptive to the brand behind it. Gransnet editor Lara Crisp says: ‘If advertisers want to talk to the over-50s, who have more disposable income than any other age group, they need to start by listening to them. It’s just plain odd for marketers to assume that there’s an upper age-limit when it comes to having an interest in technology, fashion or blockbuster films’. Source: Marketing Week, 15 October 2018

164  Situation analysis

Case 6.2  Economic factors

The crises from 2022: consumer confidence hits rock bottom Energy crisis, housing shortages, staff shortages, nitrogen crises, angry farmers, political instability: the relief after the coronavirus quickly gave way to a less rosy feeling in some countries. If the economy had held up well during corona, a completely different perspective is expected after 2022. The fact is that energy prices have skyrocketed and consumers have to spend hundreds of euros more on energy. At the same time, (other) products and services have also become more expensive. It all doesn’t look good. Consumer confidence therefore fell to an all-time low in the summer of 2022. After 2022, a recovery was visible, so the long-term effects might be limited, but no one knows for sure. The influence of economic variables on market demand varies with the market. In general, due to their greater luxury character, consumer durables will be more sensitive to changes in economic developments than consumer non-durables. Although economic developments will often not have a significant impact on market demand for non-durable consumer goods, a shift in demand may occur. For example, an economic recession will have a favorable effect on cheaper brands, such as private label brands. Detailed information about economic developments in the past are available at national agencies that collect statistical data. In contrast to government-related factors, economic variables are normally fairly predictable in the not too distant future. The reason is that these are often long-term trends that do not change strongly at one point in time. However, corona in 2020 and the East European war that started in 2022 show that the economy can also change quite fast.

Industry analysis 165

6.3.3  Socio-cultural factors Social-cultural factors relate to issues such as people’s way of life, opinions, and standards and values in a society. They includes a large number of divergent developments, such as: n an increasing awareness of climate change n changes in media use (online) n social changes within the family household, such as: n marrying later in life n an increase in the role of women in the labor process n an increase in the role of men in the household n delay in having children n changes in the upbringing of children n the increase and revaluation of free time (work-life balance) n a growing focus on health (eating habits, sports) n a growth of subcultures

Clearly, these factors can have important marketing implications. The ‘S’ in DESTEP offers perhaps the best starting points for marketing. This creates new/growing markets for environmentally friendly products, leisure articles, quick meals, ‘healthy’ food, and so on. Socio-cultural trends are important not only in product development but also in communication; just look at online behavior. The implication of this is that it will not always be easy for a company to actually convert a certain socio-cultural development into an opportunity. Information about socio-cultural factors (past and future) is available online. Newspapers and magazines also often signal socio-cultural trends at an early stage. Furthermore, some (market) research agencies are explicitly involved in collecting information about living habits in the Netherlands. It appears that the corona pandemic has some consequences for people’s behavior and thus for socio-cultural trends (see Case 6.3).

6.3.4  Technological factors Technological developments can have far-reaching consequences. The most radical thing in recent years has undoubtedly been the arrival of computers and then the Internet, followed by the explosion of mobile phones, which has now become mobile online behavior in a broader sense. But less far-reaching developments, such as the introduction of dry soup, instant coffee, and compact washing powder, can also present important opportunities or threats. Technological developments are not only important from a marketing point of view. Technological developments are also important for other functional areas in the company, such as production, logistics, and information processing. In the context of marketing applications, it is often stated that a new technological invention (technological push) is only interesting if it is accompanied by sufficient interest from the market (market pull).

166  Situation analysis

Case 6.3  More from home after corona

Since the corona pandemic, people have been staying at home more often. We are still working at home more than twice as much as before the pandemic. We also order groceries, food, and clothing online more often. That may not seem like much, but a majority of workers cannot work from home. This is because they have a job on location, such as train conductor or construction worker. As a result, the number of hours for people who can work from home is a lot higher. In the long term, these home workers expect to go to the office a little more often. But in the end, most people say that they plan to work from home one or two days a week on a structural basis. Furthermore, after the pandemic, people also prefer to do other things at home than outside the home. For example, the number of people who (almost) never go away for a day has grown considerably. In addition, people shop online more often. Incidentally, people have all boarded the plane again after corona, so the lasting effects of corona seem to be mainly in things that consumers like. Such as working at home.

Technological developments have accelerated in recent years, which means that the life cycles of products are also decreasing: the time for the development of a new, better product is getting shorter and shorter. Partly because fundamental technological research usually costs a lot of money, it is increasingly important for companies to be the first to come up with a product. Only then will there be enough time and market potential left to recoup

Industry analysis 167

the development costs of the product. When a competitor is earlier, part of the market has already been anticipated and one does not have the important image of being ‘first’. In contrast with other macro-environmental factors, a company can partly influence technological developments by itself, for example, through a strong research and development program. Influencing the other macro-environmental factors is generally not possible. Information sources about technological developments are, for example, specialized sites or magazines.

6.3.5  Ecological factors This category of variables has become dominant in the last few years: virtually the entire world recognizes that climate change is a major threat and that the Earth is running out of resources. Fossil fuels, but also eating meat, for example, must be replaced. And there are many more consequences, including for transport, production of companies, including agriculture (nitrogen), and so on. The term ‘climate crisis’ is appropriate. A related development is the level of energy prices, which we consider an economic factor. Ecological issues also include the spread of (animal) diseases, such as swine flu, BSE (mad cow disease), and foot-and-mouth disease. With the worldwide corona epidemic since 2020, another ‘human disease’ has also been added (see also Case 6.3). These diseases obviously have a direct influence on people’s consumption habits, but they also indirectly lead to increased attention to health. Case 6.3 shows that corona has partly changed our consumer behavior.

6.3.6  Political-legal factors (government) Factors such as environmental policy, media policy, subsidy schemes, employment policy, monetary policy, and political developments abroad (war) can entail both direct and indirect threats or opportunities for a company. This influence can be limited but can also mean a ‘trend break’ in the development of a market. Two examples of ‘sudden’ shifts in the late 2010s are Trump’s election as US president, which led to (more) instability, and Britain’s decision to leave the European Union (Brexit, realized January 2020). The year 2022 gave some rest after corona but was quickly disrupted by the war in Ukraine. All of these events have a global impact. In some countries, legislative regulations are, of course, also important for companies themselves, such as those relating to smoking, ‘vaping’, (un)healthy eating, and gambling (Example 6.1).

6.3.7  Points of interest for macro-environmental factors The following points of attention should be central to the analysis of all the macro-environmental factors mentioned previously: n opportunity or threat n continuous analysis n forecasting and scenarios

168  Situation analysis

Example 6.1  More restrictive legislation needed

Advertising for gambling restricted After online gambling was declared legally free in the Netherlands in October 2021, gambling brands and advertisements sprang up like mushrooms. Many celebrities acted in humorous films with the message that you can easily get rich. According to researchers, this has contributed to a sharp increase in gambling and gambling addiction among young people, a serious matter. After the industry as a collective did not address this and therefore continued to opt for money, the rules for gambling advertising were tightened, like no famous athletes. But does this help enough? Pleas for a surcharge on the price of meat have not yet been implemented by the liberal government. It is not for nothing that Greenpeace is running a campaign in 2022 with the ultimate goal of a complete European ban on advertising and sponsorship for the fossil fuel industry. Maybe more regulation is a good idea after all. An obvious sources of information about government decisions is Google. As for the ability to predict government decisions: tricky.

Opportunity or threat The influence of an environmental factor on the company depends on the company’s ability to respond to a development, that is, on its own relative strengths and weaknesses. It cannot therefore be said a priori that a particular development constitutes an opportunity or a threat. For one company it can be an opportunity, for another a threat. In the

Industry analysis 169

latter case, a company can try to convert the threat into an opportunity: by deploying as many resources as possible, it can still try to respond to the development. For example, a publisher of youth magazines should not see dejuvenation and aging as a threat if they are able to market a magazine for the elderly. In the SWOT analysis, we define opportunities and threats from the situation of an unchanged policy of a company.

Continuous analysis Due to the great importance of responding to macro-environmental developments in a timely manner – and preferably first if possible – it is important to be constantly open to signals from the macro-environment that indicate that a new trend is starting. In this context we sometimes speak of environmental scanning: the continuous scanning of the environment. Particularly for larger companies, it may be advisable to entrust someone specifically with this task. Incidentally, the company must limit itself to relevant factors in environmental scanning. A complete macro-environmental analysis is impossible and unnecessary. In this context, Aaker (2013) argues that so-called information need areas must be designated: the most important factors in the external environment about which information must be collected continuously. A manager must identify these factors not only for macro-environmental analysis (e.g., demographic trend A, economic trend B, government factor C) but also for customer analysis (e.g., segments A and B) and competitor analysis (e.g., competitor A and potential competitor B).

Forecasting and scenarios Many macro-environmental developments are very difficult to predict. In practice, many predictions turn out not to come true or happen many years later – or earlier. Specialized agencies also regularly come up with new forecasts. In order to deal with this uncertainty in the planning process, it is possible to define scenarios around the most important factors. A scenario is a description of a possible environmental situation, for example, a disappointing economic climate or (for a beverage manufacturer) a total ban on advertising for alcoholic beverages. Incidentally, a scenario can also be defined with regard to the competition: for example, the competitor reacts or does not react. In practice, usually no more than two scenarios are defined: a pessimistic scenario and a most likely scenario. In addition to a pessimistic variant, one should also define an optimistic scenario. After all, it can be bad, but it can also be good. And if things go well, the planned strategy may also need to be adjusted. In practice, optimistic scenarios are often omitted out of caution. Defining a scenario is only meaningful if a manager also indicates how the company should respond in such a situation. To this end, an alternative plan can be described in an appendix to the marketing plan that corresponds, for example, to the pessimistic scenario. Such an alternative plan is called a contingency plan: it is accompanied by ‘standards’ (limiting values of variables) that indicate when such a plan becomes current. The most likely scenario then forms the basis for the marketing plan itself.

170  Situation analysis

All scenarios must be realistic. A pessimistic scenario is not the same as assuming that everything is against you. For example, it is extremely unlikely that, in addition to disappointing economic growth, the competitor will come up with new, better products while at the same time energy prices are rising sharply and the government is imposing important online restrictions. We have argued that macro-environmental factors can have a direct impact on total market demand. In Section 6.4, we discuss the aggregated market factors in more detail.

6.4 Aggregated market factors Section 6.3 discussed the various categories of macro-environmental factors: the DESTEP factors. We have stated that every organization should try to keep abreast of developments in these variables. Any possible change or trend can represent an opportunity or threat. Macro-environmental developments can have an important influence on the attractiveness of a market. This influence is largely via the total market demand. In this way we arrive at an analysis of the aggregated market factors. Aggregated market factors are variables defined around the total market demand (the primary demand or the size of the market). This involves the following variables: n The (potential) market size. n The (expected) market growth and (the stage in) the product life cycle. n Sensitivity to economic and seasonal trends.

6.4.1  Market size The size of the market is important first of all because larger markets are in themselves more attractive than small markets. After all, large markets offer more sales opportunities, making it easier to recover the costs of investments. In addition, a larger market offers more opportunities for segmentation (such as searching for niches). Larger markets also attract more competitors, which adversely affects attractiveness. Another reason for determining the market size is that it can indicate the significance of a certain market share. For example, a market share of 1% in the laundry detergents market generates a lot more turnover than the same market share in the liquid detergents market. The latter implies that it is important to clearly define a market: without an exact market definition, it is unclear what exactly the various analyses in the strategic marketing planning process relate to (see Chapter 3). In this regard, a manager may choose to define the market broadly or narrowly. In the first case, the market share will be relatively low and the number of competitors large. In the case of a narrow market definition, the reverse is true. This gives the impression that a manager can freely ‘manipulate’ market share by choosing a different market definition. That is, of course, not the case. The market is defined on the basis of strategic choices: which customer groups does the company serve, and who are its main competitors? The analysis of the market size also involves trends and market segments. For example, a total market can shrink, but if certain submarkets grow, a company can focus more on that.

Industry analysis 171

When analyzing the size of the market, the company must distinguish between: n the market served: the current market n the potential market: what would be the maximum feasible, for example, a 100%

distribution of the product and strong sales promotion

Determining the potential market requires the application of forecasting methods. Data on the total market demand for food is collected by agencies such as Nielsen, GfK, and IRI. For other markets, a manager can use data from, for example, trade associations.

6.4.2  Market and submarket growth and the product life cycle Market growth is also an important criterion for the attractiveness of a market. Within a market, the development of submarkets must also be considered. For example, a certain market (for example, the beer market) can stabilize or even decline, while certain submarkets (for example, non-alcoholic beer) can grow in the meantime. Market growth is so important that it has been included as the market characteristic in the Boston Consulting Group’s portfolio analysis (see Section 10.2.2). In addition to the current market growth, expected market growth is important. Thus, market growth predictions need to be made. In making forecasts, the concept of the product life cycle can be used. The phase in the life cycle in which the market finds itself partly determines the expected development in the future. Many products have a life cycle. After an introduction and a growth in sales, a stabilization follows and finally a decline. An important cause of such a cycle is that, over time, other, better products come onto the market, after which sales of the ‘old’ product start to decline. The life cycle of a product is usually visualized by means of a graph that shows the development of sales over time. It is often assumed that this curve is S-shaped and that four phases can be distinguished (see Figure 6.3): 1 2 3 4

In the introduction phase, sales are growing slowly: there are few consumers who know or use the product, and distribution is limited. In the growth phase, sales are growing faster and faster: the product is catching on, distribution is increasing, and more and more consumers are buying it. In the maturity phase, sales are still growing, but this growth is decreasing: there are not many ‘new’ consumers and later on sales are slowly declining. Finally, in the decline phase, sales will fall sharply. In this phase, the function of the product is taken over by other products.

The product life cycle concept can be applied to product groups, brands, or varieties. In this case we talk about the life cycle of a product group, for example, laptops. It is about a market as a whole. The implementation of the market instruments will then differ per phase. For example, in the growth phase of a market, brands will be able to grow by focusing on the market potential, while in the saturation phase, growth must be sought in taking sales away from competitors (increase in market share) or through innovation.

Annual Sales Volume

172  Situation analysis

I: Introduction

II: Growth

III: Maturity or Stabilization

IV: Decline

Time

Figure 6.3  Example of an S-shaped product life cycle curve

Brands and varieties can also have a life cycle, for example, Colgate toothpaste or Ariel Liquid. It is sometimes argued that in the introduction phase of a brand, the brand values to be communicated should mainly be instrumental, while in later phases the emphasis can be more on derivative, emotional properties. The strategic implications of the life cycle concept are not always clear. A market in the growth phase seems attractive but attracts competitors. It is not uncommon for the number of providers in growth markets to become too large in relation to the ultimate market size. This irrevocably leads to the downfall of some of them. A product in the maturity or saturation phase seems less attractive, but in these phases there may be segments that still show growth. By choosing the right segmentation strategy, growth of the sales of the own brand is still possible. The latter illustrates that one should not take the life cycle of a product (or brand) as given but that one can influence and extend this cycle oneself. By choosing a good marketing strategy, a product (or brand) in the saturation phase can still offer many opportunities to remain profitable or become profitable again.

6.4.3  Cyclical and seasonal sensitivity Markets in which sales are highly cyclical or seasonally sensitive are less attractive than markets in which this is not the case. After all, more uncertainty about sales and/or greater fluctuations means that a large degree of flexibility must exist in the company. Cycle sensitivity mainly occurs in luxury goods; these are often consumer durables. Sales fluctuations within a year due to seasonality (see Case 6.4) can occur for many products, such as beverages, travel, and sporting goods. A company that is active in several markets can try to reduce the uncertainty about total sales by making a well-considered choice of product-market combinations (portfolio decision).

6.5 Factors related to industry structure Factors related to industry structure determine the intensity of competition in a market. An analysis of the intensity of the competition is important because a market is less attractive to the extent that the competition is more intense. Strong competition leads to

Industry analysis 173

Case 6.4  Economic sensitivity

Traveling sensitivity to economy and news The travel sector stays very sensitive to bad news in countries. Clearly, traveling was physically impossible during the pandemic. But after that, it recovered quickly. Disasters in countries also strongly affect the image of a country and thus the interest of tourists. The sector is also dependent on the development of private consumption. A shortage of personnel is a challenge, as is the growth of tourism in areas where the quality of life is under pressure as a result. Consumers are increasingly opting for convenience and are willing to pay for a unique experience. Collecting data is important for tourism providers in order to use it to provide added value to your guests. increased marketing activity (promotional campaigns, high advertising efforts) and thus increases costs. As a result, the average profitability of companies is relatively low. Because the profitability of companies is ultimately central to the industry structure analysis, it is important to first gain more insight into profitability (Section 6.5.1). Subsequently, the factors influencing average profitability must be examined. To this end, the firm can use Porter’s (1980) industry model (Section 6.5.2).

6.5.1 Profitability In a market, there can be important differences between the profitability of the various brands. Moreover, there are usually large differences in profitability between markets. Factors that determine this are, for example, the production process, the cost structure,

174  Situation analysis

and the competition. In an industry structure analysis, it is important to obtain the best possible insight into the profitability. The variability of profitability is also important: the extent to which profitability fluctuates over time. The latter is an indication of the risks present in a particular market. In markets with relatively high fixed costs, a drop in demand leads to a greater drop in profit than in markets with relatively low fixed costs. In practice, it is not easy to gain insight into the average profitability in a market. It is true that companies publish data on costs and revenues in annual reports, but this data is never broken down into products and/or markets. The average profitability in a market must therefore often be estimated on the basis of impressions.

6.5.2  Industry structure according to Porter In his well-known book Competitive Strategy, Porter (1980) establishes a relationship between the industry structure and competitive strategies. He argues that five factors (competitive forces) influence the competitive structure in an industry (Figure 6.4). In Porter’s model, the central industry factor is the intensity of competition between existing suppliers in a market. The intensity of competition is determined by external and internal factors. We discuss these in the following.

External factors Figure 6.4 shows the external factors displayed. This concerns the threat of new competitors, such as: 1 2 3 4

the threat of new (potential) providers the threat of substitute products the bargaining power of suppliers the bargaining power of customers (distributors and final customers)

If these ‘threats’ are strong, the intensity of competition will be relatively strong and the average profitability of companies will be relatively low. The threat posed by each of these four factors depends on a number of underlying factors, which are discussed in the following.

Threat of potential entrants

Bargaining power of suppliers

Level of competition between companies/brands

Threat of substitute products

Figure 6.4  Forces affecting industry structure

Bargaining power of customers

Industry analysis 175

The threat from new providers is strong if: n the barriers to entry are low, for example, due to: n the absence of economies of scale n limited communication intensity n there is little product differentiation n there is easy access to the distribution channels

In many markets for consumer goods, there is indeed little (physical) product differentiation, but partly because of this, there are also intense communication efforts. A new product or brand can then only be successful if a corresponding communication budget is available. The latter also facilitates access to distribution channels: retailers prefer brands that are intensively promoted by the manufacturer. The threat of substitute products depends on the breadth of the market definition used in the analysis. If one assumes a narrow market definition, there are relatively many substitute products. The power of suppliers and/or buyers (distributors) is strong if: n their power is highly concentrated n they are not very price sensitive n there is little product differentiation (presence of alternatives)

In the food industry in some countries, buyers (retailers) have considerable power because of their concentration. As a result of various mergers and acquisitions, only a few purchasing combinations are responsible for a large part of the turnover in the food industry. In other countries, that power is much smaller. Especially in less developed grocery markets (for example, in southern Europe), there are many smaller distributors and therefore these buyers have less power. It is clear that for manufacturers, buyer power is an important factor. The increased concentration in some countries has led to the development of the account management system among manufacturers and a greater emphasis on collaboration with distributors. This demonstrates that in the context of Porter’s model, it is important to analyze the distribution structure. The market structure of the distribution chain determines the power of the distributor and thus the influence of this factor on market attractiveness. In addition to the power of distributors, the power of final customers (consumers) is also increasing as a result of the use of the internet. We mentioned earlier that social media can, among other things, be extremely fast word of mouth, so that one complaint can turn into a serious reputation crisis, especially if journalists pick it up.

Internal factors: the supply structure Apart from the external factors, the intensity of competition between existing suppliers in a market is determined by a number of underlying internal factors. These are factors that directly determine the supply structure of the market. These factors are not shown

176  Situation analysis

in Figure 6.4 but will be discussed in the following. First, we discuss four elements that determine the supply structure itself: the number of providers, the degree of product differentiation (together these two dimensions determine the market form), concentration, and collaboration. 1 2

3

The number of providers. A larger number of providers in principle leads to a greater degree of competition. Degree of product differentiation. This is the extent to which suppliers and products differ from one other. In this respect, competition is fiercer when, in the eyes of consumers, there are few differences between the products offered. With the ever-faster technological developments, products in many markets are increasingly similar. The degree of concentration of the suppliers. With a strong concentration, market agreements can be made more easily and competition will generally be less intense; this also applies if the number of competitors decreases. This relationship does not always apply. If a company merges with a competitor (which increases the concentration), the larger company can throw more resources into the (competitive) battle. The relationship between concentration and competition is therefore not unequivocal and depends, among other things, on the company performing the analysis. For example, in the event of a merger, competition will by definition decrease for the merging partners, while competition may increase for the remaining providers.

The degree of concentration can be read, for example, by calculating the collective market share (concentration ratio) of the largest two (CR2) or four companies (CR4) and analyzing it over time. An increasing concentration ratio indicates a more one-sided distribution of power within the market. Partly because of the importance of internationalization, concentration is increasing in various markets, for example, in banking, insurance, and aviation sectors. Concentration also plays a role in the healthcare sector, especially for health insurers, which still have a strong regional function. According to some, this somewhat hinders the functioning of the market. 4 Collaboration within a market. The existence of agreements or other forms of cooperation between competitors influences the organization of the market and therefore also the degree of competition. Figure 6.5 provides an overview of the possible market forms. Number of providers Homogeneity of the

A lot

Few

One

Homogeneous

Full competition

Homogeneous

Monopoly

Heterogeneous

Monopolistic

Heterogeneous

competition

oligopoly

products oligopoly

Figure 6.5  Market forms

Monopoly

Industry analysis 177

The dimensions mentioned previously constitute the supply structure of the market. In addition, several other elements have an influence on the competitive behavior of suppliers: n The development of the primary demand (market size). In a shrinking market,

growth in sales can only be achieved at the expense of competitors. Many markets are saturated, so this factor generally causes strong competition. n The strategic effort of companies. If a company carries out its main activity in a certain industry, it will be more competitive than a company that only carries out secondary activities in the same industry. n The exit barriers. This refers to all factors that make it difficult for companies to exit loss-making activities: the higher the exit barriers, the longer companies continue with loss-making activities and the fiercer the competition. Exit barriers can be: n social factors: the legal procedures for collective redundancies and the resistance of workers at risk of losing their job are very important barriers to exit n highly specialized assets: the liquidation value of a highly specialized machine is often considerably lower than its value in use n the connection of a certain product with other products, for example, due to the joint use of fixed means of production (buildings, machines, etc.), the desire to carry a complete range, or because of the company’s image (withdrawing a product from the market will affect the share price negatively) n emotional factors, such as attachment to a product For a company considering entering a market, one of the factors deserves special attention: entrance barriers. An analysis of entrance barriers is not only important to be able to determine the threat of potential suppliers but also to be able to determine which obstacles you have to overcome yourself in order to be able to enter a market. For a company considering entering a market, high barriers to entry are obviously a negative factor. In contrast, for companies that are already active in a market, high barriers to entry are a positive factor because they limit the threat of new entrants.

6.6 Determination of the market attractiveness Conducting an industry analysis has the following goals: n obtain insight into opportunities and threats from the perspective of the industry n obtain insight into the attractiveness of the market

To summarize an industry analysis, first the identified opportunities and threats are listed. Once a manager has examined the attractiveness of the market through the factors listed in Figure 6.1, it may be difficult to reach summary conclusions. After all, what is the conclusion if some factors are valued positively and others negatively? This problem is solved using the assumption that a high score on one factor can compensate for a low score on another. With this assumption, a summary ‘score’ can then be calculated using a weighted factor scoring method.

178  Situation analysis

Suppose an ice cream manufacturer is considering producing candy bars. In order to investigate the attractiveness of the candy bar market, the manufacturer studies the factors listed in Figure 6.6. Management gives a score for each factor on a scale of 1 (very unattractive) to 5 (very attractive). In the example, there is a large market. This leads to a score of 5 on the market size factor. On the other hand, there is also fierce competition. This factor is therefore given a score of 1. Subsequently, a weight is assigned to each factor on the basis of the importance (as estimated by management) of the factor for the attractiveness of the relevant market. Because different success-determining factors exist in different markets, this weighting can differ per market. The weighting also depends on how important the management itself considers a factor. For example, one company may find growth important, while the other considers profitability the most important. In this example, the market growth factor is considered the most important (weight 0.20). When all scores are multiplied by the weighting factors and added together, an attractiveness score of 2.95 is obtained. The next issue is how this score should be interpreted. Is 2.95 high or low? The interpretation depends, among other things, on whether the company performing the analysis is active in the relevant market. A company that is already active in the market could compare its results with a previous period. This answers the question of whether the market is becoming more or less attractive and why. A potential entrant could compare the results with another market, for example, the sandwich spread market: the market with the highest score is the most attractive for entry. In addition, the potential entrant must weigh the score against the height of the barriers to entry: what problems must be overcome to enter the market? Another market with a lower attractiveness score but also with lower barriers to entry may be preferable. After all, barriers to entry can be seen as the ‘price’ that must be paid to enter a particular market. Obviously, the factor scoring method described here is subjective. The biggest challenge is determining the weights for the individual factors. Moreover, it is assumed that a

Factor

Weight

Assessment

Score*

Value

Market size

0.15

Big

5

0.75

Market growth/product life cycle stage

0.20

Saturated

2

0.40

Seasonal and cyclical sensitivity

0.05

Limited

4

0.20

Margin of profit

0.15

Rather high

4

0.60

Threat of new entrants

0.05

Limited

5

0.25

Bargaining power of buyers

0.10

Strong

2

0.20

Negotiating power of suppliers

0.05

Limited

4

0.20

Intensity of competition

0.20

Very violent

1

0.20

Threat of substitute products

0.05

Pretty strong

3

0.15

Total

1.0

Aggregate market factors

Industry structure factors

2.95

Figure 6.6  Example of calculating the attractiveness score of the candy bar market (1 = unattractive; 5 = very attractive)

Industry analysis 179

low score on one factor can be compensated by a high score on another factor. However, it is not unthinkable that a company require minimum values for certain factors, for example, a minimum required market growth. An important advantage of applying the factor scoring method in the industry analysis is that the results of the entire analysis are clearly summarized. A systematically conducted and clearly presented industry analysis is of great importance not only for the benefit of our own analyses but also for internal communication within the company. The example also shows that, compared to Figure 6.1, the macro-environmental factors have not been included in Figure 6.3. This is because they are factored into the assessment of market attractiveness through their impact on market size and growth. Finally, we note that the way in which the industry analysis is summarized in Figure 6.3 allows for a direct link to the portfolio analyses in which several factors are taken into account (see Section 10.2). In the context of such ‘multifactor portfolio analyses’, analyses such as those in Figure 6.3 are very common. The DESTEP analysis and Porter’s model are very popular. These models are used in many theses at universities of applied sciences, for example, and sometimes it is even mandatory to use them. But we close this chapter with an important caveat. An industry analysis is by definition at an aggregated level and provides general insights into market attractiveness and long-term developments therein (including via DESTEP). From a marketing perspective, this is of limited value. The DESTEP factors are usually long-term trends that many others also see coming and therefore offer little chance of gaining a competitive advantage. Porter’s model shows the general competition but says nothing about specific competitors that you have to deal with as a manager. Most relevant in the industry analysis appear to be the market developments themselves and also those in submarkets. More or less, the whole industry analysis is interesting as background in a marketing plan, but the depth should come from customer and competitor analysis. And making any model compulsory is of course never a good idea: every research method and model should fit the research question. It is difficult to screw in screws with a hammer.

Summary The purpose of an industry analysis is to gain an impression of opportunities and threats from the industry and of (changes in) the attractiveness of the market and submarkets in which the organization operates. The attractiveness or expected profitability of a market is determined by the intensity of competition. The harder the fighting, the less attractive the market. The degree of competition, in turn, is determined by three categories of factors: macro-environmental developments (such as environmental and socio-cultural trends), aggregate market factors (such as market and submarket growth), and industry structure factors (such as retailer power). The macro-environmental analysis is an important source of opportunities. A company that can respond quickly to a socio-cultural development, for example, can gain a competitive advantage. As a result of various trends (such as climate change, online growth, political instability), important shifts in future consumption and information behavior can be expected. Given the large future uncertainties, a manager may choose to define scenarios around the most important trends.

180  Situation analysis

The attractiveness of a market must be determined by making an assessment of the main underlying factors and calculating an attractiveness score based on this assessment. By weighting each of the examined factors and adding up the different values, one gets an attractiveness score that can be compared to the scores of other markets or to the score in a previous period. This information is especially important for determining the objectives and investment level of the organization in the relevant market (see Chapter 10). Information about opportunities and threats is also important for the marketing strategy. However, a more in-depth customer analysis and competitor analysis should be added.

Industry analysis 181

Aviation in trouble

Flying has become so cheap that it has changed our daily lives. Five days of work on a job in Poland, a bachelor party in Riga, or monthly up and down to the second house in Spain for a family from London: it’s all possible. Yet the future doesn’t look that bright for many airlines. The COVID pandemic changed everything for the airlines, and the outlook for aviation has not improved since then. Cut-throat competition continuously keeps airline ticket prices low, and increasing environmental awareness might impact our travel behavior, while fuel prices are rising due to the uncertain political situation and the war in Ukraine.

Flying was the future While airline ticket prices were going down continuously, the number of air passengers worldwide doubled between 2000 and 2010 to a total of 2.5 billion annually in 2010. The growth in passengers leveled off after that, but until the COVID pandemic in 2020, it was still growing in Europe at about 5% per year. However, a clear shift could be seen: ‘traditional’ airlines became less relevant and the lowcost airlines started taking the lead. The increase in passenger numbers was caused by a number of factors. Due to the low cost of flight tickets, flying became so cheap that people went to their holiday destinations by plane when they would otherwise have taken the car or train. However, the increase was not exclusively based on choosing another means of transport; low-cost carriers also expanded the market. Bachelor parties in

182  Situation analysis

Latvia, a weekend in Ibiza, or shopping in Barcelona: without the low-cost carrier, this simply would never have existed. Flying became a commodity and mobility part of our lifestyle. We accepted the fact that flying is also very polluting. Globalization, the emerging economies in Asia and South America, and European unification also contributed to increased mobility. Not only tourists were moving further and further away, business travelers also had more and more international contacts. And what about all those international students within Europe? Student exchanges created international friendships, and to maintain that, of course, one had to travel. The rise of social networking reinforced this: all those international friends on Facebook really had to be visited, if only to be tagged in even more photos.

The trend reversed And then COVID showed up. Much of Europe entered lockdown. Tourism became an illusion; business travel was replaced by Zoom and Microsoft Teams. Planes remained grounded, and aviation came to a standstill. For example, in the months of April and May 2020, there were only 700,000 air passengers in Britain, compared to more than 30 million in those two months the year before. Only freight transport increased, due to the sharp increase in online shopping during the lockdown period. One would expect aviation to quickly return to its old level after the pandemic, and perhaps even more, with people wanting to make up for their missed holiday trips. However, this turned out not to be the case. When European countries started to relax COVID regulations, tourism initially indeed quickly took off again. Airliner’s profitable business classes, however, turned out to be much more difficult to fill: online meetings had become an excellent alternative to the expensive business trip. This shift was permanent: after the coronavirus pandemic, the number of business trips would never return to their former levels. When corona finally disappeared from Europe, the sky seemed to clear for tourists. But then chaos at European airports appeared: long queues at all major airports in Europe. The reason: staff shortages. During the COVID crisis, tens of thousands of employees were laid off in the aviation sector: personnel who cannot simply be brought back. In addition, many airline employees were dissatisfied with the working conditions and the increased workload, resulting in strikes, which meant that flights had to be canceled again and travelers had to wait even longer to get their passports checked. As a result, there were 373 million air passengers in the EU in 2021. This was an increase of 35% compared to 2020 but still well below the more than 1 billion passengers in the pre-COVID year 2019.

Industry analysis 183

Improvement was in the air for 2022, but the Russian invasion of Ukraine created new uncertainties such as rapidly rising fuel prices, which initially made flying a lot more expensive, and then impacted overall purchasing power. Tourism is a luxury when a possible recession is looming and many people are struggling to pay their energy bills. And with all that, global warming was becoming more and more a fact of life. The train to London has only 10% of the CO2 emissions per passenger kilometer compared to the same journey by plane, and more and more people became aware of this. Even so, sustainability may be considered important by everyone these days, but that does not mean that we will immediately adjust our transportation behavior. Alternatives for flying are not always available either. After all, going on holiday by car is even more polluting, and the train is often hardly an alternative: Europe is hopelessly behind in terms of trains. A continental train journey can cost days, and hundreds of euros, due to differences in equipment and regulations. Despite a success like the Eurostar connection between London and Paris, a European network of high-speed trains connecting capitals is still a long way off. Nevertheless, opportunities for the train seem to arise. The European Union declared 2021 the European Year of Rail, and in time this may lead to new investments in railroad connections. In the meantime, the aviation industry is also aiming for more sustainability. With sustainable aviation fuel, flying on hydrogen, or electric flying on future generations of rechargeable mega-batteries, the aircraft of the future can become more sustainable. For now, however, this is still far away.

Low-cost carriers Revenues and margins were already under pressure in aviation before the COVID pandemic. For example, Air France-KLM saw passenger numbers rise by 2.8% to 101 million passengers in 2018, but profitability remained limited. Other national airlines did not perform much better. However, this was in stark contrast to the results of low-cost carriers. Ryanair, the European market leader for cheap flights, realized a profit of around 900 million euros in 2018, and the number of Ryanair passengers increased by 9% to more than 140 million. Low-cost carriers such as Ryanair are also referred to as no-frills airlines. In Europe, they have emerged since the liberalization of the European aviation sector in the 1990s. Since April 1, 1997, airlines have been allowed to operate flights to and from any airport in Europe, regardless of the country in which they are established. The Irish Ryanair, the first low-cost carrier in Europe (founded in 1988), has grown since that date from 3 million passengers to 117 million in 2016. The low-cost model was replicated all over the world. The strategy is aimed at getting the plane as full as possible; after all, the airline doesn’t earn anything from an empty plane seat. Extremely low prices well before the date of the flight ensure a

184  Situation analysis

high occupancy rate, and rapidly rising prices in the days before departure should bring in profit. Low-cost carriers also aim to remove as many frills as possible. Regional airports, with much lower take-off and landing fees, are their base of operations. There are no free drinks and meals, and luggage has to be paid extra. The efficiency of low-cost carriers is apparent from the following overview, which shows the number of passengers per employee (total number of passengers divided by the total number of employees of the company): Number of passengers per employee (based on annual reports from the airlines) Ryanair

9,451

EasyJet

6,772

British Airways

  735

Air France\KLM

  715

Lufthansa

  624

An increasing share of the European aviation industry is now in the hands of low-cost airlines. Ryanair is again the largest of these. In the pre-COVID years, national airlines had a much more difficult time than low-cost carriers, and they even started experimenting themselves with low-cost carriers. Air France-KLM’s low-cost brand Transavia is an example. Of course, COVID did not leave the no-frills airlines untouched. However, the following charts show that the low-cost carriers such as Ryanair initially recovered quicker than the national airlines (such as Lufthansa):

Lufthansa: number of passengers (in millions) 160 140 120 100 80 60 40 20 0

2012

2013

2014

2015

2016

2017

2018

2019

2020

2021

Industry analysis 185

Ryanair: number of passengers (in millions) 160 140 120 100 80 60 40 20 0

2012

2013

2014

2015

2016

2017

2018

2019

2020

2021

The question is, of course, what will happen to European aviation in the future? Will the industry survive this crisis? And will low-cost carriers continue to outperform national airlines in the years to come, just as before?

Questions 1 2 3 4 5

6

7

Which strategic groups can be distinguished in the European airline industry? Make a macro-environment analysis of the European airline industry based on the information in this case. The Brand Benefitting Model distinguishes a number of strategies to generate benefits for the customer. Which of these strategies has been chosen by Ryanair? Explain your answer. In what stage of the product life cycle is the airline industry? Explain your answer. a Do you feel that the aviation industry is sensitive to economic fluctuations? Why (not)? b Do you consider the aviation industry sensitive to seasonal trends? Why (not)? a Determine the attractiveness of the aviation industry, from the point of view of Ryanair, by using Porter’s five-forces model. b To what extent does this differ from the attractiveness from the viewpoint of AirFrance-KLM? Give your own opinion: a What is the future of the European airline industry? b Who will be most successful in this future: the ‘traditional’ airlines or the low-cost carriers? Explain your answer

Chapter 7

Competitor analysis

Phase 1 Analysis Mission, customer value and market definition (3)

External analysis

Internal analysis

Customer analysis (5) Industry analysis (6)

Internal analysis (4)

Competitor analysis (7) Analysis of distribution and suppliers (8)

SWOT (9) Phase 2 Strategy Corporate objectives and strategy (10)

Marketing objectives and strategy (11)

Phase 3 Tactics Product, Price, Place (12); Promotion (13)

DOI: 10.4324/9781003381488-9

Organization of marketing and Personnel (14)

COMPETITOR ANALYSIS 187

Key points in this chapter n Know the steps of a competitor analysis. n Be able to identify competitors by using the appropriate methods. n Assess competitors’ strengths and weaknesses on the corporate and brand

levels.

n Know which qualitative and quantitative data sources can be used in a competitor

analysis.

n Put it all together in making a forecast of a competitor’s strategy and reactions.

Introduction A competitor analysis can be thought of as a competition analysis at the micro level: The behavior of individual competitors is analyzed with the ultimate goal of predicting the competitors’ actions and reactions. It is important to maintain a clear structure in a competitor analysis. Without structuring, the problem may arise, as it often does in practice, that large amounts of data are collected about competitors without deducing the relevant information from the data. Section 7.1 describes the goal and structure of a competitor analysis. The first phase in a competitor analysis is identification of the competitors. Section 7.2 discusses the methods that may be useful in that process. Sections 7.3 through 7.6 outline the other phases of the competitor analysis. Section 7.7 reviews a number of data sources that may be used.

7.1 Goal and structure of the competitor analysis 7.1.1 Goal A competitor analysis looks at individual competitors. A competitor analysis can therefore be regarded as a micro-level competitive analysis. Opportunities that the company can expect should mainly be sought in the weaknesses of the competitors. These offer starting points for our own competitive advantages. The extent to which competitors pose a threat to one’s own company depends on their objectives and strategies. Comparatively less danger can be expected from a competitor who is satisfied with his position and has no new plans. However, a competitor that wants to grow and enters into an active competition with, for example, new products and high advertising efforts, poses a major threat to one’s own company. Therefore, the objectives of a competitor analysis are: 1 2

gain insight into the strengths and weaknesses of competitors gain insight into the future behavior (the expected strategies) of competitors

188  SITUATION ANALYSIS

Competitors’ strengths and weaknesses are compared to one’s own strengths and weaknesses; this provides insight into the extent to which the brand is strong or weak in relation to its competitors. An own strong point has little strategic value if competitors also have that strong point. On the other hand, a weakness is less serious if all competitors have the same weakness. It is therefore about determining what the own relative strengths and weaknesses are. Understanding the expected behavior of competitors provides indications of opportunities and threats posed by those competitors. Incidentally, with regard to the future behavior of competitors, a distinction can be made between: n the expected ‘autonomous’ behavior of the competitors: what they intend on their own n possible reactions of competitors to strategies of their own organization

7.1.2  Structure of the competitor analysis When conducting a competitor analysis, the company can choose two angles: a rival approach and a partner approach. 1 2

A manager may regard competitors as rivals: other suppliers who compete for the favor of customers and who therefore have to be ‘fought out’. Competitors can also be considered possible cooperation partners. Collaboration can go so far as to involve a merger or acquisition.

For the practice of competitor analysis, this means that it should not only be aimed at looking for weaknesses in the opponent (in order to gain a competitive advantage yourself) but also at looking for starting points for cooperation. An opportunity arises when the competitor has an interesting strength in which its own company is weak and vice versa. Example 7.1 is an example of a merger of two former competitors. Five phases can be distinguished in a competitor analysis (see Figure 7.1): 1 2 3 4 5

identification and choice of competitors (Section 7.2) competitors’ objectives (Section 7.3) current competitor strategies (Section 7.4) identification of the success determinants and strengths and weaknesses of competitors (Section 7.5) expected competitor strategies (Section 7.6)

Of the aforementioned phases, 4 and 5 provide the information we listed under the objectives of the competitor analysis: strengths and weaknesses, future behavior. Already we notice that the first four phases require a systematic and creative approach, while the last step (strategy prediction) above all requires important empathy with the ‘psychology of the competitor’.

COMPETITOR ANALYSIS 189

Example 7.1 Huge merger at holiday parks

They announced it halfway through 2021, and at the end of 2022 it also seems to be coming around with the Authority for Consumers and Markets: the takeover of Landal Green Parks by Roompot. These two major providers of holiday parks want to join forces in order to gain an even stronger market position in Europe. Roompot is mainly active in Central and Southern Europe and Landal in Northern Europe, so the combination complements each other well. The investment company that owns Roompot sees opportunities to achieve a higher return. Whether Landal’s beloved mascot Bolle and Koos Konijn from Roompot will both continue to exist is not yet certain. Source: NRC, 18 June 2021, and www.parkvakanties.nl, consulted 13 October 2022

7.2 Identification and selection of competitors A definition of what a competitor actually is can be: another provider that potentially meets the same needs of the target group. Based on this definition, the question of who the competitors are therefore depends on the definition of the need. The latter is related to the market definition. For example, do the top management of Coca-Cola think they are active in the ‘colas’ market or in the soft drinks market? Or even on the stimulant market? We will discuss in turn: n n

levels of competition (Section 7.2.1) methods to identify competitors (Section 7.2.2)

190  SITUATION ANALYSIS

Market definition

Customer analysis

Internal analysis

1. Identification and choice of competitors

2. Determining objectives of each chosen competitor

3. Determining current strategy of each chosen competitor

4. Identification of key success factors, scores of competitors and ‘own’ relative strengths and weaknesses

5. Predicting future behaviour of each chosen competitor = step in competitor analysis = other part of situation analysis

Figure 7.1  Structure of a competitor analysis

n the choice of identification method (Section 7.2.3) n the choice of which competitors are most important to the company (Section 7.2.4)

7.2.1  Competition levels With regard to competition, we can distinguish four levels of competition: 1 2 3 4

Product form competition: competition between brands targeting the same market segment, such as Pepsi Light versus Coke Light. Product category competition: competition between products with similar properties, such as different soft drinks. Generic competition: products that meet the same consumer needs, such as beverages. Budget competition: competition for consumer money, such as food and entertainment.

Figure 7.2 contains some other examples of competition at these four levels. As one moves from product form to budget competition, the market definition becomes broader, and, as a result, the number of competitors increases. There is thus a direct interplay between the definition of the market and the identification of the competitors. As a result, there is also a relationship with marketing decisions: different product characteristics must be emphasized at the different levels of competition. If the manufacturer of low-priced TVs from Figure 7.1 chooses the product form level, then the

COMPETITOR ANALYSIS 191

Competition level

Low alcohol beer

Low-priced TV

Chinese restaurant

1 Product form

Low alcohol/non-

Low-priced TV

Chinese restaurants

alcoholic beer 2 Product category

Beer

TVs

Restaurants

3 Generic

Drinks

Equipment

Restaurants, eating at home

4 Budget

Drinks, food,

Durable goods,

Food, drink,

entertainment

vacations

entertainment

Figure 7.2  Examples of competition levels

competitors are other low-priced TVs, and he must emphasize why his TV is so much better than the other cheap TVs. If the manufacturer starts from the product category level, then he must position himself in relation to all other TV brands, for example, with the price. At the generic level, he must point out to the consumer the advantages of a TV over a computer, for example. At the budget level, he could communicate why a TV is so much more interesting than other leisure activities. The choice of the level of competition is therefore clearly related to the market definition. The market definition in turn is determined by, among other things, two related factors: n The planning level in the company: corporate, business unit, or product level n The planning term: are these short-term plans (one year or less) or longer-term plans?

We show the relationship between this and the other in Figure 7.3.

Corporate level

Business unit level

Product level

Long term

Long and short term

Short term

Broad market definition

Narrow market definition

Narrow market definition

Generic and budget competition

Product category competition

Product category and product form competition

Figure 7.3  The relationship between corporate level, planning term, market definition, and level of competition

192  SITUATION ANALYSIS

As the level of aggregation in the company increases, the planning time generally becomes longer, the market definition broader, and the level of competition higher. For example, matters such as cooperation with potential partners play a role at the company level. This is a long-term matter that requires a broad market definition and therefore a high level of competition. After all, potential partners do not only have to be active in their own direct market but can also be active in adjacent markets. On the other hand, annual short-term planning is important at product level; this includes the day-to-day threat of directly competing products/brands (product category competition and product form competition).

7.2.2  Methods to identify competitors The methods that can be used in the identification of competitors fall into: 1 2

competition-oriented methods customer-oriented methods

1  Competition-oriented methods In general, it can be said that the competition-oriented methods are especially suitable for determining competition at the firm level, while the buyer-oriented methods are suitable for identifying competing products. A competitive orientation means that one identifies the competition oneself on the basis of information about the competitors, for example, by checking which competitors follow a similar strategy to one’s own company.

2  Customer-oriented methods Customer-oriented (customer-based) methods use data on the demand side of the market: the competition is analyzed from the point of view of the customers. For example, customers can be asked which product/brand they would buy if the preferred product/brand were not available. We first discuss two competition-oriented methods and then three customer-oriented methods. In Section 7.3, we briefly consider the advantages and disadvantages of both categories of methods.

Competition-oriented methods We can distinguish the following two competition-oriented methods: 1 2

management judgement strategic groups

1  Management judgment Based on her experience and market knowledge, a manager can sometimes reasonably estimate what the current and future competitors are (management judgement). If neces-

COMPETITOR ANALYSIS 193

sary, she can consult representatives, retailers or other internal experts. A tool she can use for this is to classify the competitors into companies and: n whether or not to market the same products n whether or not to serve the same customers (markets or segments)

The most direct competitors are companies that supply the same products to the same markets. More indirect competitors are companies with the same products that focus on a different market. Companies that serve the same market with different products can be seen as potential competitors.

2  Strategic groups The second competition-oriented method involves dividing the suppliers in a market into strategic groups. A strategic group is a group of companies pursuing similar strategies. Insight into how these groups are composed can be obtained by examining which strategies the providers choose in a market, such as by looking at the choice of the target group and the positioning and the implementation of the market instruments: product quality, assortment, pricing, distribution spread, deployment of representatives, and the communication mix. In addition, the strategies with regard to other functional areas are also important, for example, the extent of R&D, production, purchasing, and finance. Example 7.2 contains an example of strategic groups in the Dutch banking market. The concept of strategic groups simplifies competitive identification and choice, as it were. After all, competition will be strongest, especially within strategic groups. With a large number of competitors, the competitor analysis can then emphasize one’s own strategic group. The other strategic groups can be analyzed as a whole. In practice, sometimes all (or groups of) ‘small competitors’ are defined as a strategic group, assuming that they apply more or less similar strategies (which is often not the case).

Customer-oriented methods We distinguish three customer-oriented methods: 1 2 3

direct identification research on customers brand changes positioning research

1  Direct identification research on customers The most direct and simple method of identifying competition through buyers is to ask directly about competitors, for example, by asking questions such as: ‘What other comparable products do you know?’ or ‘Which products have you also considered buying?’ A researcher gains insight into the most direct competitor by asking, for example: ‘Suppose your preferred brand were no longer available; which brand would you buy?’ A disadvantage of such questions is that it is uncertain to what extent the opinion

194  SITUATION ANALYSIS

Example 7.2 Strategic group in the banking market: the ‘neobanks’

They are small, new, and what’s more: digital. They promise a revolution in the banking world, with all their new services – for which you pay a little extra – and also by being more customer friendly. They do what the customer wants and not what a product can offer. Banks traditionally did it the other way around. The ‘neobanks’, such as Bunq and Knab, are doing their utmost to capture market share. Two problems. First, the big banks can imitate their trick. For example, the idea of an app to easily transfer money came from Bunq, but when ABN AMRO copied and distributed it a little later through its large network, the ‘Tikkie app’ took off. Second, it is still not possible in the Netherlands to transfer your bank account number to a new provider. ‘Consumer organizations should take this up’, says Bunq founder Ali Nikham. Source: NRC, 16 November 2019

of the interviewee reflects their own behavior. The great simplicity of this method is an important advantage. A variant of the direct question is to make a link with product use. Approaches via product use associations ask users of the product to name all use cases or applications. They are then asked to name suitable products for each application. Other product users are then asked to indicate how suitable each product is for each usage situation. Finally, the products can be clustered based on the equality of suitable applications. An advantage of this method is that it provides insight into less direct forms of competition, such as generic competition.

COMPETITOR ANALYSIS 195

2  Brand changes A more advanced customer-oriented identification method uses data on the extent to which customers switch between brands (brand-switching data). The advantage of this is that behavioral data is used. This data is usually collected through household panels. But online data can also be used when click and purchase behavior is analyzed per consumer.

3  Positioning investigation Chapter 5 describes methods for mapping brand images. If this is done for different brands, it is possible to see which brands are ‘close to each other’. The underlying distances can even be calculated exactly if the correct methods are used.

7.2.3  Selection of the identification method In practice, competition-oriented methods are mainly used. This is also the simplest: one forms an opinion based on one’s own market knowledge and does not have to carry out additional fieldwork. However, competition-oriented methods have an important drawback: the question is whether what people think about the competitors actually corresponds with the perception of the customers. There is a risk that certain companies will be labeled competitors who are not actually perceived as such by customers, and vice versa. This danger is not present if one chooses a customer orientation when identifying the competition. However, a customer orientation does have a number of limitations: n First, it is difficult to gain insight into potential competitors and indirect competi-

tors. For example, customers only know the existing products; they are not aware of competitors who have not yet entered the market. n A second limitation is that buyer-oriented methods usually have to be implemented at the brand/product level. Customers often do not know the suppliers of products. Both limitations imply that buyer-oriented methods are particularly suitable for shortterm planning. After all, in the short term, it is unlikely that new competitors will enter, and the analyses can therefore be limited to the product-brand level. However, for longer-term planning, one must also look at the company level and at possible potential competitors. The competition-oriented methods are especially suitable for this. We therefore conclude that it is advisable to choose both a customer and a competitive orientation when identifying competitors. In this way one puts into practice what Kotler (1984) so aptly formulated many years ago: ‘learn how your customers view your competitors rather then how you view your competitors’.

7.2.4  Choosing the competitors Once the competitors have been identified using the previous methods, the next question is whether a detailed behavioral analysis of all possible competitors should be carried

196  SITUATION ANALYSIS

out. In practice, this is not necessary and, moreover, generally unfeasible – let alone that a separate behavioral analysis can also be carried out of all possible potential competitors. Within the chosen market, the manager must make a choice of the competitors to receive the most attention. But who is most important? The biggest or the one most like us? And who will be important in the future? Because these questions will in principle be answered in the follow-up analysis, it seems impossible to make a choice in advance. A solution to this chicken-and-egg problem is to first perform a global competitor analysis and then take a closer look at a few competitors. Two factors play an important role in the initial selection of competitors: market share and similarity to one’s own product/company. It seems logical to always consider the largest competitors in terms of size, as well as those competitors that have similar products or target the same target group.

7.3 Objectives of competitors In the second phase of competitor analysis, the company attempts to derive the objectives of its main competitors. This actually involves two aspects: 1 2

What does the competitor want? How badly does she want that?

The first aspect relates to the competitor’s growth direction: does the competitor want to maintain or increase market share? And if the latter is the case, does the competitor want to grow with the help of existing or new products and with existing or new customers? The second aspect is determined by the commitment of the competitor: the extent to which she feels involved in the product/market. Both aspects together determine the commitment and aggressiveness with which a competitor is active in a market. The greatest threat can be expected from a competitor that feels very involved in a market and wants to grow in that market. But a competitor that ‘just’ wants to keep its market share, but wants it very badly, also represents an important threat (see example 7.3). Indications of what the competitor wants can be obtained in the following ways: n By comparing the competitor’s objectives with current results. A difference between,

for example, desired and realized market share leads to an expected growth strategy.

n By applying a portfolio analysis for the competitor. Assuming that the competitor

also applies a portfolio analysis itself, one can derive the most logical portfolio decision (investments and growth direction) on the basis of its own analysis of the position of the SBUs and products in a portfolio model. n By determining how important a product is to the competitor. This can be measured in, for example, turnover, profit, or number of employees. n By studying the competitor’s market instruments over time. For example, a price reduction and an increase in advertising spending may indicate that the competitor is pursuing growth, which could pose a threat to its own product. On the other hand, minimizing marketing efforts could indicate a harvest strategy, that is, obtaining as much profit as possible. Less danger can usually be expected from such a competitor in the long term.

COMPETITOR ANALYSIS 197

Example 7.3  Apple and Samsung in fierce battle

In industries where technology is important, such as in the computer or mobile phone market, innovations are an important means of maintaining a competitive advantage. After all, large investments in research and development are often preceded. If a competitor can claim an innovation, it is very disadvantageous. The battle between companies like Apple and Samsung in the smartphone market is therefore fierce. Samsung attacks the competitor directly. For example, a commercial for the latest Samsung is introduced on purpose before the iPhone 14 comes on the market, and the voice-over literally says that ‘the latest innovation does not come from an iPhone, but is already there, with the Samsung Flip Over’. Source: www.imore.com

7.4 Current strategies of competitors A company that wants to be able to indicate what strategy it expects from a competitor must first investigate what the competitor’s current strategy is. This includes: n the marketing strategy: choice of target group (segments) and chosen positioning n the handling of market instruments

Insight into the marketing strategy is obtained through observation and analysis of the market instruments. You then first look at the market instruments of the competitors and derive the marketing strategy from this by asking yourself what the core message of the brand actually is. Insight into the competitive advantage that a competitor is seeking is provided, for example, by its advertising and all other offline and online communications. One can almost certainly assume that every company will communicate its (perceived) strength to its customers. A detailed analysis of the content of the competitor’s communication is therefore of great importance.

198  SITUATION ANALYSIS

You can gain insight into the target group targeted by the competitor through market research (who are the competitor’s customers?) and indirectly, for example, via the competitor’s communication channels (offline and online). The choice of distribution points also says something about the choice of target group. An analysis of the target groups that competitors have defined is important to avoid segments with intense competition, while segments with low competition represent an opportunity. In Section 7.7, we discuss concrete data sources that the company can use in the competitor’s strategy analysis.

7.5 Identification of success factors and competitive strengths and weaknesses In the fourth phase of the competitor analysis, the company must answer three questions: 1 2 3

Which resources and skills in the market are important; in other words: what are the success-determining factors? (Section 7.5.1) What are the strengths and weaknesses of the competitors? (Section 7.5.2) What summary conclusions can we draw? (Section 7.5.3)

7.5.1  Identification of key success factors In order not to have to identify all possible strengths and weaknesses in the strengthweakness analysis of the competitors, it makes sense to first determine which resources and skills are most important in a market. To this end, the success-determining factors in the market must be determined, that is, those resources or skills that have a major influence on the result of a company. ‘Result’ can refer to relative costs, customer loyalty, market share, profit, and so on (Day & Wensley, 1988). We can also say that these are the strengths that lead to an above-average result. A company that has these strengths has an advantage over competitors. Examples are: efficient physical distribution for food manufacturers, low labor costs for a television manufacturer, good relations with intermediaries for an insurance company, and so on. To be able to operate successfully itself, knowledge of the success-determining factors is of great importance for a company. As a starting point for the identification of success-determining factors, one can use the same checklist as one that can be used for an internal analysis (see Figure 4.3). The question, then, is which factors from that checklist are most important. Aaker (2013) gives a number of questions that may be helpful: 1 2 3 4

Why are successful companies successful and unsuccessful companies unsuccessful? What are the main motivations of customers? What do customers consider important? Which phase in the production process produces the highest added value and which phase produces the highest costs? What are the barriers to entry within the industry and between segments in the market?

1  Comparison of successful and unsuccessful companies A method that ties in with the first question is to compare successful and less successful companies. By comparing the characteristics of successful and less successful companies

COMPETITOR ANALYSIS 199

in one’s own industry, one can gain insight into those characteristics that are responsible for success. We note that in order to reach reliable conclusions, sufficient data must be available. Because this is often not or only partly the case for a specific sector, such an analysis will often have to be carried out qualitatively, and the conclusions will be indicative.

2  Customer motivation To answer the second question, a customer analysis must be performed. The aim is to find out what is important to people. The simplest method is to ask directly how important certain product properties (attributes) are considered. To prevent respondents from indicating that they find everything important, methods have been developed that take into account the trade-off between characteristics. A very suitable analysis method in this context is conjoint analysis (see Section 5.4). We will not discuss these and other methods in the context of this chapter.

3  Value chain A method that ties in with the third question is an analysis of the value chain as it applies ‘on average’ in the industry. Activities that deliver the highest added value on average are potential success-determining factors. Furthermore, the phases in which the costs are highest are the most suitable for seeking cost benefits.

4  Barriers to entry The fourth question implies that the barriers to entry should be analyzed. Factors that make it difficult for a potential supplier to enter the market (for example, obtaining the technology necessary to make the product, obtaining a high degree of distribution, or running an intensive advertising campaign) are generally also factors of great importance in the industry. On the basis of previous analyses, the importance of each factor in the sector can be indicated (see first column of Figure 7.2).

7.5.2  Determining competitors’ strengths and weaknesses For each of the factors shown in Figure 7.4, it must then be determined to what extent the selected competitors are strong or weak in this respect. To this end, the company will have to collect a large amount of mostly qualitative data, in which discussions with various ‘experts’ (representatives, customers, researchers, etc.) will be an important source. Figure 7.4 provides a brief description and qualification for each of the competitor attributes.

7.5.3  Determining the relative strengths and weaknesses In Chapter 4, we described different methods for the internal analysis. If those methods are also used for competitor analysis, a direct comparison can be made. For example,

200  SITUATION ANALYSIS

Characteristic

Importance Competitor Competitor Competitor Other in industry A B C competitors

Marketing • Product quality •  Customer orientation and service •  Market knowledge •  Relationship with retailers • Brand image • Price level Innovation • Technology • Expenditure on R&D • Patents production • Raw materials •  Production resources Sustainabiity • Footprint Financing • Cash flow w • Parent company • Current position Management • Flexibility •  Entrepreneurial quality • Staff turnover Figure 7.4 Potential success drivers in the industry and strengths and weaknesses of a company or brand

the value strategies can also be determined for competitors, or image characteristics of competitors can be included in a perception study, so that you as a brand know whether you are perceived as ‘younger’ than competitor X. Ahandy method for a competitive comparison is to draw up a table in which one’s own organization is added as a comparison at the same time (see Figure 7.5: a competitive grid). One can limit oneself to the success-determining factors (factors of great importance in Figure 7.5). Comparison of competitors’ strengths with own strengths provides insight into ‘relative’ (unique) strengths.

COMPETITOR ANALYSIS 201 Success determining

Competitor

Competitor

Competitor

Other

Own

factor

A

B

C

competitors

organization

Innovative/new

1*

5

2

3

2

perceived quality

4

4

1

2

5

Sustainability

5

2

4

2

5

Ambition top management

2

2

5

4

1

Distinctive image

4

1

3

4

2

Figure 7.5  Competitive grid: scores on key success-determining factors of competitors and own organization: * 1 = very weak; 5 = very strong

From Figure 7.3 we can deduce the following: n The own organization is strongest in terms of high quality (5) and sustainability (5). n Own relative strengths and weaknesses. Because A is also sustainable, this is not

a relatively strong point for its own organization; the high quality is a relatively strong point and therefore a competitive advantage. The other points point to a lack of innovative management and (probably partly because of this) an unclear image.

Furthermore, Figure 7.5 can be used for an initial selection of future collaboration partners. For example, an own weak point is the quality of the R&D. Competitor B is particularly strong. Conversely, B’s financial position is limited and that of its own organization is very good. So there seems to be a mutual interest in cooperation between the own organization and competitor B. A more specific form of comparing one’s own organization with its competitors is referred to as benchmarking. Benchmarking (sometimes referred to as ‘copying’) is best described as looking for best practice at other companies and then translating this into one’s own company (Camp, 1995). By comparing business processes within one’s own company with those within other companies, one gains insight into one’s own performance and thus into the starting points for improvement. These business processes can range from administration and production to comparing commercial performance. The comparison can be made with competitors but also with non-direct competitors. Research shows that benchmarking can be a good source of knowledge for finding a sustainable competitive advantage (Vorhies & Morgan, 2005). Case 7.1 is an example of benchmarking.

7.6 Expected strategies of competitors In the previous stages of competitor analysis, we have answered the questions of who the main competitors are and what the objectives, current strategies, and strengths and weaknesses of those competitors are. In the final phase, the question of what the competitor will do in the future must be answered on the basis of the previous elements. At the same time, one should try to predict how competitors might respond to strategies formulated by the organization. It is therefore important at this stage

202  SITUATION ANALYSIS

Case 7.1  Competitive advantage

Tenzing is really different from other drinks Natural, sustainable, radically different: that is the energy drink Tenzing. No screaming like the big competitor Red Bull, but a sincere brand, based on the legendary Sherpa Jamling Tenzing, who has managed to climb Mount Everest many times. The brand started in England, is very successful there, and is now also for sale in the Netherlands. Tenzing: naturally energy. to draw a kind of ‘conclusion’ from all the previous information about the expected behavior of the competitor. Good empathy for the position of the competitor is necessary. It is not easy to arrive at concrete predictions in this last phase. Among other things, the company will have to use subjective forecasting methods: methods in which ‘experts’ in one way or another generate forecasts based on the available information. Concrete methods that can be used for this are a Delphi study (making a forecast in a number of rounds with experts in the company) and role-playing. In a role play, people are assigned roles of market parties and each has to draw up a plan based on his own objectives (which are by definition conflicting: not everyone’s market share can grow). The advantage of a role-playing game is that someone literally empathizes with the psychology of the competitor. Armstrong (2001, 2002) has shown that this forecasting method often produces good predictions of competitive behavior. As with the analysis of other environmental factors, it can also be useful here to define scenarios; for example, the competitor does not react or reacts to our strategy. Finally, we make an important comment on the competitor analysis. Companies must be careful not to focus too much on the competition. Of course it is important to keep a close eye on the competition, but companies should be guided in their strategy primarily by the customer and not by the competitor. Research into price reactions by retailers in

COMPETITOR ANALYSIS 203

the United States shows that brands often ‘overreact’ to each other (Leeflang & Wittink, 1996 (they researched price reactions); Steenkamp et al., 2005 (they researched the reaction to promotions and commercial break)). This leads to unnecessary price reactions and reactions with other sales-promotion instruments that the providers themselves ultimately all lose.

7.7 Data sources Collecting data about competitors is sometimes referred to as competitive intelligence (or business intelligence). In fact, this means nothing more than trying to collect as much data as possible about the competitors in the most inventive way possible. This can range from requesting university research reports to buying out a competitor’s employee. How far creativity must and may go on this point, we leave unaddressed here. In practice, several publicly available sources can be used. We can make a distinction between the following sources: n What other market parties say about the competitor, for example, buyers, suppliers,

their own representatives, and financial institutions.

n What competitors say about themselves, for example, in annual reports, online,

lectures, press releases, job advertisements, advertisements, or via ‘bought away’ employees from competitors. n What third parties say about the competitor, for example, online, articles in newspapers and magazines, consumer organizations (product testing), industry studies, research agencies, and universities. For all data that a company collects about competitors, it is important to bring it together and make it accessible to others within the company. Only in this way can a coherent picture of the current and expected behavior of the competitors emerge. To achieve this, the following conditions must be met: n Responsibility for competitor analysis rests in one hand. This person can ensure that

the correct analyses are carried out and that all data is collected.

n There is a well-functioning marketing information system. In such an automated

system, not only must one’s own data be stored but also that of competitors. Everyone in the company should be able to request the most recent data from the most important competitors and also to enter their own ‘news’.

In addition to qualitative data, there are a number of quantitative data sources. In some countries there may be secondary data sources about the competitors. In Section 4.6, we discussed Nielsen, GfK, and IRI files that include data regarding sales, prices, and distribution of fast-moving consumer goods and some other product categories as well. Detailed data about advertising are collected in many countries by Nielsen Media Research. A limitation of the quantitative data sources mentioned here is that they mainly relate to consumer markets of goods. This implies that conducting a competitive analysis in service or industrial markets requires greater inventiveness than in consumer markets.

204  SITUATION ANALYSIS

Nevertheless, adequate competitor analysis is also possible in such markets by engaging the right people and collecting and processing data in a structured manner. For example, in Chapter 5, we showed how brand images can be measured. An organization can apply a similar method to itself and to its competitors.

Summary The purpose of competitor analysis is to understand the strengths and weaknesses of key competitors, as well as their anticipated strategies. The combination of both things, coupled with one’s own strengths and weaknesses, determines whether the competitor should be seen as a rival or as a future partner. The question of how many competitors a company has depends on the level at which the target group competes: at the budget level, at the generic level, at the product category level, or at the product form level. The annual marketing plan usually looks at the last two levels. Within a chosen level, the most important competitors must then be determined. It is important to carry out this identification from the point of view of management and, moreover, to check how the target group views the competition (market research). The current strategy and objectives are then determined for the most important competitors and what strengths and weaknesses they have. At the end of a competitor analysis, all collected information is introduced into, for example, a brainstorming or role-playing session, in which a forecast of the competitor’s behavior is made from the perspective of the competitor. This also involves estimating the likelihood that the competitor will react to the future strategy of the company conducting the analysis. Competitor data is largely qualitative in nature. For markets of non-durable consumer goods, a lot of quantitative data is also available from agencies such as Nielsen and GfK. But an organization’s own market research can also contain information about competitors.

COMPETITOR ANALYSIS 205

McDonald’s versus Burger King: concept or taste

You likely know more about the fast food industry than you realize. If you live in the United States – or pretty much anywhere else – it’s everywhere. Off of every exit on the highway and at every rest stop. In the food court at the mall and on the commercial strips on the outskirts of town. In cities and at airports. What you may not have noticed, though, is the changing dynamics within the industry. The last several years have seen an absolute explosion of diversity in

206  SITUATION ANALYSIS

both restaurant concepts and menu choices. This evolution reflects an industry that has been responsive to changing consumer tastes as well as entrepreneurs finding niche opportunities to profit, an industry that needs to be responsive as consumers become more and more critical about what they eat. The fast food sector has been growing rapidly in the past decades due to the busy lifestyle of consumers. Hamburger giants, pizza chains, and sandwich restaurants all compete to favor the grazing consumer. But the growth has been slowing down over the past decade, partly due to the growing health consciousness of the consumer. The fast food market continues to be dominated by hamburger fast food restaurants in most countries. However that market share is sliding, and alternatives such as wok-to-go concepts have been gaining. Also, ‘premium’ fast food chains such as Five Guys claim to offer a better food or customer experience than the traditional chains. A recent trend is the rise of fast casual restaurants such as Shake Shack and Chipotle. These restaurants offer consumers freshly prepared, higher-quality food in an informal setting, with counter service to keep things speedy. Shake Shack, for instance, is a burger chain that is successful by offering a casual dining experience at a fast food pace.

Figure 7.6  Eating behavior

COMPETITOR ANALYSIS 207

Figure 7.7  Restaurant usage

Especially in the United States, these developments have led to price competition between McDonald’s, BK, and other ‘traditional’ hamburger chains. But competition with ‘dollar menus’ not only leads to financial consequences; the brand equity also suffers. McDonald’s still is the global market leader. The golden arches not only symbolize Big Mac and Happy Meal but also a certain lifestyle. But there are negative associations as well. Especially in Europe, McDonald’s is seen as an example of American imperialism, together with, for instance, Hollywood and Coca Cola. The brand has to deal with growing health concerns as well as increasing competition. One of the causes is the growing diversity in the fast-food landscape. But there are also challenges in hamburger country itself. One of the competitors even claims to be king: the Burger King. Even though there are more McDonald’s restaurants than Burger Kings worldwide (around 38,000 McDonald’s restaurants against around 19,000 Burger King restaurants), both brands have established themselves firmly in the mindset of the customer. The final word is up to the consumer: Does he love McDonald’s or will he choose the BK way?

McDonald’s The good thing of being a market leader is that free publicity comes more or less automatically. The campaign ‘I’m lovin’ it’ is, according to McDonald’s, more than just a slogan. ‘It’s a way of thinking, with a central theme how McDonald’s can satisfy the needs of every individual customer’, according to the global chief marketing of McDonald’s Corporation. The intention of this approach is to check whether the product range still matches the diversity of desires of the client. Store design and service will be adapted to the taste of the customer as well.

208  SITUATION ANALYSIS

The McDonald’s strategy is visible in the worldwide campaigns. In the commercials a variety of people are enjoying McDonald’s products. At the start of the campaign reactions were mixed. Critics were surprised that McDonald’s apparently had abandoned the ‘think global-act local’ approach. With this approach McDonald’s had conquered the world and a unique image in each country of the world. ‘The campaign is loaded with people enjoying themselves, individually. A boy is playing the drums with McDonald’s straws, a businessman is swinging in the streets. Sometimes the fun has a cynical touch, like when a kickboxing girl kicks a milkshake out of someone’s hands. This type of fun is typical for individualistic cultures like in Europe or North-America. In collectivistic cultures like in Southern Europe, Asia or Latin-America people have fun with each other’, according to the criticism. Another critic: ‘This is a typical American feelgood-campaign. This might not work with a European audience. I also wonder whether it is smart to target young people. Especially in a number of European countries the brand is doing very well with families with children. McDonald’s has to be careful not to lose this audience’. Others, though, have more favorable opinions. A reaction is that the campaign fits a market leader. The campaign is superficial, but demonstrates a vision. Apparently McDonald’s has no identifiable competitive advantage. That’s why – like with a fashion brand – McDonald’s uses a non-tangible appeal to make the brand relevant and valuable. If there would have been a distinctive advantage it would be a lot easier to make a nice commercial, which gives the consumer a hint of what they can find at McDonald’s. But fastfood is not necessarily tasty or healthy. Whatever you say about it would not be believed by the consumer anyway. What remains is the ordinary, the day-to-day aspect of McDonald’s. And because of this, McDonald’s is part of our lives. Even though the theme is global, execution of the campaign remains localized. A European marketing director of McDonald’s highlights that: ‘The specific contents will differ from country to country, especially because the strategy is focused at the individual consumer. The global strategy is localized in each country. In many countries in Europe, an important focus is on teenagers, young people, and families with children’.

Burger King The difference in positioning between Burger King and McDonald’s was characterized once as ‘concept versus taste’ or ‘brains versus belly’. The market leader, McDonald’s, is communicating a lifestyle in its global campaign. Burger King, on the other hand, emphasizes its products. According to a marketing expert: ‘I think that in the fastfood industry the best way is to communicate the product. Burger King has a distinctive way of making its products’. The preparation (grilled, meaning less fat) has been a unique selling proposition (USP) for BK for years.

COMPETITOR ANALYSIS 209

The Burger King campaigns have a local approach, although the supporting slogan is global. For a long time, this slogan was ‘Have It Your Way’. This slogan was based on the idea that Burger King offers a specific snack for each moment of the day. ‘Nowadays, the consumer is changing its habits continuously’, according to a marketing manager at Burger King. ‘Grazing patterns and tastes change continuously’. Therefore, the slogan was changed in 2014 into ‘Be Your Way’. In an interview, management of Burger King noted that ‘Have It Your Way’ focuses on only the purchase – the ability to customize a burger. By contrast, ‘Be Your Way’ is about making a connection with a person’s greater lifestyle. ‘We want to evolve from just being the functional side of things to having a much stronger emotional appeal’, according to BK’s brand management. In 2022, BK’s customer focus was emphasized even more with the new slogan ‘You Rule’. Whether the new tag line can help Burger King’s image over the long term remains to be seen. Real BK lovers know the slogan. These people appreciate BK for its quality, the flame grilling as a way of preparing the food, and the Whopper. But the slogan is almost unknown for most people. A marketing specialist observed that The problem is that people don’t see themselves as living the Burger King lifestyle. You’ve got to be realistic with the place that your brand holds in real life. And it is not certain whether the consumer knows what the slogan ‘You Rule’ stands for. The reply of BK’s brand management to this criticism: ‘We will communicate this more in the future. The slogan puts the customer in the middle. The customer decides on the size of the menu, and whether he wants ingredients like cheese, ketchup or bacon’. Next to a new slogan, part of BK’s strategy is to directly challenge McDonald’s products. For instance, when McDonald’s brought back the McRib sandwich, Burger King responded by unveiling a $1 BK BBQ Rib as a cheaper alternative. Burger King management is clear about its value proposition. It is just as good as McDonald’s, with the same products, just slightly more upscale and, possibly, cheaper. At the same time, Burger King is noted for its superior burgers. Therefore, Burger King remains aware of the importance of its flagship: the Whopper.

Questions 1 2 3 4

Explain, based on the case about the fast food market, what the difference is between the industry analysis and the competitor analysis. Which strategic groups can be identified in the fast food industry? Four levels of competition can be distinguished. Define for each of these levels competitors for McDonald’s. According to the Brand Benefitting Model, a company has to choose for a specific brand promise in order to be successful. Which brand promise is

210  SITUATION ANALYSIS

  5   6   7   8

  9 10

11

12

essential for fast food? Do you see any differences between Burger King and McDonald’s? Explain. The industry structure can be defined by using Porter’s five-forces model. Execute this model for the fast food industry. Draw your conclusions about the attractiveness of this industry, from McDonald’s point of view. The case highlights the observation that ‘McDonald’s has no identifiable competitive advantage’. Do you agree with this observation? Explain your answer. Suppose McDonald’s would like to identify its most direct competitors by means of multidimensional scaling. Describe step by step what needs to be done to execute this analysis. What would you favor in the fast food industry: a campaign focusing on the product (like the ‘You Rule’ slogan of Burger King) or a campaign focusing on the lifestyle you want to create with your brand (like McDonald’s)? Explain your answer. What do you consider the key success factors in the fast food industry? a  What is the competitive advantage of McDonald’s, as compared to Burger King? b What is the competitive advantage of Burger King, as compared to McDonald’s? Imagine McDonald’s asked you to analyze and predict the strategy of Burger King by performing a competitor analysis. Start with the information in the case, but do additional desk research where necessary. a Define the (marketing) objective of Burger King. b Identify the current marketing strategy (target group selection and positioning) of Burger King. c Determine the strengths and weaknesses of Burger King. d Predict the future strategy of Burger King: how do you expect Burger King to proceed in the near future? Imagine Burger King asked you to analyze and predict the strategy of McDonald’s by performing a competitor analysis. Start with the information in the case, but do additional desk research where necessary. a Define the (marketing) objective of McDonald’s. b Identify the current marketing strategy (target group selection and positioning) of McDonald’s. c Determine the strengths and weaknesses of McDonald’s. d Predict the future strategy of McDonald’s: how do you expect McDonald’s to proceed in the near future?

Chapter 8

Distribution and supplier analysis

DOI: 10.4324/9781003381488-10

212  SITUATION ANALYSIS

Key points in this chapter n n n n n

Know aggregation levels in the distribution analysis. Be able to analyze the distribution structure in an industry. Assess the role of disintermediation. Be able to analyze the distribution intensity by applying different criteria. Know the steps in an individual distributor and supplier analysis.

Introduction A thorough distribution and supplier analysis is important because it offers the opportunity to build good relationships with these parties. Availability of your product has a strong influence on market share. A competitive advantage can then be achieved through a good channel strategy. And a good relationship with suppliers can be a basis for high quality or excellent sustainability. Of course, the growth of online sales means that more and more providers will follow a multichannel strategy: selling through multiple (for example, in-store and online) channels. But in all cases, a good distribution analysis is important. Section 8.1 focuses on the structure of the distribution analysis, after which Sections 8.2 to 8.4 flesh out the distribution analysis on three levels: the macro, meso, and micro levels. Section 8.5 is devoted to supplier analysis.

8.1 Goal and structure of a distribution analysis In preparation for Chapter 11, we note that three types of decisions must be made in the context of deploying the market instrument distribution (or channel strategy): 1 2 3

the choice of distribution intensity (target) the choice of distribution channels distribution channel management

In this chapter, we will not discuss these decisions, but we will focus on providing an analysis scheme with which the necessary information can be obtained in order to implement the said decisions in the most responsible manner possible. For the purposes of this book, we limit ourselves to a few key points. A distribution analysis takes place at three levels of aggregation: 1 2

Macro level. This involves mapping the entire distribution column, both vertically (possible levels, long or short channel) and horizontally (different types of intermediaries within a level). So this is a global distribution structure. Meso level. This analysis involves: n the more specific distribution structure within one type of intermediary, for example, the distribution of power of retail chains within the type of supermarkets

DISTRIBUTION AND SUPPLIER ANALYSIS 213

3

n the position of brands within one level and in particular within the group of retailers (analysis of distribution intensity) Micro level. This concerns the strategies and wishes and desires of individual distributors (distributor analysis). Separate distributors here mainly refer to separate retail chains, such as Jumbo. It is therefore not about separate distribution points, because a chain consists of many stores. Some also consider this meso level; in this book we do not do that because it is about the relationship with individual companies, as well as competitor analysis.

The levels cannot be separated from each other. Thus, the distribution structure has a macro and a meso component. While this distinction makes analytical sense, both belong to the distribution structure. Furthermore, analysis of the distribution structure at the meso level (within one group of intermediaries) requires information on the market shares of individual retail chains. These data are obtained from the micro-level distribution analysis. These three levels are discussed in turn in Sections 8.2 to 8.4.

8.2 Distribution analysis at the macro level In this section we discuss the dimensions of the distribution analysis and the online channels.

8.2.1  Dimensions of the distribution analysis The analysis of the distribution structure at the macro level involves two dimensions: 1 2

the number of levels in the distribution column (vertical: length of the channel) the type of intermediary links within one level, such as the distinction within the group of retailers between supermarkets, discounters, convenience stores, specialist shops, or the ‘grey circuit’ of, for example, petrol stations (horizontal: width of the channel)

Insight into this is important for the choice of the type of intermediate links. There are two possibilities regarding the length of the channel: direct delivery and indirect delivery. Direct delivery takes place to customers without the use of intermediaries; online delivery has of course grown enormously and is still growing. We will discuss this further in Section 8.2.2. With indirect delivery, intermediaries are called in. Possible intermediaries between producer and consumer are agents, importers, wholesalers, and retailers. If one opts for delivery via retailers only, then we speak of a short channel. In all other cases one speaks of a long channel. Some of the selection criteria here are the number of (final) customers that the company wishes to serve and the type of product (including shelf life and complexity). Incidentally, it is not necessary to choose one channel. Companies are increasingly opting for a multichannel strategy, for example, by combining bricks (offline) and clicks (online: e-commerce).

214  SITUATION ANALYSIS

8.2.2  Online channels The internet makes it relatively easy to have direct contact with customers, and direct contact enables direct trade. Online shopping (e-commerce) has therefore expanded enormously. Direct delivery to customers by producers implies that intermediaries are ‘cut out’ (disintermediation). Such decisions in food are difficult, because the intermediaries are also customers and will not be happy if they are ignored. Another challenge for online sales is to limit costs. The logistics require an entire organization and lead to additional costs, including the costs of returns (see Case 8.1). For example, consumers who buy clothing often seem to have many sizes and types delivered, a large number of which are then returned free of charge. It seems that there are also consumers who really wear a new suit, for example, for a special occasion and send it back the day after, sometimes with stains on it. The arrival of online shopping has created a new kind of companies that do not provide their own products or services but help you as a customer to choose ‘intermediaries’ between service providers and customers. Booking.com is well known (Case 8.2), but there are also plenty of airline ticket sites. The difference with ‘product intermediaries’ such as amazon.com is that no logistics device needs to be set up for these services: no products need to be physically transported. You buy someone else’s service, just on another site. Very simple. The business model that these sites have is that they usually get a share of the turnover. As online shopping is becoming increasingly important, these new intermediaries are also becoming increasingly important, and employment at these organizations is also increasing. Because customer wishes and customer behavior plus ICT knowledge are essential, new marketing-ICT functions are emerging.

8.3 Distribution analysis at the meso level 8.3.1  Distribution structure at the meso level In the previous section, an analysis was provided of the distribution structure at the macro level. However, more detailed information is needed to determine the optimal choice of a channel. We briefly describe the role of the wholesaler and then discuss the level of the individual retailers in more detail. The wholesaler is positioned between the manufacturer and the retailer, and its core function is to tailor the supply and demand of goods in markets, both qualitatively and quantitatively. As a result of the enormous development in ICT, in which manufacturers and retailers increasingly coordinate their supply and demand with each other more easily and intensively via electronic data interchange (EDI), there is evidence that the wholesale trade is being eliminated. For a supplier, this means that an analysis of the added value that the wholesaler can offer is relevant. Within a single level of intermediaries (e.g. retailers) or even within one type of intermediary links (e.g. supermarkets), it is important to understand the distribution of power (market shares) between individual companies and distributors. After all, this distribution also determines the importance of individual retail brands (in addition to volume and margin) and is therefore a guideline for the marketing efforts in this regard. When analyzing the distribution of power, the company must – of course – take into account

DISTRIBUTION AND SUPPLIER ANALYSIS 215

Case 8.1  Costs of return

More than 200 billion dollars (~180 billion GBP) worth of merchandise was returned in 2021, according to a study by Appriss Retail and the National Retail Foundation, amounting to approximately 20% of total online sales. In addition, according to a consumer survey, around 25% of customers believe they’re returning between 5% and 15% of their purchases. A small percentage even said they return more than half of what they buy online. The numbers worsen during holidays like Christmas when it’s estimated that two out of three consumers return a gift or purchase. It’s especially the case with apparel, electronics, and jewelry items that return rates are high (the average eCommerce return rate for apparel is around 10%). Returns cost businesses about 66% of the original item’s price. Even if the item is returned in good condition, the entire returns process will still be costly because of the required labor, transport, and inspection (the business usually shoulders the return cost). Source: lestbloom.com, 7 October 2022

the various forms of cooperation that exist between distributors (buying combinations, franchising, etc.). In some countries a tendency towards concentration has occurred in the food retail industry. For example, in the United States, Wal-Mart is by far the largest food retailer, with a share of more than 30% in some product categories.

8.3.2  Analysis of the distribution intensity of a brand The distribution intensity of a brand relates to its position within a single level in the distribution channel. For this reason, we consider the distribution intensity analysis a meso-level analysis.

216  SITUATION ANALYSIS

Case 8.2  Connecting providers and customers

The success of Booking.com Booking.com is perhaps the most famous site for booking hotels and other accommodations worldwide. The site is very user friendly, and as a customer, you actually get all the information you want. The scores and opinions of customers who have already visited the hotels are also important. You can immediately see if there is still room on the days you want, and you will also be presented with alternatives that ‘visitors who looked at this hotel also looked at’. What is also special is that many hotels can be booked without cancellation costs. That makes the threshold for booking very low. Booking.com is gaining more and more power due to the large number of customers. You can even report it immediately to Booking.com if you have a complaint in a hotel, after which Booking.com will contact the hotel. Usually the problem is solved very quickly! The rates via Booking.com are no higher than if you book directly through a hotel. Naturally, Booking.com receives a large share of the turnover. Due to the great success of Booking.com, hundreds of marketeers and IT specialists work there. In the context of a distribution analysis, it is important to continue to explore the possibilities and impossibilities of supplying customers directly and to be neither too cautious nor too progressive in the choice of strategy (see Chapter 12).

To determine the desired distribution intensity, a manager must first analyze the past and current distribution intensity. We now focus on the ‘offline’ distribution of a brand. The reason is that once a retailer has a webshop, the online distribution intensity is by definition 100% (assuming there are no regional restrictions). So, for online distribution only two values exist: 0% or 100%. The review of distribution criteria that follows is

DISTRIBUTION AND SUPPLIER ANALYSIS 217

therefore in some sense ‘old-fashioned’. But it is still important to manage physical distribution as well, also in the light of the findings of Sharp (2010), who demonstrated that availability and visibility strongly affect market share. To measure the position within the physical distribution channel, two criteria are typically used: 1 2

Non-weighted (numerical) distribution. This is the percentage of stores in which the brand is available Weighted distribution. This is the market share in the product group of the shops in which the brand is available; in other words, or the market coverage.

The difference between the two criteria is that the weighted distribution takes into account the size (sales) of the stores. Shops that sell a relatively large amount (from the product group) count more heavily. For the calculation of the size of the stores where the brand is for sale, the following benchmark exists: the selection indicator. This is the average turnover in the product category at the stores where the own brand is present, divided by the average turnover in the product category at all stores where brands from the product category are offered. If the selection indicator is greater than 1, the own brand is located in relatively large stores and vice versa. The selection indicator can also be calculated by dividing the weighted distribution by the unweighted distribution. The aforementioned criteria say something about the distribution position of the brand in the market as a whole. To measure the position of the brand within the stores where the brand is present, a manager can use the metric sales share. This is the market share of the brand within the stores where it is present (own sales or turnover divided by the total sales or turnover in the product category of the stores where the brand is located). It can be easily shown that the following relations exist: Market share = weighted distribution × revenue share Market share = non-weighted distribution × selection indicator × sales share Another important indicator of the position of the brand in the shop is the shelf position. The shelf position has two important aspects: location and amount. Location (low, middle, high) cannot be quantified. Amount can be expressed in facings: the number of visible products. The number of facings is often related to the market share: the bigger the brand, the more facings are given by the retailer. We have summarized this schematically in Figure 8.1. We illustrate this figure and the previous one with a calculation example (see example 8.1).

8.4 Distribution analysis at the micro level: retail analysis We now focus on the relation between a producer and retail brands. Retailers are in fact the customers of the producer. So, for a producer, an important issue is to anticipate the retailers’ needs. The final distribution goal is to obtain a good location on the shelf as well as a lot of positive attention from the sales staff of retailers in terms of personal sales to the final customers (consumers). Important tools in this context are the margins on products and promotional activities in collaboration with the retailer. The concept

218  SITUATION ANALYSIS

Example 8.1  Position of the brand Suppose a brand generates a turnover of €500,000 (B) on a market size of €5 million (T). The brand is located in 100 (n) of the 500 (m) stores where the product is offered. The turnover in the product category of these 100 stores amounts to €2 million (W). The unweighted distribution is then: 100/500 (n/m) = 20% The weighted distribution is: 2 million/5 million (W/T) = 40%. The selection indicator is: (W/n)/(T/m) = (2/100)/(5/500) = 2 This was also seen by dividing 40% by 20%. The turnover share is: B/W = 500,000 / 2,000,000 = 25%. The market share of the brand is: B/T = 500,000 / 5 million = 10%. This is indeed equal to 20% × 2 × 25%. The conclusion is that the brand has a low degree of distribution and is mainly located in large shops (measured in sales within the product category). The shops where brand A is located depend on that brand for 25% of their sales in the product category. The results of distribution analyses are of direct importance for the use of market instruments. For example, if a company wants to increase its weighted distribution, it can choose to encourage retailers to include the brand through extensive advertising and sales staff visits. If the turnover share is disappointing, this means that the position of the brand in the stores where it is located is weakened, for example, due to insufficient support in the store. A strategy in which the retailer is rewarded more for support (push-strategy) is then obvious. Finally, we mention again the limitation of the previous analysis in that it pertains to the physical (offline) distribution. of relationship management has a central focus: The manufacturer attempts to realize its goals (and those of the retailer) through an optimal relationship with the retailer. Insight into the wishes and desires of retailers is the most important information source in this area. For that purpose, individual retail brands must be examined. Therefore, this involves a distribution analysis at the micro level (distributor analysis). At the most disaggregated level (sales outlets), a manufacturer may be dealing with many hundreds of ‘customers’. By far the largest proportion of them is in one way or another involved in joint collaboration. Thus, in reality, the ‘salesperson’ of a manufacturer (the sales manager) has to deal with a significantly lower number and often with only a few buyers.

DISTRIBUTION AND SUPPLIER ANALYSIS 219

T

W

(m)

B

(n) B = sales of brand W = category sales of ‘own’ retailers T = sales total market

B/W = sales share B/T = market share W/T = weighted distribution

(W/n)/(T/m) = selection indicator n/m = numerical (unweighted) distribution So: weighted distribution = numerical distribution x selection indicator

Figure 8.1  Summary of distribution measures

For the purpose of organizing the analysis of a distributor, it is important to determine which role the retailer actually plays for the producer. As already mentioned, the retailer is a customer that ‘resells’ the product to final users. Yet in the food industry, retailers increasingly are also competitors of producers as a result of the own brands of those distributors (distributor-owned brands). Therefore, a distributor analysis is positioned between a customer analysis and a competitor analysis (see Chapter 6). For each retailer, insight should be obtained into the following: 1 2 3 4

The importance and role of the retailer (Section 8.4.1). The position of the manufacturer’s brand at the retailer (Section 8.4.2). The objectives, strategy, and wishes of the retailer (Section 8.4.3). The strengths and weaknesses and the expected strategy of the retailer (Section 8.4.4).

8.4.1  The importance and the role of the retailer The importance of a retailer may be measured by its sales in the product category. For the food products industry, relevant data can be obtained from Nielsen, IRI, or GfK. For markets for durable consumer goods, the position of retailers (e.g., the position of Megapool in the market for white fabrics) should be estimated. In addition to sales, the

220  SITUATION ANALYSIS

margin is essential. For a manufacturer, the profitability of a ‘relationship’ is ultimately what matters. With regard to the role of a retailer, the easily answered question is whether it is only a ‘customer’ or also a competitor. The retailer is a competitor if it carries its own brands (distributor brands, or D-brands), a situation that occurs in many markets for fast-moving consumer goods. In addition, it is important to determine the degree of freedom in brand supply for a retailer: Does the retailer have a ‘preferred supplier’ – a manufacturer within the product category that is preferred?

8.4.2  The position of the manufacturer’s brand at the retailer Measures of the position of the manufacturer’s own brand at the retailer include the shelf position, the number of facings, and the sales of the manufacturer’s brand at that retailer in relation to other sales outlets and/or in relation to other retailer brands. Shelf position and facings are tools of the retailer. Another tool is the personal sale, especially in lines of business that are not related to the food products industry. All these tools have an impact on brand sales. Relatively low brand sales may indicate insufficient attention to the brand on the part of the retailer; that may indicate an inadequate marketing policy of the producer toward that retailer. The other way around it can be argued that for the retailer the producers’ brand might also be important. This is especially true if the producers’ product contributes to the turnover of the retailer, if the margin is sufficient, if it meets needs of consumers, and also if it helps the retailer to differentiate from competitive retailers. So, there is a mutual dependency between producers and retailers.

8.4.3  The goals, strategy, and wishes of the retailer Objectives involve issues such as satisfaction of the retailer (and therefore the results until the present time) and ambition (limited or fast growth, growth with existing or new activities, etc.). Strategy here involves the implementation of the marketing strategy (positioning and choice of the target audience): On which consumers does the retailer focus? For a manufacturer, it is important to choose a retailer with a marketing strategy comparable to its own. In addition, the use of the four Ps by the retailer should be examined. The ‘P’ of product in this regard is actually related to the wishes of the retailer: How wide is its assortment; which product categories are in the shop with how many varieties; and what proportions of those are A brands, B brands, and retailer brands? Other relevant questions include the following: To what extent and how does the retailer implement its own communication policy? How does the retailer handle promotional campaigns? In general, to what extent is the retailer willing to collaborate with the manufacturer? The answers to all these questions will need to be provided, based mostly on observation and experiences with the relevant retailer. It may be expected that an account manager or another representative of the manufacturer will gain insight, through regular contacts with the buyers, into what the retailer does or does not want and how it behaves. All these issues are part of what is called trade marketing: the marketing of a producer to the retailer.

DISTRIBUTION AND SUPPLIER ANALYSIS 221

Case 8.3  Strategies of a retailer

Primark chooses for bricks only Budget fashion chain Primark, which has shunned the extra cost of home delivery, could add click-and-collect services to its revamped website over time but still sees new stores in markets such as Italy and the United States as its main growth driver. The chain, whose trendy clothes at rock-bottom prices have taken British and European shoppers by storm over the last decade, will launch a new website in the United Kingdom by the end of March and across its 13 other markets by the autumn. That will better showcase its 10,000 products, provide customers with near real-time information on product availability by store, and enable Primark to mine the data of its over 24 million active ‘engagers’. ‘We’re making the digital move forward in a very big way in both the UK and the rest of Europe. That will generate sales and profits for us’, John Bason, finance director of Primark’s owner, Associated British Foods (ABF.L), told Reuters. ‘Does this give us a capability to move further forward? Well let’s have a look at that’, he said in an interview. ‘If there was an e-commerce opportunity for us, it will probably be more in the area of click-and-collect’, he said, referring to products ordered online and picked up in store. But Bason said home delivery remained off Primark’s agenda, as the economics don’t stack up for its low price points. ‘You can’t get our value by delivery to home, it’s as simple as that’. Source: Reuters.com, 11 March 2022

222  SITUATION ANALYSIS

8.4.4  The strengths and weaknesses and the expected strategy of the retailer Finally, an attempt is made, based in part on the foregoing steps, to deduce the strengths and weaknesses as well as the expected strategy of the retailer. In terms of the strengths (and weaknesses) of a retailer, two types may be distinguished: strengths that are interesting to any manufacturer (e.g., high sales per customer, friendly staff, and short waiting times at the cash register) and manufacturer-specific strengths. After all, for a manufacturer, the issue is to choose a retailer that fits with the target audience and the positioning of the manufacturer’s products. Characteristics of the retailer that are congruent present opportunities for the manufacturer (such as a good fresh produce department, high-quality positioning, and a large staff). Weak points of an existing retailer (e.g., low sales per customer) may be an occasion for more intensive collaboration with the manufacturer (e.g., joint promotions). The expected retailer strategy also may present opportunities (or threats) for the manufacturer. Expanded support and growth of the retailer’s brands may have important implications for the manufacturer. Potential options vary from strengthening the position and positioning of the producer’s brands to starting to produce retailer brands. Just as in Section 8.4.3, statements can only be qualitative in nature and assumptions probably will have to be made if insufficient information is available.

8.5 Analysis of the suppliers This section provides a brief introduction to the analysis of suppliers. For more extensive descriptions, the reader should refer to the literature on purchasing and business marketing (marketing from a company to another company). Purchasing occurs in many areas, such as the purchasing of the following: n Supportive goods and services (office furniture, financial services, online support

services, advertising agencies, etc.).

n Means of production (labor and capital goods). n Semimanufactured articles and raw materials.

A good relationship with suppliers can be a source of a competitive advantage. This applies to all types of purchasing. For example, a good website which is easily found and has a strong ‘call to action’ may be very important for success. Good housing can have an impact on staff motivation. The usefulness of qualified personnel (labor market) is evident. Good and reliable machines determine the quality of production. Certainly in the case of semifinished products and raw materials, savings in purchasing may be ‘channeled’ to the consumer. The requirements for purchased semifinished products and raw materials depend on the chosen value strategy. A company that chooses customer leadership (customer intimacy) and direct delivery will require flexibility (many varieties) and reliability (timely delivery) in the deliveries. The strategy of product leadership requires a high and constant quality of the purchased products. A company that chooses a low price within operational excellence will have a strong need for inexpensive purchasing, for example, through agreements about quantity discounts.

DISTRIBUTION AND SUPPLIER ANALYSIS 223

Case 8.4  Relevance of suppliers

Marketers have a duty to please suppliers as well as customers The essence of marketing is pleasing customers. But is this currently still the case? Who needs customers nowadays? Marketing’s longstanding obsession with the demand side of the equation – pandering to consumers, diligently working back from their ever-shifting needs, obsequiously striving to ‘surprise and delight’ – is beginning to look overdone. Shortages of staff and raw materials mean marketers must influence how suppliers perceive them and ground product development in supply chain reality. So, the goal of marketing should be much broader nowadays. Source: adapted from Marketingweek.com, 5 December 2022 Whichever demands are made for whichever type of purchasing, it will be easier to comply with those demands if good relationships are built with the supplying companies. Therefore, an analysis of current and potential suppliers is important. Purchasing by a company is in essence no different from purchasing by a consumer: there is a need that is satisfied through purchasing and/or acquisition. The most important differences are the following: n In purchasing, the need is ‘indirect’: It depends on the requirements that are made of

the products, which in turn depend on the final needs of the final customer.

224  SITUATION ANALYSIS

n The purchasing process is different and more complicated: Typically, a single

person is not responsible for purchasing; instead, there are decision-making units (DMUs). In this situation, various people in a company are responsible for the final purchasing decisions.

In a supplier analysis, the following questions are answered: 1

2

Which needs within the company have to be met? The analysis of suppliers depends on the need that must be met. Therefore, an internal analysis to define that need is important. For example: do we need a new website? Should we search for more sustainable suppliers? Which supplier can best provide for that need? To arrive at a selection of potential suppliers, the company will have to examine the expected achievements of the suppliers in the following areas: n n n n

Quality: the concrete characteristics of the products Price (potential discounts, etc.) Sustainability Service

The service component is very important in business markets and includes both components such as warranty, repair service, and reliability and additional service components such as training and information. To be able to evaluate suppliers on these factors, information from the company’s own purchasers is important: they know the market like no one else. In addition, suppliers may be asked to make ‘bids’. This may occur through a call for tenders (e.g., construction combinations needed to create and present a building scheme), pitches (advertising agencies that need to write a campaign proposal), or normal quotes. Because trust plays an important role in purchasing markets, issues such as reputation, experience with suppliers, and personal contacts often are decisive in making a choice. This implies that branding and communication are also relevant in a business market. Therefore, in a supplier analysis, these qualitative elements play an important role.

Summary An analysis of the distribution and suppliers is important since building relations with retailers and suppliers may lead to competitive advantages. A distribution analysis is performed at the macro level, the meso level, and the micro level. At the macro level, the distribution structure is mapped out. Clearly, nowadays, multichannel strategies are often applied int the sense of offline as well as online. An analysis is made of which levels are used and to what extent and how many sales are made in the category through which channels. A specific point in that regard is what the potential development of online sales might be. The elimination of intermediary links is a way for manufacturers to avoid the increasing power of retailers. At the meso level, the power of the retailers is analyzed, along with the position of the brand at the various retailers. At the micro level, individual retailers (chains) are analyzed; an important point is to discover how the best

DISTRIBUTION AND SUPPLIER ANALYSIS 225

possible relationship with the retailer can be built. For that purpose, an understanding of the retailer’s goals, strategy, and wishes is required. The company’s account managers are an important data source for this largely qualitative analysis. For a supplier analysis, the goal is also to build relationships. An analysis will focus on the question of which purchasing needs the company has and which supplier can best meet those needs. The company’s own purchasing needs will depend on the chosen positioning. Selection of a supplier is becoming increasingly important, also given the importance of sustainability in climate and in relation to personnel.

226  SITUATION ANALYSIS

Challenges in food distribution: the Barika story

An African perspective on distribution Sub-Saharan Africa is often heralded as an important future growth area. With the rise of an African middle class, spending power also increases, creating growth opportunities that are increasingly difficult to reach in the saturated European or American markets. But, in order to be successful, knowledge of distribution structure is of the highest importance: in order to sell, it is essential to reach the consumer! The Western shopper is used to buying food in supermarkets, operating under familiar names like Wal-Mart, Carrefour, or Tesco. This is where we spent the bulk of our money. But we easily forget that this pattern isn’t the same everywhere. In sub-Saharan countries in Africa, big chains have a substantial lower relevance, often being virtually non-existent. Nielsen retail sales data show that some 40% of African consumers shop in small, local grocery stores, or ‘dukas’. These dukas account for nearly 50% of consumer goods spend. The average duka, often only a few square meters, is loaded with a wide variety of goods and often forms the center of a community. But this is not even the most relevant channel. The most common African shopping channel is the table top: a stall set up at the side of the road or in the local market to capture local and passing trade. In a recent Nielsen study of sub-Saharan countries, it was found that 80% of consumers shopped from table tops. For instance, in a country such as Nigeria, there are no less than 200,000 table tops. At the duka, Africans tend to spend a lot more than during each visit than at the table-top. But this doesn’t make the duka more relevant. An important factor is the frequency of visit: con-

DISTRIBUTION AND SUPPLIER ANALYSIS 227

sumers tend to shop less frequently in dukas, as stores can be hard to get to without transport. In contrast, they often visit a table top or kiosk daily for smaller, top-up quantities, buying basics like toilet paper or bananas. Shopping patterns also differ by country. In Madagascar, a Nielsen survey showed consumers went shopping 70 times a month on average – this is more than twice a day! – while in Kenya, the average was 38. At the table top, consumers are familiar with both the vendor and the products, and the products are helpfully sold in decanted or single servings and in rounded denominations (e.g., 100 shillings in Kenya or 1,000 CFA francs in Burkina Faso). So while the shop itself may be no more than a table or countertop, its products unbranded, and the product range small – many might sell no more than four different items – these outlets perfectly meet consumers’ needs. They offer familiar goods at the desired price and size, they offer convenience, and they are trusted. Numbers give an average picture. Companies need to identify the best channels and retailers for their product category. In Lagos (Nigeria), for instance, Nielsen found laundry detergents in distribution in no less than 100,000 outlets, an impossibly large number to reach. But further analysis showed that 80% of the sales value came from just 35,000 of those outlets and a full 50% from a more manageable 10,000. Similarly, in the same city, beverages are sold in 61,000 outlets, but only 24,000 of those outlets generate 80% of sales. But still, how to reach even the most effective dukas and table tops in an efficient manner? Getting close to the retailer in order to build distribution to support sales in such a fragmented retail market is a huge undertaking, particularly for international manufacturers lacking in local knowledge. Moreover, it is only the final stage of a meticulous process. First manufacturers need to understand who shops where and for what; then they must identify the best retail outlets for a given product, and then they can turn to helping retailers build demand. Companies also need to consider how to help build demand in an environment where consumers on limited budgets are ultra-cautious about trying new products. Consumers continue to show a powerful preference for products they know, have tried before, or have had recommended to them – not surprising in an environment where budgets are tight and a disappointing purchase is an expensive loss. But the creation of brand awareness and familiarity, a crucial step in introducing new products to the market, is a huge challenge. Small retailers have little or no display space, shopper loyalty is often to local manufacturers, and premium-priced branded packages are often split open and sold in unbranded singles or servings to meet consumers’ needs. So, in a market where brand familiarity and recommendations from others are strong purchase drivers, how can you start with a new product that by definition does not have any familiarity or recommendations? A close understanding of how smaller, traditional retailers operate is key for the right approach to building sales. For instance, a table-top vendor selling a small range of everyday basics will often stock only a very narrow range of products. With no transport and limited or no storage, the vendor will probably not visit even one distributor or wholesaler. Instead, everything is brought to the stall either on a bicycle or boda boda (cargo-carrying motorcycle), in a motor vehicle, or perhaps

228  SITUATION ANALYSIS

even on a pushcart or by foot. Sometimes it is a wholesaler who drops off supplies, sometimes another retailer; often, there is no record of what are all cash transactions. Airtime, cigarettes, and sodas may be delivered as often as three to five times a day. Other goods, such as gum, sweets, biscuits, or analgesics, might be delivered every three days. The vendors are masters at adapting their offerings to meet consumers’ immediate needs, which change at various points during their day. In the morning, the commuting consumer may stop for breakfast – ready-made tea served from a flask, freshly squeezed juice, slices of bread, a cooked sausage, a single teabag, and a serving of sugar – even super glue for fixing a broken shoe. All of this must be understood by a manufacturer that wants to introduce its product to the table top market and develop its success, particularly because it is the vendor and not a wholesaler intermediary that will make the ultimate decision. Meeting consumers’ needs in this environment means not only being timely but also thinking about the required pack size, format, affordability, and denomination. If a branded packet is too expensive, the retailer may open the pack, split it into smaller ones, and sell it unbranded, resulting in profit for the manufacturer but weaker brand identity. Sometimes, it’s the small things that have the potential to drive success. A number of these small suggestions to stimulate brand identity in the African market: n Repackaging and branding products into single servings or at least smaller sizes n Providing branded packaging such as wrappers or sachets that retailers can

use if they spilt up larger portions

n Branding the selling vessel, for example, the basin from which water sachets

are sold

n Providing branded cooler boxes for table-top vendors to sell products which

require refrigeration

n Providing small, portable display stands for kiosk vendors to stack products

and add visibility

n Branding re-usable product packaging or containers for top-ups and repur-

chases

n Providing free samples appropriate to the time of day and the way the outlet

is used. Each table top can be seen as a location to trial new products with no risk to either the vendor or the consumer.

Barika Barika is a medium-sized distributor in Burkina Faso, a francophone country in Western Africa. The company profiles with the following mission statement: African urban societies are experiencing a social change that is reflected in a more individualized food experience. Styles and aspirations are diversifying while traditional community channels are showing more and more their limits. In order to overcome these changes, Barika proposes to facilitate access to quality essential products in partnership with local actors and committed suppliers.

DISTRIBUTION AND SUPPLIER ANALYSIS 229

According to its website, Barika offers an innovative distribution network based on: a triple principle of modernity, accessibility, quality a wide range of products, emphasizing attractive products with social impact a brand that caters to all, including the low-income segment innovative products, previously unavailable on the market, to enrich the local offer n collaboration with a wide variety of fully involved stakeholders n n n n

The company promises a quality commitment: n n n n

a guarantee of quality to give consumers the assurance of healthy products a stable price guarantee support to suppliers in improving their local distribution quality of service: personalized support for customers in the choice and use of products

And proposes to work with a network of partners n committed suppliers n local stakeholders in the field of health, childhood, and so on n animation offers proposed in collaboration with our partners

Interview With the Strategic Manager of Barika Question: Can you tell me something about Barika? Barika is a brand specialized in distribution of innovative products. We aim at good products that are not too expensive. With a focus on local quality products. We get our products directly from the producer, or through an intermediary. Barika has its own shops, 2 boutiques located in Ouagadougou (the capital of Burkina Faso). We also distribute to a number of small shops and table-tops. These small shops and table-tops currently account for most of our sales. We serve them with two sales people, but many owners of shops and table-tops come to our boutiques to buy the goods they want, Q: What is the role of the Barika store? A strong local store is a proof of quality. We want to use the shop to increase the awareness of the Barika brand, so that the owners of the small shops will come to us. Q: But why do you prefer the small shops to come to you? Wouldn’t it be better if you go to the small shops? A push strategy seems to make more sense than a pull strategy in our market. Going directly to the small shops and the table-tops is very hard work as they

230  SITUATION ANALYSIS

are disseminated all over Ouagadougou with approximately 3 000 selling points. Currently, as I mentioned before, we have only two sales people in our own service. That is why our primary focus is on making Barika a strong and trusted retail brand. Then the shop- and top-owners will come to us, instead of we to them! Q: How important is relation management in the Burkina Faso market? Very important. Work is not efficient without good relations. There is also a strong hierarchy issue – people are not really saying what they think: they will say yes in order to keep the relation, even if they mean no. The ideal sales person is someone that used to be a respected retailer with a well-established network. We are still looking for the ideal. Q: I want to talk about one of the products you distribute: Grandibien. Can you say something about the product? Grandibien is a product against chronic malnutrition. It targets pregnant women, as well as young children, in a couple of age categories. Awareness of the Grandibien brand is still limited. The target group doesn’t know it too well. Currently it is available in 150 shops, mainly smaller ones. But there is a potential of 3000 sales points for this type of product in Ouagadougou and way more in the whole country, so there is still a lot of work to do. We found that kids like Grandibien. The sales price is relatively high, due to the high quality ingredients. It pays off, as a healthy diet prevents medical costs due to malnutrition issues. But it’s hard to convince our target of the importance of prevention of malnutrition. Prevention awareness is a global issue in the world anyway. Q: African consumers are known to be ultra-cautious about trying new products. What is your experience with Grandibien? Yes, consumers are very faithful and loyal. They trust big brands such as Nescafé, but above all they trust the person that sells them the product. But consumers here are also curious. We noticed that they try Grandibien, but we need to create more awareness around the brand and the benefits of prevention to create a rebuy.

Questions 1 2 3

Draft a global distribution structure for a consumer product in the sub-Saharan market, for instance, for a product such as laundry detergent in the Nigerian market. A distribution analysis can be executed on three levels of aggregation. For which of these levels does the Barika interview provide useful information? Explain your answer. Is Barika a wholesaler or a retailer? Explain your answer.

DISTRIBUTION AND SUPPLIER ANALYSIS 231

4

The manager states that ‘A push strategy seems to make more sense than a pull strategy’. a Explain what the manager means with this statement. b Do you agree that in the sub-Saharan market, a push strategy makes – in general – more sense than a pull strategy? Explain your answer c What is your opinion on the solution of the push/pull issue as proposed by Barika? 5 The choice for a focus on the Barika shop (a choice on macro level) seems to be partly driven by issues in the salesforce (micro level). Do you agree that micro-level issues should drive macro-level choices? Why (not)? 6 A distribution channel can be long, short, or direct. How would you describe the distribution channel in which Barika is operating? 7 Describe the current distribution intensity of Grandibien. 8 Consider the information about Grandibien: which distribution intensity would you advise for Grandibien? 9 How would you advise Barika to realize this distribution intensity for Grandibien?

Chapter 9

SWOT analysis

DOI: 10.4324/9781003381488-11

SWOT analysis 233

Key points in this chapter n Know the steps in a SWOT analysis n Be able to summarize a situation analysis into a focused problem statement n Discuss alternative positioning options

Introduction In the earlier phases of the strategic marketing planning process, an internal and an external analysis were completed. This is called a situation analysis. In this chapter we describe how the insights from the situation analysis can be summarized and what steps can be taken to come to strategic decisions. The tool reviewed is the SWOT analysis, where SWOT stands for strengths, weaknesses, opportunities, and threats. This chapter is structured as follows: 1 2 3 4 5

Definitions and forecasting (Section 9.1). Summarize the situation analysis in a SWOT list (Section 9.2). Formulate a vision of the environment and the core challenge (Section 9.3). SWOT matrix and options (Section 9.4). Selection of a marketing strategy (Section 9.5). 

9.1 Definitions and forecasting methods Before moving on to the steps in SWOT analysis, let’s discuss two general guidelines: the need for clear definitions and the need for a future perspective (and forecasting methods).

9.1.1 Definitions First we define what should be understood by strengths, weaknesses, opportunities, and threats. A good definition of this is necessary, because otherwise determining it can lead to misunderstandings. We focus on three properties: 1

2

The difference between strengths and weaknesses on the one hand and opportunities and threats on the other. Strengths and weaknesses are internal: they relate to the brand for which a marketing plan is being made. Opportunities and threats are external: they relate to the environment and would exist even if the brand in question were not there. For example, a ‘good image (measured with customers)’ is a strength and, despite the fact that it comes from the customer analysis, is not an ‘opportunity’. The difference between an opportunity and a threat. The difference between an opportunity and a threat is that a opportunity is a positive development with unchanged policy and a threat a negative development. We add the condition of unchanged policy, because, as is often said, ‘there are no threats because a company can respond to anything’. If the company opts for this – in itself justified – starting

234  Situation analysis

3

point, there is no tenable distinction between opportunities and threats, and it is better to speak of issues or external points for attention. So we do make a distinction. For example, a downturn can be an opportunity for a quality product if the brand is able to lower the price. Nevertheless, we regard this as a threat, because if policy remains unchanged, there will be an unfavorable impact. The difference between opportunities and strategies. One difference between opportunities and strategies is that a strategy is something a brand does and an opportunity is not. For example, ‘developing a peanut-flavored beer for young people’ is not an opportunity but a possible strategy. The underlying probability may be: ‘expected growing demand among young people for specialty beers’. Another example: ‘rejuvenating a brand’ is not an opportunity but a response to the weakness ‘old-fashioned image’. The latter often goes wrong with SWOT analyses: all kinds of ideas are called ‘opportunities’, which is actually incorrect: they are ‘options’.

Finally, in this book we sometimes used the terms relative strengths and weaknesses, by which we mean that they are strong or weak not only in general but also with respect to the competition: that is, comparatively. Relative strengths can be determined by comparing the ‘absolute’ strengths and weaknesses (partly derived from the internal analysis) with those of competitors (derived from the competitor analysis).

9.1.2  Forecasting methods A marketing plan, by definition, concerns the future, for example, for one year or, if it concerns a strategic marketing plan, for example, three years. This means that a manager must identify future opportunities and threats. Developments that have occurred in the past are not really important. One problem is that no one knows for sure what will happen tomorrow. A manager will still have to make her own predictions. She can often make use of forecasts from research agencies or government institutions. A manager should not only predict environmental developments. Forecasts of sales should also be made so that financial projections can be incorporated into the marketing plan (see Section 14.3). Because predictions in a marketing plan are important, we now provide some guidelines for choosing a forecasting method. We base ourselves largely on Armstrong (2001). There are two types of prediction methods: n Objective forecasting methods. Forecasts are calculated in one way or another so

that if someone else applies the same method, they will also get the same result (replicability). These methods require quantitative data (data) and sometimes some statistical knowledge. Examples: trend extrapolation and causal regression models. n Subjective prediction methods. The best possible prediction is made ‘in the head’ of a researcher/expert or customer. Hard, quantitative data can also be used, but this is not necessary. The essence is that a prognosis is arrived at in an ‘implicit manner’. In fact, it involves two methods: ‘opinion research’ (expert prediction) and ‘intention research’ (asking customers in a sample of how likely it is that they will buy the new product). Examples of intention research outside of marketing are political polls: research into who voters intend to vote for. In everyday parlance this

SWOT analysis 235

is often referred to as ‘opinion polls’, which is very confusing because voters are not ‘experts’ but ‘consumers’. Subjective methods are not replicable. One day an expert or a consumer with the same information can give a different opinion than on another day. Repetition does not therefore give exactly the same result. A lot of research has been done into when which methods are best. For example, an important factor is whether ‘circumstances are expected to change significantly’. Objective methods are by definition based on patterns from the past and therefore seem less suitable for predicting trend breaks, for example. However, subjective methods are not always suitable either. For example, people have a natural tendency to anchoring: sticking to familiar situations and underestimating what can change (see Case 9.1).

9.2 Step 1: summary of the situation analysis In principle, the situation analysis produces a large list of strengths, weaknesses, opportunities, and threats. Some of them are important, others less important. In addition, some are related. To keep the follow-up analysis clear, the situation analysis should be summarized in a limited number of strengths, weaknesses, opportunities, and threats. We provide the following practical tips (Dibb et al., 2003): n Include only the most important factors (issues). Always limit the number to a

maximum of five (so a maximum of five strengths, five opportunities, and so on).

n Rank the points in order of importance. n Ensure that there is sufficient supporting evidence (research) for each point. n Strengths and weaknesses should preferably be relative, that is, in relation to

competitors.

n Do not confuse strengths with opportunities, threats with opportunities, or opportu-

nities with strategies (see definitions in Section 9.1.1).

The most pronounced issues therefore form the starting point for the further SWOT analysis. The choice of what is relevant requires a high degree of attentiveness and creativity – attentiveness because one can certainly assume that competitors also signal the most obvious opportunities, and the difference can be precisely in less obvious ‘brackets’. Creativity is also important: one must be able to sense what an opportunity might be. Actually, the goal of the entire SWOT analysis is: to find a ‘golden hook’. Popularly speaking, a ‘big idea’ can be enough for a profitable strategy. That hook or idea can often be found by listening very carefully to customers and not only paying attention to things that customers like but especially to what they don’t like. Figure 9.1 summarizes the result of this sub-step and follows the guidelines from Section 9.1.1 (we use the abbreviation SWOTs).

9.3 Step 2: vision of the environment and core challenge After and in addition to the summary of the situation analysis, a further reduction of the situation analysis is desirable. The reason for this is that the company can then make even

236  Situation analysis

Case 9.1 Prediction is also difficult for experts

Major forecasting errors leading to global changes It would be no exaggeration to say that 2016 was the year in which global opinion polls plummeted. Not only was Brexit not predicted at the time, a flaw in the forecasts was also the completely surprising election of Trump as president of the United States. Besides the difference between intent and behavior, another cause of these massive forecasting errors is that the sample in polls does not always closely match the actual voting population. For example, a relatively large number of votes against (i.e. for exit) showed up for Brexit, and it was easily demonstrable afterwards that the result would have been the other way around if the voter turnout were representative. In the meantime, in 2023, it has been shown that Brexit was indeed harmful for all stakeholders. In any case, this is an important disadvantage of referenda: the result is strongly influenced by mood swings and the associated turnout. A referendum is therefore very popular with the more populist parties and should therefore be abolished as a democratic instrument.

SWOT analySiS

For marketing purposes, the conclusion is that with consumer behavior becoming increasingly erratic, predicting consumer behavior is becoming increasingly difficult. Another problem with prediction (especially with subjective methods) is that there is often a difference between intention and behavior. We already mentioned this in Chapter 1 under sustainable behavior. People say they want to behave sustainably but often don’t. And the political predictions mentioned previously often go wrong as well. A factor here is that people ultimately make choices based on feeling and ‘unconsciously’, which can be different than if you ask ‘rationally’. A general conclusion from research into the correctness of forecasts is that combining different forecasting methods yields the best prediction (this is called eclectic research). Armstrong (2001) therefore recommends that instead of putting a lot of energy into one method, it is better to put less energy into a few methods. Preferably, therefore, both an objective and a subjective method should be used. Finally, the question is how a researcher should come to one prediction if he uses different methods. This point has also been examined in the literature. The surprising conclusion is that simply the (unweighted) average gives the best result. We end with an example. Suppose an entrepreneur has an idea for a new product. Before taking out a loan to the bank, she must show a forecast of the expected sales over the next five years and must in any case be able to estimate the market potential. Then she could apply the following steps: 1

2 3 4

She conducts an intention survey in which she asks a representative group of men and women how likely it is that they would buy the described product for a certain price. For both segments, she takes the ‘will definitely buy’ category and calculates the number of buyers accordingly. Benchmarking: she looks at how comparable products have performed and uses this as a basis for a forecast. The problem here is always the degree of comparability. She makes expert forecasts (opinion research). She is looking for four carefully chosen objective external experts and asks them to make a prediction. She combines the three predictions by calculating an average.

Certain future developments may be very uncertain and at the same time very decisive. In the example of the entrepreneur, this could be the possible arrival of a competitor with the same product. In that case, scenarios are used. A scenario is a description of a possible environmental situation. For example, the entrepreneur in the example formulates two scenarios: ‘there will be no competitor in the next five years’ and ‘there will be a competitor from the start’. The most likely scenario is chosen, and the alternative can be included in an appendix to the plan. A scenario is not a forecasting method: it is a way of dealing with uncertainty.

237

238  Situation analysis Key Strengths and Weaknesses (SW)*

Key Areas of Interest (Future OTs )*

S1

Strong position among

O1 Increasing need for quality photos

professionals

O2 Economic growth

S2

Good at quality and innovation

O3 Customers rely more on in-store advice

S3

Many possibilities

O4 Cameras still pay little attention to style

S4

Good relationship with shops

O5 Competitors are not specialized

S5

Specialist in photography

W1

High cost and price

T1 Improvement photo quality smartphones

W2

Low market share among

T2 Growing need for convenience

consumers

T3 Growth of Instagram

W3

Brand awareness relatively low

T4 Stronger competition in user - friendly

W4

Not very easy to use

W5

No brand extensions

cameras T5 Competition (e.g. Canon) has much wider range (printers, PCs, cameras and so on)

Figure 9.1  Selection SWOTs (example digital camera manufacturer) * In total, a maximum of 10 internal and 10 external items

better choices with regard to what is or is not important. What really matters here is that the company develop a view on the environment, that is, a short and concise statement about what management considers important in the environment of the brand. For this, a manager can refer to the format of the external analysis: n n n n

the customer analysis the industry analysis the competitor analysis the distribution and supplier analysis

For each of these components, the question is: which future development or trend does the manager consider most important? This is often related to the customer analysis. Does management think there will be more or less need for simplicity in cameras in the future? Such an opinion has major consequences for the strategy choices. To achieve the best possible focus, it is advisable to draw some kind of conclusion about the problem and the cause from the situation analysis. A marketing goal can also be set, for example, a market share to be achieved. If that goal is then compared to the situation of ‘no change in policy’ and a gap is expected (‘gap analysis’), then something has to change in a company’s strategy. The performance analysis (see Section 4.2) has given a first impression of where possible problems lie. For instance: n that the marketing objective (such as a certain market share) of a new brand X has

not been achieved

n that this was mainly caused by a disappointing percentage of repeat purchases n that the cause should not be sought in the implementation of the planned strategy,

because there was no significant difference between planned and actual implementation

SWOT analysis 239

This problem recognition is obviously not enough. The question remains: What are the specific causes of the disappointing results? Or, more broadly formulated: For which ‘core marketing problem’ should this marketing plan provide a solution? The answer to this question is best given as the capstone of the summary of the SWOTs. After all, all possible relevant internal and environmental factors have been analyzed in this phase. Problems are often a combination of internal and external factors. As a matter of fact, we already point out that the problem conclusion is presented much earlier in the marketing plan itself, namely in the first plan chapter (see Section 2.5). A solid foundation is important for the core problem. An example of a core problem in practice is that brand identity and brand image do not correspond: the brand wants to have certain associations, but the target group does not see them. This happens a lot, sometimes more than managers realize. For example, it is often said that a brand is ‘very strong, because the reputation is enormous’. But image is also important. If an image moves in the direction of ‘trusted, known from the past’, there is a danger (prognosis) that it will move in the direction of ‘old-fashioned, old-fashioned’. Does the company want that or not? A critical interpretation of the situation analysis is therefore desirable. In this phase, a forecast can also be given of what is expected with unchanged policy: a forecast of sales and profit if nothing is changed in the strategy. Naturally, subjectivity also plays a major role here, and the marketing plan to be developed will have to lead to a better result. An advantage of such a prediction is that it can underline the need for change. Incidentally, this is also often stated in the context of change management: the first step in a change management process is awareness of the need for change. And the best awareness is the belief that if the company continues on the same footing, it will lead to disastrous or at least unsuccessful results. If we combine this with the vision of the environment, we can give an example for the manufacturer of photo cameras (Case 9.2).

9.4 Step 3: marketing strategic options The aim of this crucial third step of the SWOT analysis is to arrive at possible strategies (‘options’) from the SWOTs. Here, therefore, a connection is made between the analysis and strategy phases. Although a SWOT analysis is well known in itself, authors use different methods to make this connection. We come up with our own way of doing that in this book. First, we argue which choices we make in this phase. Next, we’ll work this out for the example of the digital camera manufacturer.

9.4.1  Features of the SWOT approach in this book We make the following choices in the SWOT analysis: 1 2 3

The goal in this phase is to define marketing strategic options and not to come up with all sorts of tactical ideas. It is important to be innovative and also to be able to think out of the box. Because of the necessary mental space to be creative, we allow sufficient freedom in the connection between analysis and options and therefore do not come up with a detailed weighting method to ‘calculate’ an option.

240  Situation analysis

Case 9.2 Development of a vision on the environment and core challenge

Vision of camera manufacturer In the market for cameras in Argentina, we see our market share fall to 2.1% in 2022. The main cause of this is the competition with increasingly good cameras in smartphones. Our goal is to increase the market share to 2.4% over the next three years. We expect that the need for quick photos via social media will continue to grow and that our competitors will respond well to this. Our image is that we deliver top-quality cameras, but also that our user friendliness is not as good as that of the competitors. If policy remains unchanged, our market share will continue to fall.

1 Think in terms of marketing strategy A central point in this book is that choosing a brand positioning is the core of the marketing strategy. So it makes sense to focus on that right from the SWOT. In marketing practice, people often take too little time to think carefully about brand positioning. And it is precisely the brand positioning that should be the reason people buy one brand and not another. This part of the brainstorming process is therefore very important. When applying the SWOT analysis, it is tempting to immediately brainstorm about tactical ideas. Suppose a weakness is: ‘little presence on social media’. How logical is it, then, to consider that an option is: ‘become more active on social media’? But such choices can only be made after the formulation of the marketing strategy. For a practical example, see Case 9.3.

SWOT analysis 241

Case 9.3 Strategy development

How to develop a positioning for Lipton in Asia Although a long time ago, this interview with Tex Gunning of Unilever Foods Asia at the time says a lot about strategy development in practice. ‘We now conduct all major market research in large collective processes. The numbers come back and then we lock ourselves up for three or four days. Then we work our way through all the ups and downs of such a process, but after that it is also a collectively supported positioning. It produces a lot of frustration, but you end up with a conclusion that you would never have come up with one or two other smart people. Consumers and their relationship with a brand are so complicated that as a marketer you cannot do it alone. We are going to think about that every time with ten, twenty or thirty people and we are going to work on it. And we’ll do it again in four months until the positioning of the brand is clear and relevant’. Gunning gives Lipton tea as an example. ‘Sounds simple, but everyone sells tea in China. I’ve been working on it for two and a half years and it’s only been two weeks since we think we’ve really got it. What we’re sitting on with Lipton is this: Young Asians know the future is theirs. Those economies are so big and the political influence of the Chinese is growing so fast that the collective self-consciousness becomes infinite. You get a whole group of young people who want to ride that wave. With that in mind, we positioned Lipton as: bright and vital outlook on life. That means you have to do more than just sell tea’.

242  Situation analysis

2  Be creative and innovative It is advisable in this phase when formulating ideas not (yet) to be completely guided by existing preconditions, such as the company’s vision or financial constraints. In the first instance, any strategy is possible, including outside the current activities. It is very important to be creative. Of course, it must then be examined whether a strategy is realistic, but that is part of the last fourth step of the SWOT analysis. Creative thinking can be performed in different ways. Aaker (2013) provides the following guidelines for creativity: 1 2 3 4 5 6

Do it in groups, because diversity increases the number of different ideas. Do ‘warm up exercises’ before you start the creative session, for example, taking turns making up a sentence in a story. Define a clear goal of the session, such as finding a suitable extension for the brand. Do not pass judgment on ideas, but generate alternatives. Try to think laterally, for example, by asking the question ‘What do we need to do to achieve . . .?’ instead of ‘Yes, but that’s not feasible because . . . ’ At a later stage, judge the ideas not only factually but also based on feeling.

The brainstorming phase of the SWOT analysis is crucial and therefore requires an important degree of creativity and empathy. The ideas that are conceived must be as concrete as possible. For example, it makes little sense to include vague ideas such as ‘increase market share’, ‘better respond to customer needs’, ‘diversify’, ‘reposition’, and so on. At the very least, it should be added how exactly the company could do that. To get as many ideas as possible about possible strategies, it is advisable to organize brainstorming sessions. Various representatives from the company should be involved: designers, production personnel, intermediaries (such as sales representatives), and top management. A brainstorming session can consist of the following steps: 1 2

3

The participants are first informed about the results of the SWOT analysis itself (the most important Ss, Ws, Os, and Ts). Then they think along about possible strategies. From a marketing point of view, the most important discussion point to address is brand positioning. Questions that can be asked are: n What is the brand awareness like and what are the brand associations that the target group has now? n To what extent is this in line with the brand identity? Then they try to come up with a few alternatives, for example, three. For each alternative, the internal and external issues on which the idea is based are indicated in brackets. It does make a difference whether one thinks from a strength or weakness point of view. Strengths provide starting points for a competitive advantage; weaknesses are more likely to result in a defensive (defensive) strategy. Incidentally, that does not necessarily have to be the case; even a weakness can be quickly eliminated by cooperating with a strong partner, thus forming the basis for an offensive strategy.

SWOT analysis 243

Case 9.4  Innovation

Product innovation or marketing strategy: What comes first? ‘Innovate or die’ is a phrase often used to describe the approach brands must take to stay ahead in an ultra-competitive market characterized by rapidly changing consumer demand. However, the way companies go about driving new product development depends very much on their structure, priorities, and where marketing sits within the innovation journey. Marketing’s influence is key to ensuring new offerings fit with a strategy determined by customers’ needs, so companies aren’t stuck trying to sell something for which there is no demand. But brands have to balance being insight driven with being able to launch products that no focus group would ever think to suggest. FMCG companies such as Unilever perform all kinds of qualitative and quantitative research and use these as input in product innovation. Innovation is central to marketing’s role within any organization, according to HP global chief marketing and communications director, Antonio Lucio. But he recognizes the approach differs depending on the category. So while in FMCG, the fundamental premise is that the ‘customer is king’, in a technology business like HP, the goal is to create products consumers have never even dreamed about. This means marketing is responsible for bringing invention to life from a consumer experience standpoint. Source: Adapted from Marketing Week, 15 May 2018

244  Situation analysis

The following applies at every step: be creative and interpret each signal carefully and based on your own possibilities. Being innovative also means taking possible new activities into account as much as possible. It is true that these may fall outside the existing market, but signals for this can certainly be obtained from an analysis of the current market. Following the example of the digital camera manufacturer (Case 9.2 and Figure 9.1), examples of signals that could lead to innovations are: n Unmet needs: wishes and desires of existing customers that cannot be met with

n n

n

n

the current products. An analysis of complaints can also be helpful here. The main source of ideas is: listening to customers creatively! Example: developing a digital camera that does have a good battery, including an indicator that – when the battery is almost empty – does not jump from full to empty in one go. New customer groups that are currently not being targeted. Example: children’s cameras. Developments in the macro environment that could have a favorable impact on other markets. Example: the aging population, which can be a reason to produce extra-convenient cameras. The expected development of substitute products within the industry structure factors. Example: the emergence of mobile telephones with a camera function, which may be a reason to become active in that market as well. What are competitors doing outside their core activities? Example: producing copying machines.

In order to make the best possible selection process possible, it is advisable to come up with not one but, for example, three possible alternatives. Then, of course, one must be chosen. Formulating a number of options explicitly, instead of opting for a strategy at a certain level ‘at once’, based on a situation analysis, has the following reasons: n It forces the manager to think about paths other than those already taken. n If only one option is presented, it is more difficult to gain support in the company

for the ‘choice’.

3  Make a flexible connection with the SWOTs The ultimate connection between the SWOTs and the strategic options should be replicable and provide sufficient creative scope. We consider the latter more important than the former. What almost all authors agree on is that there should be a confrontation matrix: in a 2 × 2 matrix, the Ss and the Ws, are in two rows and the Os and the Ts in two columns, and in the four quadrants (SO, ST, WO, WT) come ideas/strategies. Weihrich (1982) also makes a matrix and proposes numbering all strengths, weaknesses, opportunities, and threats (for example, S2, O3) and then generating ideas per quadrant, indicating which SWOTs are appropriate for each idea. The beauty of this is that it is traceable which SWOTs are linked to which strategies (and vice versa).

SWOT analysis 245

Other authors link general directives to the four quadrants as ‘attack’ (SO), ‘defend’ (ST), ‘fortify’ (WO), or ‘withdraw’ (WT). There are also approaches that go even further in structure. For example, it is sometimes proposed to first insert an intermediate phase in which, for each combination of an internal and external point, it is indicated with pluses and minuses how promising that combination is. Subsequently, it can be ‘calculated’ what the most promising combination is, after which ideas can be devised that fit it (see, for example, Hummel, 2012). A disadvantage of this method is that in our opinion it is ‘too analytical’: it is suggested that a strategy can be logically ‘derived’ from the SWOTs. This does not work in practice, and we observe that a manager never chooses a mechanical method for strategy development. In general, a situation analysis is carried out, but one never works with weighting of opportunities and so on in order to arrive at a strategy choice. What does happen and is sensible is brainstorming: empathizing with and understanding the results of the situation analysis, discussing, brainstorming, thinking, brainstorming again, and so on (see also Case 9.3). This approach is considered fruitful and has the advantage that it can be carried out by a number of people at the same time. What we propose is a variant of Weihrich ‘s approach, with two changes: 1

Ideas are not searched per quadrant but across all SWOTs. After all, it may be the case that both strengths are available for a certain positioning and that weaknesses need to be strengthened. In short: we let go of the quadrants, also because of the next point. 2 The recommendation is to arrive at a coherent marketing strategy and not with various other tactical recommendations.

9.4.2  SWOT matrix Figure 9.2 shows the proposed approach. Our approach may not be exactly a matrix, but for convenience, we’ll call it a SWOT matrix anyway. Figure 9.2 shows an elaboration for the positioning. An elaboration is also possible towards segmentation and target groups. Suppose the segmentation analysis (see Section 5.2) shows that six segments can be distinguished, each with its own wishes and preferences. Then three alternative target groups could be mentioned here, for example: n segment of professionals n segment of children and young people up to the age of 20 n segment of the elderly over 65

With a choice for one of these groups, the T of STP (‘segmenting, targeting, positioning’) is fulfilled. As the last step in the selection process, a choice must be made.

9.5 Step 4: selection of a marketing strategy In this section we discuss three steps. Section 9.5.1 deals with assessing options on the basis of a number of criteria. Subsequently, in Section 9.5.2, we look at the forecasts

246  Situation analysis O1 Increasing need for quality photos O2 Economic growth O3 Customers rely more on in-store advice O4 Cameras still pay little attention to style O5 Competitors are not specialized

T1 Improvement photo quality smartphones T2 Growing need for convenience T3 Growth of Instagram T4 Stronger competition in user-friendly cameras T5 Competition (e.g. Canon) has much wider range (printers, PCs, cameras and so on)

S1

Strong position among professionals

S2

Good at quality and innovation

Alternative marketing strategies for the next three years •

Repositioning towards user-friendliness (W2, W5, T2,

T4) •

Strengthening quality aspect (S1, S2, S3, S5, W1,

S3

Many possibilities

O1, O2, T1)

S4

Good relationship



with shops

Introduction of a user-friendly and stylish sub-brand

(S4, W4, O4, T2, T4, T5)

S5 Specialist in photography W1 High cost and price W2 Low market share among consumers W3

Brand awareness relatively low

W4 Limited distribution W5 No brand extensions

Figure 9.2 SWOT matrix

and considerations in the option choice. Finally, we show how the net present value of a strategy can be estimated (Section 9.5.3).

9.5.1 Criteria when assessing options In an approach that is as systematic as possible, ideally each option should be assessed against a number of criteria. Each company can choose its own criteria. Ultimately, expected profit is, of course, a very important one. But that is often difficult to predict. It is also important whether a strategy is feasible. Finally, a strategy must fit within the company’s DNA. Figure 9.3 shows possible criteria for each alternative that can be taken into account when selecting a strategy. This is followed by an explanation of these criteria.

SWOT analySiS

Criterion 1: fit with vision Does the option match the vision ( value strategy ), is the core problem solved?



Criterion 2: feasibility Is the option feasible internally? (preconditions FOETSLE) Financial: to what extent are there sufficient financial resources to implement the strategy? Organizational: does the strategy fit into the organization? Is implementation organizationally possible? Economic: is the strategy in line with the company's economic objectives? Technical: is the implementation of the strategy technically possible? Social: is the strategy socially acceptable? In this context, the company's social objectives should also be considered. Legal: are there no legal problems to be expected (e.g. in the context of trademark law)? Ecological: is the strategy ecologically sound (environmentally)? Ecological: is the strategy sustainable?



Criterion 3: results and risks Expected achievement of the objectives: are the results acceptable to the internal stakeholders (in particular: expected profitability, payback period and associated risks)? Figure 9.3 The selection process of the marketing strategy

Suitability An initial assessment of the strategic options concerns the extent to which an option fits: n n n

the higher levels of strategy (vision, corporate strategy) the solution of the core problem (if not already done) the most important issues in the external and internal environment

For example, a company may have come to the conclusion, based on customer research, that there is a market for significantly cheaper products. However, if the company has not opted for the low price brand benefit, offering low-cost products may not fit the brand identity. In that case, the company is not doing what some customers would ideally like. This is in line with our understanding of the role of marketing as an intermediary between the customer and the brand. From the assessment of the appropriateness of options, it may be concluded that various options are satisfactory (see Figure 9.4).

Feasibility Each option that may be suitable is then compared to a number of internal preconditions. Testing on the basis of the seven preconditions (FOETSLE; see Figure 9.4) provides insight into the feasibility: is it possible to implement the option in question?

247

248  Situation analysis

Suitability

Feasibility

Expected profit and risk

Option 1







Option 2







Option 3







Choice:

Figure 9.4  The selection of a marketing strategy

Results and risks The company must make a choice from the options that remain after selection based on the preconditions. This selection is done on the basis of objectives. These can be business or marketing objectives. Business objectives are usually financial in nature (profit, payback period, etc.; see Section 10.1); marketing objectives often relate to sales or market share (see Section 11.1). Profit and market share are not always aligned: with a high marketing budget, a high market share can be ‘bought’. Also sustainability goals should be considered. Which of the objectives is decisive depends on the internal and external situation in which the marketing plan is written.

9.5.2  Forecasts and considerations in the selection process When market share or sales is the selection criterion, one must make a forecast of the expected sales for each option. Although this forecasting always remains a highly precarious business, the forecasting methods we described in Section 9.1 can be helpful in this respect. The option with the highest expected market share is then chosen. Often, however, financial objectives are decisive: the option that is expected to earn the most money is preferred. A financial selection criterion implies that the profit contribution of each option must be predicted over a range of years. This means that the sales forecast referred to previously must be supplemented with (assumptions about) the required investments, among other things. Because this can in fact only be done after, for example, a communication plan has also been made, we (also) pay attention to this in the last chapter of the book (see Section 14.2). In addition to the expected revenues and costs, the expected risk plays a major role. In the eventual choice of options, the company must therefore weigh up the expected returns, risks, and investments required immediately and investments required in the long term. Crucial in this list are the expected returns: forecasting methods are needed to determine these. When it comes to financial objectives, a commonly used simple criterion is the payback period: how quickly are the investments required ‘now’ recovered? The management can also set a maximum for this, for example, four years. A somewhat more advanced way of comparing alternatives is the shareholder value analysis, a method of determining the ‘present value’ of a strategy. The idea behind the shareholder value analysis is: a strategy can be regarded as an investment that produces a certain future cash flow. If one calculates the expected cash flow back to the point in time ‘now’ by means of discounting, the expected shareholder value can be calculated. The

SWOT analysis 249

selection criterion that is used here is therefore entirely financial in nature and actually relates to the value that a strategy has for the shareholders. After all, shareholders can choose from various options when investing capital, and they will in principle opt for the option with the highest cash value. An important advantage of the shareholder value analysis is that it establishes a link between the functional areas of marketing and financing: the strategies are evaluated on the basis of financial measures.

9.5.3  Estimating the net present value of a strategy To calculate the present value, the same formulas may be used that are employed in the investment realm. The present value of a strategy is the sum of the discounted future cash flows (calculated back to point ‘zero’ in time) plus the discounted residual value at the end of the duration of the strategy. To calculate the net present value, the investment made at point ‘zero’ in time should still be subtracted. The formula is as follows: n

NCW =

CE CF t

∑ (1 + r ) t =1

t

−I

in which: NCW = net cash (present) worth of a strategy n = planning period (e.g. three or five years) CFt = predicted cash flow in period t (CFn also contains the residual value of the strategy) r = discount rate 1/(1 + r)t = discount factor I = investment amount The variables mentioned here are calculated as follows: n The cash flow is calculated in the usual way: expected annual sales times gross profit

margin less taxes, increases in fixed costs (advertising, R&D) and investments in working capital. n The discount rate is the average cost of capital for the company. If a certain strategy has a relatively high risk, the discount rate can be increased by a risk surcharge. n The residual value of a strategy is the value at the end of the planning horizon. This seems difficult to determine. One approach is to assume that net receipts will continue forever or change by a certain percentage through the end of the planning period. In choosing a strategy, this procedure should be performed for the situation of ‘unchanged policy’ and for the options to be considered. The difference between the net present value of an option and the net present value of an unchanged policy is the value of the strategy. Figure 9.5 contains a calculation example. The most convenient way to do the calculation is to start from the expected differences between the strategy to be considered

250  Situation analysis Current values 2023

Forecasta of differences between strategy and unchanged policy

Residual value

2024

2025

2026

2027 ff

10

21

33

46

(t = 0) Cash flow a (annual growth

100

10%) Discount factor (r = 15%)

0.87

Present value of cash flow

8.7

Total cash value

222

Investment amount

150

Net present value strategy

72

0.76 16.0

0.66 21.8

3.81 b 175.3

Figure 9.5  Example of calculation of present value for a strategy a  For examples of how cash flow is calculated, we refer to the literature. b  Eternity assumption: discount factor/discount rate = .57/.15.

and ‘unchanged policy’ in one go. Figure 9.5 is based on the assumption (prognosis) that with the chosen strategy (investment amount 150) the cash flow will increase annually by 10%, while a stable cash flow (of 100) is expected if policy remains unchanged. In the example, the strategy should be executed. An advantage of the shareholder value analysis is that the financial expectations of a strategy are summarized in one key figure. This makes it easier to compare strategies. An additional advantage is that one is forced to explicitly describe all expected returns and costs of strategies. Drawing up financial indicators is always a necessity in a marketing plan. The shareholder value analysis stands or falls with the reliability of the predicted results. So, as we noted earlier, mapping future returns is a tricky business.

Summary The SWOT analysis forms the link between situation analysis (internal and external analysis) and strategy formation. Ideas for possible strategies are generated from the results of the situation analysis. It is important to do this creatively, critically, and in a customer-oriented way and to make a clear choice. The four steps are: 1 2 3 4

Reducing the situation analysis to a limited number of Ss, Ws, Os, and Ts. Reaching a ‘conclusion’ of the SWOT analysis: key point and future expectation, goal and expectation if policy remains unchanged. Devising marketing strategic options using the SWOT matrix, with sufficient room for creativity. Choice of a marketing strategy.

Various criteria can be used in choosing the best option, such as the FOETSLE criteria and the expected cash flow.

SWOT analysis 251

We end this chapter with an important caveat. We indicated earlier that a strategy cannot be ‘derived’ from a SWOT analysis. For that reason, a certain degree of freedom was chosen in step 2. But also in this chapter, a systematic approach to selection has been discussed. In step 2 it is recommended to come up with alternatives and then to arrive at a substantiated choice in steps 3 and 4. However, it is an illusion to think that a strategy can be chosen objectively. For example, it is virtually impossible to predict what the future annual returns of a strategy will be. In practice, therefore, a suitable strategy is often developed ‘in one go’ in step 2.

252  Situation analysis

Pepsi Cola in the United States: strategic choices

The American market for (non-alcoholic) beverages has traditionally been dominated by soft drinks, especially cola. However, the position of soft drinks has been under pressure for years, partly due to the pursuit of a healthy lifestyle and continuous attention to the dangers of obesity. The need for functional foods is also reflected in the market: consumers are looking for hydration, a good energy balance, or strengthening the immune system. Other product categories, such as sports drinks, fruit juices, and bottled water, are therefore on the rise. The following segments can be distinguished in this market: n n n n n

(Carbonated) soft drinks Bottled water Ready-to-drink (RTD) tea (such as iced tea) Energy, health, and sports drinks Juices

Carbonated soft drinks Sales of soft drinks have been declining for years. Consumers are increasingly buying drinks such as mineral water, fruit juice, and sports drinks instead of soft drinks. The downward trend continues: in 2021 there was another 5% decrease, to around 40 billion liters on an annual basis. In monetary terms, soft drink sales in the United States stabilized around a total of $136 billion. We are still talking about a lot of consumption: the average American drinks more than 120 liters per year.

SWOT analysis 253

Initially, companies such as Pepsi and Coca Cola tried to counteract the decline with Diet or Zero Sugar variants such as Diet Pepsi or Coke Zero. But these drinks are also under pressure, partly because sweeteners such as aspartame are also in the news negatively because they are said to be bad for health. And besides, if you really want to live a healthy life, you drink water, not a weak decoction of cola. That is why producers are increasingly trying to turn the tide by innovating and launching soft drinks with stronger flavors or other additives. Experiments are also being carried out with new taste concepts. Coca Cola Zero Sugar Byte is a sugar-free cola that should taste like pixels; Coca Cola Dreamworld is, according to the company, ‘a soda meant to capture technicolor tastes and surrealism of the subconscious by inviting drinkers to dream with open eyes’. Pepsi’s new Nitro Pepsi is ‘creamy, smooth and has a mesmerizing cascade of tiny bubbles topped off by a frothy foam head’. Consumers’ search for new experiences and the functional food trend will continue to stimulate these kinds of innovations in the coming years, if only to stop the declining trend in soft drink sales.

Bottled water Bottled water benefits greatly from increasing health awareness. While soft drinks are increasingly seen as artificial and sugar laden in the eyes of consumers, bottled water seems to benefit from its clean, pure image. In 2021, sales of bottled water in the United States grows by approximately 8%. The average American drinks nearly 180 liters of bottled water per year. Incidentally, there is an important difference between European mineral water and American bottled water. In Europe, mineral water comes from natural sources, contains all kinds of minerals, and has an image of ‘pure nature’. The bottled water sold in American supermarkets usually does not come directly from nature and often has hardly any natural association. It is filtered and distilled water, cleaned of potential germs through a process called reverse osmosis. Trends such as wellness are creating all kinds of product innovations in the field of bottled water with added vitamins and minerals so that consumers can get their daily dose of vitamins by drinking bottled water. Product innovations continue to drive consumption growth. The European idea of mineral water from natural sources is also an innovative element in the American market.

RTD tea Manufacturers of RTD tea have increasingly positioned their products as functional drinks, mainly due to the addition of beneficial antioxidants. Recent product introductions with the addition of green tea leaf extracts benefit from the increased interest in green tea. Specialty teas such as kombucha and yerba mate are enjoying increasing interest. This is partly stimulated by home delivery services such as UberEats; apparently home (or office) delivery stimulates the choice of surprising flavors. Sparkling tea is also on the rise. Due to all these

254  Situation analysis

developments, RTD tea remains in the spotlight: the RTD market grew by about 3.6% in 2021 to a total of $2.3 billion. Translated into liters, however, this hardly means an increase: RTD tea contains sugar, and health awareness also influences sales here.

Juice Fruit juices are healthy, but they also contain sugar. Partly because of that sugar, the sale of fruit juice in the United States was under pressure for years. But the turning point came in 2020 with the COVID-19 pandemic. The balance then tipped towards the healthy appearance of fruit and therefore of fruit juice. Fruit juices gave consumers a short escape from the lockdown by letting them enjoy a glass of pure nature. Some fruit juices also claim to support the immune system and prevent disease, which also boosts sales. The refrigerated fruit juice market increased by a whopping 7.8% in 2020 to a total of nearly $8 million.

Sports drinks continue to grow The sale of sports drinks has risen sharply in recent years due to product innovations and a repositioning in which the link between sports and health has been strengthened. All kinds of viral marketing aimed at students, for example, in combination with ‘traditional’ campaigns via radio and TV, have stimulated the sale of functional drinks such as energy drinks and sports drinks. As with fruit juices, sports drink sales were also boosted by COVID. The current emphasis on fitness and health will continue to reinforce this growth in the coming years. The growth of sports drinks in 2020 was no less than 15%. Growth opportunities also seem to lie in the field of personalized solutions. The CEO of Gatorade says: ‘We see great opportunities for creating personalized advice for athletes and their hydration and nutritional needs during exercise’.

Pepsico Pepsico is one of the leading food and beverage companies in the world. Pepsico’s product portfolio includes Frito-Lay (snacks such as Lay’s chips, Doritos, Cheetos), Quaker Foods (Quaker Oatmeal and other nutritious (breakfast) products), and Pepsico Beverages (brands like Pepsi Cola, Mountain Dew, Aquafina, Tropicana, Gatorade). Pepsico sees a number of important trends for its markets: n Retail dynamics, in particular the growth of e-commerce as a distribution

channel for food and beverages

n Society is increasingly focusing on the values and ethics of a brand n Continued consumer interest in health, wellness, and functional foods n Consumers are looking for ‘experiences’, also with soft drinks

SWOT analysis 255

The company has split its portfolio to benefit from these trends: n Good-for-you (Tropicana, Aquafina, and Quaker Foods). The Quaker brand is

one of the most important brands that Americans associate with healthy food.

n Better-for-you. Diet Pepsi can be considered ‘better for you’ than ‘regular’

Pepsi

n Fun-for-you: snacks and soft drinks

The key drinks in Pepsico’s portfolio are (figures are for the United States, 2021): Pepsico’s Sales in billions Market Competitors brands of liters (1 liter share is approx. 0.25 gallon) Soft drinks

Sports drinks

Pepsi 11.8 Mountain   9.5 Dew

Gatorade

  9%  7%

Market share

Coca Cola Dr. Pepper (Cadbury Schweppes) Sprite (CocaCola Company)

40%   8%   8%

  6.7

68%

Powerade (Coca-Cola Company)

14%

RTD-tea Lipton

  0.9

39%

Arizona (Arizona Beverage Company)

26%

Bottled water

  1.0

  9%

Dasani (CocaCola Company) Private labels

  8%

Aquafina

25%

Pepsico’s mission seems to be based on a people-planet-profit idea (source: www.pepsico.com, September 15, 2022): Create more smiles with every sip and every bite:   FOR OUR CONSUMERS:

By creating joyful moments through our delicious and nourishing products and unique brand experiences.   FOR OUR CUSTOMERS: By being the best possible partner, driving game-changing innovation and delivering a level of growth unmatched in our industry.   FOR OUR ASSOCIATES AND OUR COMMUNITIES:

256  Situation analysis

By creating meaningful opportunities to work, gain new skills and build successful careers, and maintaining a diverse and inclusive workplace.   FOR OUR PLANET: By conserving nature’s precious resources and fostering a more sustainable planet for our children and grandchildren.   FOR OUR SHAREHOLDERS: By delivering sustainable top-tier TSR and embracing best-in-class corporate governance. Pepsico is active in convincing young people about the importance of fitness and a balanced diet, for example, by sponsoring sports activities for children. Young people are important to the company. Pepsi focuses more than Coca Cola on young people: millennials and Gen Z. Pepsi believes that if the company manages to persuade these young people to adopt Pepsi, they will have a customer for life. Pepsi also profiles itself differently than Coca Cola. Brad Jakeman (marketer at Pepsico) once said that Coke represents happiness and moments of joy, while it preserves culture and maintains the status quo. Pepsi, on the other hand, creates culture and embraces individuality. For Pepsi loyalists, leading an exciting life is much more important than leading a happy one. This insight led Pepsi to opt for a positioning in which the ‘excitement’ of the here and now is central. The brand thus seems to aim at a target group that has high expectations of life and is very mobile and active. In their lifestyle, they pick the day (Carpe Diem). With the slogan ‘That’s what I like’, Pepsi tries to connect to this lifestyle. The Coca Cola strategy is different. This is clear from campaigns such as ‘Always Coca Cola’ or ‘Open Happiness’. The traditional values ​​of the product are central here. The new tagline ‘Taste the Feeling’ aligns the brand with an overall sense of happiness and focuses less on an ‘experience’ than Pepsi. The position of private labels in the soft drinks market in the United States is getting stronger but is still a far cry from the position of private labels and discount brands in some European countries. In the United States, consumer choice is driven more by image than by price. But a growing awareness of the American consumer could make US consumers more price sensitive, especially now that the US market is ravaged by raging inflation and declining purchasing power. Pepsi has spent a lot of money on marketing and distribution and will continue to do so in the future. It has created a young and dynamic image. But continuous competitive pressure and the increasing importance of healthy consumption limits the growth perspective. Consumers seem to consume less and less cola. And competition with Coca Cola is also not leading to the desired result: Pepsi’s market share has been declining for years. It’s a very slow decline, but still, it’s falling. So . . . What should Pepsico do with the Pepsi brand?

SWOT analysis 257

Questions 1 Create a graphical representation of Pepsico’s business, using the method described in Chapter 3. 2 How is it possible that volume sales of soft drinks, expressed in liters, fall but sales in terms of dollars remain the same? Mention at least two reasons. 3 An industry can be described by using Porter’s five-forces model. Run this model for the US soft drinks market. Draw your conclusions about the attractiveness of this market. 4 Apply the product lifecycle concept to the US soft drink market. Try to include the following product categories in your product lifecycle: n Soft drinks n Ready-to-drink tea n Sports drinks n Bottled water 5 Markets can be analyzed by using a portfolio analysis (the theory on portfolio analysis is covered in Chapter 10). a Create a portfolio analysis for Pepsico Beverages USA, using the Boston Consulting Group approach b Provide strategic recommendations for Pepsi based on your portfolio. c Assess the portfolio methodology: Do you agree with the recommendations arising from the BCG matrix? 6 Create a SWOT matrix for the Pepsi brand in the United States. 7 Analyze the strategic problem Pepsico faces with the Pepsi brand. 8 What should Pepsico do with the Pepsi brand? a Define strategic options for the Pepsi brand by using the information in the case description and the SWOT matrix you created in question 6. b Develop a strategy for the Pepsi brand based on your strategic options. Use the strategy selection process to make your choice. 9 Imagine you would like to predict sales and market share for Pepsi for the coming five years (2025–2030). Which method would you like to use for this prediction? Explain your answer.

Part 3

Corporate decisions and marketing decisions 10 Corporate objectives and strategies 11 Marketing objectives and marketing strategies In Part 2, we explained the situation analysis. This analysis forms the basis for the decisions to be made (planning). In Part 3, Chapter 10 deals with corporate objectives and corporate strategies. In Chapter 11, we discuss marketing objectives and marketing strategies. Decisions at this level concern the long term; they are thus strategic in nature.

DOI: 10.4324/9781003381488-12

Chapter 10

Corporate objectives and strategies

DOI: 10.4324/9781003381488-13

262  CORPORATE DECISIONS AND MARKETING DECISIONS

Key points in this chapter n n n n

Know the difference between corporate strategy and marketing strategy Apply a portfolio analysis Know the different growth directions for companies Know how to relate growth directions to development methods (partnering or not).

Introduction In this chapter we discuss the decisions that are made at the top level in the company: the company objective and the company strategy. Chapter 11 discusses the other kinds of decisions: the marketing decisions and market instrument decisions. If there is no difference between the corporate and brand levels (e.g. SMEs), the decisions we describe in this and the next chapter are all determined at one level (the entrepreneur). Sections 10.1 to 10.4 discuss successively determination of the corporate vision and corporate objectives (Section 10.1), the portfolio analysis (Section 10.2), and then the two components of the corporate strategy, namely the choice of markets and products (Section 10.3) and the choice of possible partners (Section 10.4).

10.1 Company vision and objectives In Chapter 3 we discussed the ‘current vision and mission’. Now, after the SWOT, it is time to see if the vision and mission need adjustment.

10.1.1  Corporate vision We have already discussed these concepts in Section 3.1. We provide some summary conclusions. n A mission mainly reflects the current set of core activities of the company and often

also says something about the market in which the company is active. The mission description often also contains the principles that the company stands for. These principles relate to values and norms, such as quality, integrity, and social involvement. Part of the latter is also sustainability. Social goals are sometimes referred to as ‘purpose’ and the associated marketing as purpose marketing. n A vision is future oriented: the vision indicates where the company wants to go in the coming years. It reflects the CEO’s ‘dream’. Thus, a vision can contain the personal view of top management. This opinion can be about the environment and the role of the company. Because a vision contains a dream (if it’s good), it can be motivating for the staff. A company’s vision and mission are often quite general and therefore meaningless. Then they are not benchmarks for the staff. See also Case 10.1.

CORPORATE OBJECTIVES AND STRATEGIES 263

Case 10.1  Strategy? Many have no idea

Use road signs In many large organizations there is a deluge of documents with countless points of attention that often cause a lot of confusion. This is called ‘strategic confusion’ and ‘strategic overload’. According to a study, 65% of employees of European companies therefore do not know their own organization’s strategy. So vague is bad. And wanting too much doesn’t work either. The more priorities a company has, the lower the revenue growth. A simple metaphor is: think of your plans and communication as road signs. If you want those works to apply, your signs must be clear at a glance, you must not hang too many of them, they must not be contradictory, and it must be clear which sign is the most important. Source: NRC, October 15, 2022 (column Ben Tiggelaar)

10.1.2  Corporate objectives In Chapter 4 we set out the general requirements for objectives (SMART) and also indicated that organizations should not only formulate financial goals but also goals related to innovation, customers, internal goals (balanced scorecard), and sustainability. Corporate goals are usually chosen for several years, a minimum of three years. In fact, when choosing corporate objectives, the following decisions are made: 1 2

What are the main objective variables? What value of those variables do we want to achieve and when?

Prioritization of objective variables is entirely a matter for top management. This concerns, for example, the question of whether the company wants to emphasize market

264  CORPORATE DECISIONS AND MARKETING DECISIONS

share or profit. In the specific interpretation of the set goals, it is important that the chosen goals in the organization be supported by those who are responsible for realizing them. This means, among other things, that various sections of the organization must be involved in the realization of those objectives. The balanced scorecard discussed in Section 4.1.2 can be helpful in both decisions (prioritization and interpretation of goals). We already mentioned that nowadays sustainability must also play a role in this and that growth should not always be an obvious objective.

10.2 Portfolio analysis A portfolio is a group of products of an organization. An analysis of this is important to know whether the right markets are still being served and also to know how much to invest in each of the products. One product is more profitable than another. In Section 10.2.1, we discuss the purpose and content of portfolio methods. We then describe the ‘classic’ portfolio method (the BCG matrix, Section 10.2.2) and a variant that takes into account more factors (the MABA analysis, Section 10.2.3). Portfolio methods are basically only about existing products in existing markets. In Section 10.2.4, we indicate how new markets can be taken into account (path analysis). Portfolio methods are primarily intended for corporate-level use with different markets. However, often companies have several brands or products in the same market. In Section 10.2.5, we describe ‘brand variants’ of the portfolio analysis. Finally, in Section 10.2.6, we list some advantages and disadvantages of portfolio methods.

10.2.1  Purpose and content of the portfolio analysis A company that is active in different markets with different products must strive for a balanced combination of its product-market combinations. In this context, balanced means the total use of the financial resources is in balance with – and preferably less than – the revenues of the various product-market combinations. While this may seem like an obvious goal, realizing it isn’t easy. Markets and market positions are constantly subject to change, which means that the demand that product-market combinations make on financial resources is constantly changing. After all, a product that people want to grow costs a lot of money. If one wants to keep the market share constant in a growing market, this also requires investments. On the other hand, a product with a large market share usually makes a lot of profit, and products in stable markets require less investment. A balanced ‘portfolio’ of products may therefore mean that the company has products in different stages of the product life cycle, for example, a product in an introduction stage, a number of products in the growth stage, some in more mature markets, and perhaps some in a downward phase. The tool that a company has to achieve a balanced portfolio is to set goals for the market positions of the product-market combinations and then try to achieve these goals by investing more or less in the various products. Portfolio methods are an aid in making a choice about investments in different products. With portfolio methods, the positions of product-market combinations are visualized in a figure or matrix. The two axes are approximations of the following two dimensions:

CORPORATE OBJECTIVES AND STRATEGIES 265

1

2

Attractiveness of the market. It is based on the hypothesis that more investments should be made in attractive (for example, growing) markets than in unattractive markets. One reason for this is that without additional investments in a growing market, market share will decline, partly due to generally stronger competition. The attractiveness of the market therefore indicates the extent to which cash resources are needed. Market position of the products. Products with a strong market position have a number of advantages over smaller competitors. These advantages, such as economies of scale, cost advantages due to experience effects (the so-called experience curve), better access to distribution channels, and high awareness, mean higher profitability. The market position therefore indicates the extent to which cash resources will become available.

Based on the visual overview of the positions of the various product-market combinations, alternative investment strategies can then be formulated. A portfolio analysis can be performed on two levels: 1 2

Corporate-level portfolio analysis. This involves the assessment of positions and the allocation of financial resources across SBUs. This application receives the most attention in the literature and in practice. SBU-level portfolio analysis. This involves the assessment of positions and the allocation of financial resources across brands/products. This variant requires a small adjustment of the method.

The two dimensions (the attractiveness of the market and the market position of the products) show that a portfolio analysis links results from the external and internal analysis. For this reason, a portfolio analysis is a logical continuation of a SWOT analysis. Figure 10.1 illustrates the relationship between the SWOT analysis and the portfolio analysis at the company level. Because a SWOT analysis is defined for a market, several SWOT analyses from as many SBUs are the input for the portfolio analysis. The attractiveness of the markets is the result of the industry analyses, while the market positions of the SBUs (the collective position of the brands in a market) are examined in the internal analyses.

SBU-level

Corporate level

SWOT 1

SWOT 2

SWOT 3

SWOT 4

Portfolio analysis

Investment strategies

Figure 10.1  Relation between SWOT-analysis and portfolio analysis

SWOT ...

266  CORPORATE DECISIONS AND MARKETING DECISIONS

Incidentally, countries can also be regarded as segments/sub-markets. A portfolio analysis can therefore be very helpful for a company that has an international investment problem within a market. Over time, various portfolio methods have been developed. We will discuss: n The portfolio matrix developed by the Boston Consulting Group (the BCG matrix;

see Section 10.2.2). This is the first and simplest portfolio method, which – due to its simplicity – also has the most limitations. n The ‘business screen’ developed by General Electric (example of a MABA analysis; see Section 10.2.3).

10.2.2  BCG matrix We will successively discuss the content of the BCG matrix, the resulting recommendations, and some points of criticism.

Content of the BCG matrix Figure 10.2 contains an example of a BCG growth share matrix. Along the axes are the following two variables: 1 2

market growth the relative market share

1  Market growth The vertical axis represents the market growth. This axis is divided into two: more and less than 10% growth per year. The variable market growth thus represents the attractiveness of the market. The choice of this variable is partly due to the central role that market growth plays in the concept of the product life cycle (see Section 6.4.2). Another advantage is the easy measurability of market growth.

2  Relative market share The horizontal axis represents the relative market share: own market share divided by the market share of the largest competitor. The limit value is 1: a value greater than 1 implies that the company has the largest market share; you are then market leader. The highest value is usually defined on the left and the lowest on the right. The fact that market share and profitability are positively related is partly due to the experience curve (or learning curve) existing in some industries. This concept means that as a company has more experience in producing a product, the costs per unit of product decrease over time due to various learning effects. The relationship between market share and profit can not only be reasoned theoretically but is also apparent from many empirical studies. The most well-known studies in this field have been carried out with the PIMS database: a file with financial data of several thousand companies. One of the most remarkable results from PIMS studies is the clear relationship between market share and return on investment.

CORPORATE OBJECTIVES AND STRATEGIES 267

In the BCG matrix, the SBUs are arranged in the form of circles. It is customary for the diameter of those circles to be proportional to the SBU’s contribution to the company’s turnover. Depending on the place of a product-market combination in one of the four quadrants of the BCG matrix, we can distinguish four types of products: 1

2 3

4

Stars. These are products with a high market share in a rapidly growing market. The used and required cash resources of these products are both high and therefore in principle in balance. When the market’s growth slows, the stars can turn into cash cows. Cash cows. These are products with a high market share in a market with little growth. Due to the strong market position, they generate a lot of cash, while they require little investment due to the limited market growth. Problem children. These products (also called question marks or wild cats) have a low market share in a fast growing market. As the name implies, they can cause problems: they yield little but require a lot of cash. If they manage to strengthen their position, they can become a star and eventually, when market growth slows down, a cash cow. Dogs. This concerns products with a low market share in a market with little growth. They therefore yield little but also require little investment. As with the stars, the financial aspects of these products are in balance. Because many markets are saturated and by definition only one brand can be the market leader, in practice most brands can be characterized as dogs.

In the example in Figure 10.2, the major SBUs are numbers 5 (a star) and 6 (a cash cow). The company also has a medium-sized star and some minor problem children and dogs.

Strategic recommendations Based on a portfolio analysis, the following investment strategies can be chosen: n n n n

growth (build) maintain position (hold) harvest/milk (harvest) liquidation (terminate)

The strong positions of the stars and cash cows should at least be maintained. For the cash cows, part of the proceeds can be used to strengthen the positions of that problem children who have the opportunity to become a star. For some problem children, a growth strategy is therefore used, financed from cash cows. For the other problem children, no investments are made in them: therefore harvesting or liquidation. A problem here is of course selecting the problem children for whom growth opportunities are seen. The choice largely depends on the phase of the product life cycle in which the product is located: the introduction, growth, or maturity phase. A thorough industry analysis is important here.

268  CORPORATE DECISIONS AND MARKETING DECISIONS Market growth (%) ‘Stars’

20

‘Problem children’ 4 1

3

5

2

10 ‘Cash cows’

‘Dogs’

7 6 0 10

8 1

0.1 Relative market share (logarithmic scale)

Figure 10.2

In principle, the recommendation for dogs is ‘milk them out and remove them from the market’. However, if dogs are of a reasonable size, they can be an important part of a company’s business. A enforcement strategy then seems possible. In the example in Figure 10.2, the (sizable) cash cow can be used to collect both stars and possibly a problem. The portfolio of the company in question seems reasonably balanced.

Critique of the BCG matrix In Section 10.2.6, we discuss the objections to portfolio methods in general. Here we consider some specific drawbacks of the BCG matrix. As we mentioned, an advantage of the BCG matrix is its great simplicity. However, this simplicity also leads to disadvantages. The main limitation specific to the BCG matrix is that only one variable is chosen for both dimensions, namely relative market share and market growth. Although these variables are in themselves of great importance for determining market position and market attractiveness respectively, they are only an underlying factor. Other underlying factors should also be considered. To meet this objection, portfolio models have been developed that take multiple factors into account (see the MABA analysis in Section 10.2.3).

10.2.3  MABA analysis An example of a MABA analysis (market attractiveness business position assessment) is the business screen developed by General Electric (see Figure 10.3). Instead of market growth, the vertical axis now shows the attractiveness of the market. This variable is determined by a number of underlying industry factors, such as market

CORPORATE OBJECTIVES AND STRATEGIES 269 Competitive position Market attractiveness

Strong (score >

Average (1.67 < score
3.33)

1 Invest/grow

1 Invest/grow

Average (1.67 < score